HTTP Working Group                                      R. Fielding, Ed.
Internet-Draft                                                     Adobe
Obsoletes: 7231 7230,7231,7232,7233,7235 (if approved)               M. Nottingham, Ed.
           approved)                                              Fastly
Intended status: Standards Track                                  Fastly
Expires: October 5, 2018                         J. Reschke, Ed.
Expires: December 2, 2018                                     greenbytes
                                                           April 3,
                                                            May 31, 2018

       Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP):

                             HTTP Semantics and Content
                    draft-ietf-httpbis-semantics-00
                    draft-ietf-httpbis-semantics-01

Abstract

   The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) is a stateless application-
   level protocol for distributed, collaborative, hypertext information
   systems.  This document defines the semantics of HTTP/1.1 messages,
   as expressed by HTTP: its
   architecture, terminology, the "http" and "https" Uniform Resource
   Identifier (URI) schemes, core request methods, request header
   fields, response status codes, and response header fields, along with the payload of
   messages (metadata and body content) and mechanisms for content
   negotiation.

   This document obsoletes RFC 7231. 7231, RFC 7232, RFC 7233, RFC 7235, and
   portions of RFC 7230.

Editorial Note

   This note is to be removed before publishing as an RFC.

   Discussion of this draft takes place on the HTTP working group
   mailing list (ietf-http-wg@w3.org), which is archived at
   <http://lists.w3.org/Archives/Public/ietf-http-wg/>.
   <https://lists.w3.org/Archives/Public/ietf-http-wg/>.

   Working Group information can be found at <http://httpwg.github.io/>; <https://httpwg.org/>;
   source code and issues list for this draft can be found at
   <https://github.com/httpwg/http-core>.

   The changes in this draft are summarized in Appendix E.1. G.2.

Status of This Memo

   This Internet-Draft is submitted in full conformance with the
   provisions of BCP 78 and BCP 79.

   Internet-Drafts are working documents of the Internet Engineering
   Task Force (IETF).  Note that other groups may also distribute
   working documents as Internet-Drafts.  The list of current Internet-
   Drafts is at https://datatracker.ietf.org/drafts/current/.

   Internet-Drafts are draft documents valid for a maximum of six months
   and may be updated, replaced, or obsoleted by other documents at any
   time.  It is inappropriate to use Internet-Drafts as reference
   material or to cite them other than as "work in progress."

   This Internet-Draft will expire on October 5, December 2, 2018.

Copyright Notice

   Copyright (c) 2018 IETF Trust and the persons identified as the
   document authors.  All rights reserved.

   This document is subject to BCP 78 and the IETF Trust's Legal
   Provisions Relating to IETF Documents
   (https://trustee.ietf.org/license-info) in effect on the date of
   publication of this document.  Please review these documents
   carefully, as they describe your rights and restrictions with respect
   to this document.  Code Components extracted from this document must
   include Simplified BSD License text as described in Section 4.e of
   the Trust Legal Provisions and are provided without warranty as
   described in the Simplified BSD License.

   This document may contain material from IETF Documents or IETF
   Contributions published or made publicly available before November
   10, 2008.  The person(s) controlling the copyright in some of this
   material may not have granted the IETF Trust the right to allow
   modifications of such material outside the IETF Standards Process.
   Without obtaining an adequate license from the person(s) controlling
   the copyright in such materials, this document may not be modified
   outside the IETF Standards Process, and derivative works of it may
   not be created outside the IETF Standards Process, except to format
   it for publication as an RFC or to translate it into languages other
   than English.

Table of Contents

   1.  Introduction  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   5   7
     1.1.  Conformance and Error Handling  .  Requirements Notation . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
     1.2.  Syntax Notation . . . . . .   9
     1.2.  Syntax Notation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
   2.  Resources . . . . . .   9
   2.  Architecture  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
   3.  Representations . . . .   9
     2.1.  Client/Server Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
     2.2.  Intermediaries  . .   7
     3.1.  Representation Metadata . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
       3.1.1.  Processing Representation Data . .  11
     2.3.  Caches  . . . . . . . . .   8
       3.1.2.  Encoding for Compression or Integrity . . . . . . . .  11
       3.1.3.  Audience Language . . . . . . . .  13
     2.4.  Uniform Resource Identifiers  . . . . . . . . . .  12
       3.1.4.  Identification . . . .  14
     2.5.  Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
     3.2.  Representation Data . . . . . . . . .  15
       2.5.1.  http URI Scheme . . . . . . . . . .  17
     3.3.  Payload Semantics . . . . . . . . .  16
       2.5.2.  https URI Scheme  . . . . . . . . . . .  17
     3.4.  Content Negotiation . . . . . . .  17
       2.5.3.  http and https URI Normalization and Comparison . . .  18

   3.  Conformance . . . . . . . . .  18
       3.4.1.  Proactive Negotiation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
       3.4.2.  Reactive Negotiation
     3.1.  Implementation Diversity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
   4.  Request Methods  18
     3.2.  Role-based Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
     3.3.  Parsing Elements  . . . . . .  21
     4.1.  Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
     3.4.  Error Handling  . . . . . . . . . . .  21
     4.2.  Common Method Properties . . . . . . . . . .  20
     3.5.  Protocol Versioning . . . . . .  22
       4.2.1.  Safe Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
   4.  Message Abstraction . . . . . . .  22
       4.2.2.  Idempotent Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22
     4.1.  Field Names . . .  23
       4.2.3.  Cacheable Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
     4.3.  Method Definitions . .  22
       4.1.1.  Field Name Registry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
       4.3.1.  GET
       4.1.2.  Field Extensibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24
       4.1.3.  Considerations for New Fields . . . . . . . .  24
       4.3.2.  HEAD . . . .  24
     4.2.  Field Values  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
       4.3.3.  POST . .  26
       4.2.1.  Field Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26
       4.2.2.  Field Limits  .  25
       4.3.4.  PUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27
       4.2.3.  Field Value Components  . . . . . .  26
       4.3.5.  DELETE . . . . . . . . .  27
       4.2.4.  Designing New Field Values  . . . . . . . . . . . . .  28
     4.3.  Whitespace  .  29
       4.3.6.  CONNECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  29
     4.4.  Trailer .  30
       4.3.7.  OPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  31
       4.3.8.  TRACE .  30
   5.  Message Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
   5.  Request Header Fields  30
     5.1.  Identifying a Target Resource . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
     5.2.  Routing Inbound . . . . . .  33
     5.1.  Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  30
     5.3.  Effective Request URI . . . . . . . . .  33
       5.1.1.  Expect . . . . . . . . .  31
     5.4.  Host  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  34
       5.1.2.  Max-Forwards . . . . . . . . . . . .  32
     5.5.  Associating a Response to a Request . . . . . . . .  36
     5.2.  Conditionals . . .  33
     5.6.  Message Forwarding  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
     5.3.  Content Negotiation  33
       5.6.1.  Via . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  37
       5.3.1.  Quality Values . . . . . .  34
       5.6.2.  Transformations . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
       5.3.2.  Accept . . . . . .  35
   6.  Representations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
       5.3.3.  Accept-Charset . . . . . .  37
     6.1.  Representation Data . . . . . . . . . . . . .  40
       5.3.4.  Accept-Encoding . . . . . .  37
       6.1.1.  Media Type  . . . . . . . . . . . . .  41
       5.3.5.  Accept-Language . . . . . . . .  37
       6.1.2.  Content Codings . . . . . . . . . . .  43
     5.4.  Authentication Credentials . . . . . . . .  40
       6.1.3.  Language Tags . . . . . . .  44
     5.5.  Request Context . . . . . . . . . . . . .  41
       6.1.4.  Range Units . . . . . . . .  44
       5.5.1.  From . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
     6.2.  Representation Metadata . . . . . . . . . . .  44
       5.5.2.  Referer . . . . . .  45
       6.2.1.  Content-Type  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  45
       5.5.3.  User-Agent . . .  45
       6.2.2.  Content-Encoding  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  46
   6.  Response Status Codes
       6.2.3.  Content-Language  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  47
       6.2.4.  Content-Length  . . .  47
     6.1.  Overview of Status Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  48
     6.2.  Informational 1xx
       6.2.5.  Content-Location  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  49
     6.3.  Payload . .  50
       6.2.1.  100 Continue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  50
       6.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols . . .  51
       6.3.1.  Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . .  50
     6.3.  Successful 2xx . . . . . . . . . . .  51
       6.3.2.  Identification  . . . . . . . . . .  51
       6.3.1.  200 OK . . . . . . . . .  52
       6.3.3.  Content-Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  51
       6.3.2.  201 Created . . . . . .  53
       6.3.4.  Media Type multipart/byteranges . . . . . . . . . . .  55
     6.4.  Content Negotiation . . . .  52
       6.3.3.  202 Accepted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
       6.4.1.  Proactive Negotiation . . . . .  52
       6.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information . . . . . . . . . .  52
       6.3.5.  204 No Content .  57
       6.4.2.  Reactive Negotiation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  58
   7.  Request Methods . .  53
       6.3.6.  205 Reset Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  53
     6.4.  Redirection 3xx . . .  59
     7.1.  Overview  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
       6.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices . . . . . .  59
     7.2.  Common Method Properties  . . . . . . . . . .  55
       6.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently . . . . . .  61
       7.2.1.  Safe Methods  . . . . . . . . . .  56
       6.4.3.  302 Found . . . . . . . . . .  61
       7.2.2.  Idempotent Methods  . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
       6.4.4.  303 See Other . . . . .  62
       7.2.3.  Cacheable Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  57
       6.4.5.  305 Use Proxy . . .  62
     7.3.  Method Definitions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  58
       6.4.6.  306 (Unused) . .  63
       7.3.1.  GET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  58
       6.4.7.  307 Temporary Redirect . . . . . . .  63
       7.3.2.  HEAD  . . . . . . . .  58
     6.5.  Client Error 4xx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
       7.3.3.  POST  . . . .  58
       6.5.1.  400 Bad Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
       6.5.2.  402 Payment Required .  64
       7.3.4.  PUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
       6.5.3.  403 Forbidden . . . . . . . . . .  65
       7.3.5.  DELETE  . . . . . . . . . .  59
       6.5.4.  404 Not Found . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
       7.3.6.  CONNECT . . . . . . .  59
       6.5.5.  405 Method Not Allowed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  59
       6.5.6.  406 Not Acceptable .  69
       7.3.7.  OPTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  60
       6.5.7.  408 Request Timeout . . . . . . .  70
       7.3.8.  TRACE . . . . . . . . . .  60
       6.5.8.  409 Conflict . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  71
     7.4.  Method Extensibility  . . . . . .  60
       6.5.9.  410 Gone . . . . . . . . . . . .  72
       7.4.1.  Method Registry . . . . . . . . . .  61
       6.5.10. 411 Length Required . . . . . . . . .  72
       7.4.2.  Considerations for New Methods  . . . . . . . .  61
       6.5.11. 413 Payload Too Large . . .  72
   8.  Request Header Fields . . . . . . . . . . . . .  61
       6.5.12. 414 URI Too Long . . . . . . .  73
     8.1.  Controls  . . . . . . . . . . .  62
       6.5.13. 415 Unsupported Media Type . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
       6.5.14. 417 Expectation Failed  73
       8.1.1.  Expect  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  62
       6.5.15. 426 Upgrade Required . . . . . . . .  73
       8.1.2.  Max-Forwards  . . . . . . . .  62
     6.6.  Server Error 5xx . . . . . . . . . . . .  76
     8.2.  Preconditions . . . . . . . .  63
       6.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
       6.6.2.  501 Not Implemented  76
       8.2.1.  Evaluation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
       6.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway . . . .  77
       8.2.2.  Precedence  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  63
       6.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable . . . . . .  78
       8.2.3.  If-Match  . . . . . . . . .  64
       6.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
       8.2.4.  If-None-Match . . . .  64
       6.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported . . . . . . . . . . .  64
   7.  Response Header Fields . . . . .  81
       8.2.5.  If-Modified-Since . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  64
     7.1.  Control Data . . . .  82
       8.2.6.  If-Unmodified-Since . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  83
       8.2.7.  If-Range  .  64
       7.1.1.  Origination Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  65
       7.1.2.  Location . . .  84
     8.3.  Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  68
       7.1.3.  Retry-After . . . . . . .  86
     8.4.  Content Negotiation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  69
       7.1.4.  Vary . . . . .  87
       8.4.1.  Quality Values  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  70
     7.2.  Validator Header Fields  88
       8.4.2.  Accept  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  71
     7.3.  Authentication Challenges . . . . . .  88
       8.4.3.  Accept-Charset  . . . . . . . . . .  72
     7.4.  Response Context . . . . . . . . .  90
       8.4.4.  Accept-Encoding . . . . . . . . . . .  72
       7.4.1.  Allow . . . . . . . .  91
       8.4.5.  Accept-Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  72
       7.4.2.  Server . . .  93
     8.5.  Authentication Credentials  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  94
       8.5.1.  Challenge and Response  . . . . .  73
   8.  IANA Considerations . . . . . . . . . .  94
       8.5.2.  Protection Space (Realm)  . . . . . . . . . . .  74
     8.1.  Method Registry . . .  96
       8.5.3.  Authorization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  74
       8.1.1.  Procedure .  97
       8.5.4.  Proxy-Authorization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  97
       8.5.5.  Authentication Scheme Extensibility . . . . .  74
       8.1.2.  Considerations for New Methods . . . .  98
     8.6.  Request Context . . . . . . .  74
       8.1.3.  Registrations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
       8.6.1.  From  . . . . . .  75
     8.2.  Status Code Registry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  75
       8.2.1.  Procedure 100
       8.6.2.  Referer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  75
       8.2.2.  Considerations for New . 101
       8.6.3.  User-Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
   9.  Response Status Codes . . . . . . . . .  76
       8.2.3.  Registrations . . . . . . . . . . . 103
     9.1.  Overview of Status Codes  . . . . . . . . .  77
     8.3.  Header Field Registry . . . . . . . 104
     9.2.  Informational 1xx . . . . . . . . . . .  78
       8.3.1.  Considerations for New Header Fields . . . . . . . .  78
       8.3.2.  Registrations . 106
       9.2.1.  100 Continue  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  80
     8.4.  Content Coding Registry . 106
       9.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
     9.3.  Successful 2xx  .  81
       8.4.1.  Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
       9.3.1.  200 OK  . .  81
       8.4.2.  Registrations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  81
   9.  Security Considerations . 107
       9.3.2.  201 Created . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  81
     9.1.  Attacks Based on File and Path Names . . . 108
       9.3.3.  202 Accepted  . . . . . . .  82
     9.2.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection . . .  82
     9.3.  Disclosure of Personal . . . . . . . . . . 108
       9.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information . . . . . . . . . . 108
       9.3.5.  204 No Content  .  83
     9.4.  Disclosure of Sensitive Information in URIs . . . . . . .  83
     9.5.  Disclosure of Fragment after Redirects . . . . . . . . .  84
     9.6.  Disclosure of Product Information . . 109
       9.3.6.  205 Reset Content . . . . . . . . . .  84
     9.7.  Browser Fingerprinting . . . . . . . . 109
       9.3.7.  206 Partial Content . . . . . . . . .  84
   10. References . . . . . . . . 110
     9.4.  Redirection 3xx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  85
     10.1.  Normative References . . . . 113
       9.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  85
     10.2.  Informative References . . 114
       9.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  87
   Appendix A.  Differences between HTTP and MIME . 115
       9.4.3.  302 Found . . . . . . . .  90
     A.1.  MIME-Version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
       9.4.4.  303 See Other . . . . . . . .  90
     A.2.  Conversion to Canonical Form . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
       9.4.5.  304 Not Modified  . .  90
     A.3.  Conversion of Date Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
     A.4.  Conversion of Content-Encoding . 117
       9.4.6.  305 Use Proxy . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
     A.5.  Conversion of Content-Transfer-Encoding . . . . . . . . 117
       9.4.7.  306 (Unused)  .  91
     A.6.  MHTML and Line Length Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
   Appendix B.  Changes from RFC 7231 . . . . . . . 118
       9.4.8.  307 Temporary Redirect  . . . . . . . .  92
   Appendix C.  Imported ABNF . . . . . . . 118
     9.5.  Client Error 4xx  . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
   Appendix D.  Collected ABNF . . . . . . . . 118
       9.5.1.  400 Bad Request . . . . . . . . . . .  92
   Appendix E.  Change Log . . . . . . . . 118
       9.5.2.  401 Unauthorized  . . . . . . . . . . . . .  95
     E.1.  Since RFC 7231 . . . . . 118
       9.5.3.  402 Payment Required  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  95
   Index 119
       9.5.4.  403 Forbidden . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
       9.5.5.  404 Not Found . . . . . . . . . .  96
   Acknowledgments . . . . . . . . . . 119
       9.5.6.  405 Method Not Allowed  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
   Authors' Addresses 120
       9.5.7.  406 Not Acceptable  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
       9.5.8.  407 Proxy Authentication Required . . . . . . 100

1.  Introduction

   Each Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) message is either a request
   or a response.  A server listens on a connection for a request,
   parses each message received, interprets the message semantics in
   relation to the identified request target, and responds to that
   request with one or more response messages.  A . . . . 120
       9.5.9.  408 Request Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
       9.5.10. 409 Conflict  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
       9.5.11. 410 Gone  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
       9.5.12. 411 Length Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
       9.5.13. 412 Precondition Failed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
       9.5.14. 413 Payload Too Large . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
       9.5.15. 414 URI Too Long  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
       9.5.16. 415 Unsupported Media Type  . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
       9.5.17. 416 Range Not Satisfiable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
       9.5.18. 417 Expectation Failed  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
       9.5.19. 426 Upgrade Required  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
     9.6.  Server Error 5xx  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
       9.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
       9.6.2.  501 Not Implemented . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
       9.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
       9.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
       9.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
       9.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported  . . . . . . . . . . . 125
     9.7.  Status Code Extensibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
       9.7.1.  Status Code Registry  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
       9.7.2.  Considerations for New Status Codes . . . . . . . . . 126
   10. Response Header Fields  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
     10.1.  Control Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
       10.1.1.  Origination Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
       10.1.2.  Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
       10.1.3.  Retry-After  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
       10.1.4.  Vary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
     10.2.  Validators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
       10.2.1.  Weak versus Strong . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
       10.2.2.  Last-Modified  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
       10.2.3.  ETag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
       10.2.4.  When to Use Entity-Tags and Last-Modified Dates  . . 142
     10.3.  Authentication Challenges  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
       10.3.1.  WWW-Authenticate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
       10.3.2.  Proxy-Authenticate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
     10.4.  Response Context . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
       10.4.1.  Accept-Ranges  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
       10.4.2.  Allow  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
       10.4.3.  Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
   11. ABNF List Extension: #rule  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
   12. Security Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
     12.1.  Establishing Authority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
     12.2.  Risks of Intermediaries  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
     12.3.  Attacks Based on File and Path Names . . . . . . . . . . 149
     12.4.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection . . . 150
     12.5.  Attacks via Protocol Element Length  . . . . . . . . . . 151
     12.6.  Disclosure of Personal Information . . . . . . . . . . . 151
     12.7.  Privacy of Server Log Information  . . . . . . . . . . . 151
     12.8.  Disclosure of Sensitive Information in URIs  . . . . . . 152
     12.9.  Disclosure of Fragment after Redirects . . . . . . . . . 152
     12.10. Disclosure of Product Information  . . . . . . . . . . . 153
     12.11. Browser Fingerprinting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
     12.12. Validator Retention  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
     12.13. Denial-of-Service Attacks Using Range  . . . . . . . . . 154
     12.14. Authentication Considerations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
       12.14.1.  Confidentiality of Credentials  . . . . . . . . . . 155
       12.14.2.  Credentials and Idle Clients  . . . . . . . . . . . 155
       12.14.3.  Protection Spaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
   13. IANA Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
     13.1.  URI Scheme Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.2.  Method Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.3.  Status Code Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.4.  Header Field Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.5.  Authentication Scheme Registration . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.6.  Content Coding Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.7.  Range Unit Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
     13.8.  Media Type Registration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158

   14. References  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
     14.1.  Normative References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
     14.2.  Informative References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
   Appendix A.  Collected ABNF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
   Appendix B.  Changes from RFC 7230  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
   Appendix C.  Changes from RFC 7231  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
   Appendix D.  Changes from RFC 7232  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
   Appendix E.  Changes from RFC 7233  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
   Appendix F.  Changes from RFC 7235  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
   Appendix G.  Change Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
     G.1.  Between RFC723x and draft 00  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
     G.2.  Since draft-ietf-httpbis-semantics-00 . . . . . . . . . . 170
   Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
   Acknowledgments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
   Authors' Addresses  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179

1.  Introduction

   The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) is a stateless application-
   level request/response protocol that uses extensible semantics and
   self-descriptive messages for flexible interaction with network-based
   hypertext information systems.  HTTP is defined by a series of
   documents that collectively form the HTTP/1.1 specification:

   o  "HTTP Semantics" (this document)

   o  "HTTP Caching" [Caching]

   o  "HTTP/1.1 Messaging" [Messaging]

   HTTP is a generic interface protocol for information systems.  It is
   designed to hide the details of how a service is implemented by
   presenting a uniform interface to clients that is independent of the
   types of resources provided.  Likewise, servers do not need to be
   aware of each client's purpose: an HTTP request can be considered in
   isolation rather than being associated with a specific type of client
   or a predetermined sequence of application steps.  The result is a
   protocol that can be used effectively in many different contexts and
   for which implementations can evolve independently over time.

   HTTP is also designed for use as an intermediation protocol for
   translating communication to and from non-HTTP information systems.
   HTTP proxies and gateways can provide access to alternative
   information services by translating their diverse protocols into a
   hypertext format that can be viewed and manipulated by clients in the
   same way as HTTP services.

   One consequence of this flexibility is that the protocol cannot be
   defined in terms of what occurs behind the interface.  Instead, we
   are limited to defining the syntax of communication, the intent of
   received communication, and the expected behavior of recipients.  If
   the communication is considered in isolation, then successful actions
   ought to be reflected in corresponding changes to the observable
   interface provided by servers.  However, since multiple clients might
   act in parallel and perhaps at cross-purposes, we cannot require that
   such changes be observable beyond the scope of a single response.

   Each HTTP message is either a request or a response.  A server
   listens on a connection for a request, parses each message received,
   interprets the message semantics in relation to the identified
   request target, and responds to that request with one or more
   response messages.  A client constructs request messages to
   communicate specific intentions, examines received responses to see
   if the intentions were carried out, and determines how to interpret
   the results.

   HTTP provides a uniform interface for interacting with a resource
   (Section 2.5), regardless of its type, nature, or implementation, via
   the manipulation and transfer of representations (Section 6).

   This document defines semantics that are common to all versions of
   HTTP.  HTTP semantics include the intentions defined by each request
   method (Section 7), extensions to those semantics that might be
   described in request header fields (Section 8), the meaning of status
   codes to indicate a machine-readable response (Section 9), and the
   meaning of other control data and resource metadata that might be
   given in response header fields (Section 10).

   This document also defines representation metadata that describe how
   a payload is intended to be interpreted by a recipient, the request
   header fields that might influence content selection, and the various
   selection algorithms that are collectively referred to as "content
   negotiation" (Section 6.4).

   This document defines HTTP/1.1 range requests, partial responses, and
   the multipart/byteranges media type.

   This document obsoletes the portions of RFC 7230 that are independent
   of the HTTP/1.1 messaging syntax and connection management, with the
   changes being summarized in Appendix B.  The other parts of RFC 7230
   are obsoleted by "HTTP/1.1 Messaging" [Messaging].  This document
   also obsoletes RFC 7231 (see Appendix C), RFC 7232 (see Appendix D),
   RFC 7233 (see Appendix E), and RFC 7235 (see Appendix F).

1.1.  Requirements Notation

   The key words "MUST", "MUST NOT", "REQUIRED", "SHALL", "SHALL NOT",
   "SHOULD", "SHOULD NOT", "RECOMMENDED", "MAY", and "OPTIONAL" in this
   document are to be interpreted as described in [RFC2119].

   Conformance criteria and considerations regarding error handling are
   defined in Section 3.

1.2.  Syntax Notation

   This specification uses the Augmented Backus-Naur Form (ABNF)
   notation of [RFC5234] with a list extension, defined in Section 11,
   that allows for compact definition of comma-separated lists using a
   '#' operator (similar to how the '*' operator indicates repetition).
   Appendix A shows the collected grammar with all list operators
   expanded to standard ABNF notation.

   As a convention, ABNF rule names prefixed with "obs-" denote
   "obsolete" grammar rules that appear for historical reasons.

   The following core rules are included by reference, as defined in
   Appendix B.1 of [RFC5234]: ALPHA (letters), CR (carriage return),
   CRLF (CR LF), CTL (controls), DIGIT (decimal 0-9), DQUOTE (double
   quote), HEXDIG (hexadecimal 0-9/A-F/a-f), HTAB (horizontal tab), LF
   (line feed), OCTET (any 8-bit sequence of data), SP (space), and
   VCHAR (any visible US-ASCII character).  [[CREF1: Range also uses
   CHAR, which is probably a bug.]]

   The rules below are defined in [Messaging]:

     obs-fold         = <obs-fold, see [Messaging], Section 5.2>
     protocol-name    = <protocol-name, see [Messaging], Section 9.7>
     protocol-version = <protocol-version, see [Messaging], Section 9.7>
     request-target   = <request-target, see [Messaging], Section 3.2>

   This specification uses the terms "character", "character encoding
   scheme", "charset", and "protocol element" as they are defined in
   [RFC6365].

2.  Architecture

   HTTP was created for the World Wide Web (WWW) architecture and has
   evolved over time to support the scalability needs of a worldwide
   hypertext system.  Much of that architecture is reflected in the
   terminology and syntax productions used to define HTTP.

2.1.  Client/Server Messaging

   HTTP is a stateless request/response protocol that operates by
   exchanging messages (Section 2 of [Messaging]) across a reliable
   transport- or session-layer "connection" (Section 9 of [Messaging]).
   An HTTP "client" is a program that establishes a connection to a
   server for the purpose of sending one or more HTTP requests.  An HTTP
   "server" is a program that accepts connections in order to service
   HTTP requests by sending HTTP responses.

   The terms "client" and "server" refer only to the roles that these
   programs perform for a particular connection.  The same program might
   act as a client on some connections and a server on others.  The term
   "user agent" refers to any of the various client programs that
   initiate a request, including (but not limited to) browsers, spiders
   (web-based robots), command-line tools, custom applications, and
   mobile apps.  The term "origin server" refers to the program that can
   originate authoritative responses for a given target resource.  The
   terms "sender" and "recipient" refer to any implementation that sends
   or receives a given message, respectively.

   HTTP relies upon the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) standard
   [RFC3986] to indicate the target resource (Section 5.1) and
   relationships between resources.

   Most HTTP communication consists of a retrieval request (GET) for a
   representation of some resource identified by a URI.  In the simplest
   case, this might be accomplished via a single bidirectional
   connection (===) between the user agent (UA) and the origin server
   (O).

            request   >
       UA ======================================= O
                                   <   response

   A client sends an HTTP request to a server in the form of a request
   message, beginning with a request-line that includes a method, URI,
   and protocol version (Section 3 of [Messaging]), followed by header
   fields containing request modifiers, client information, and
   representation metadata (Section 5 of [Messaging]), an empty line to
   indicate the end of the header section, and finally a message body
   containing the payload body (if any, Section 6 of [Messaging]).

   A server responds to a client's request by sending one or more HTTP
   response messages, each beginning with a status line that includes
   the protocol version, a success or error code, and textual reason
   phrase (Section 4 of [Messaging]), possibly followed by header fields
   containing server information, resource metadata, and representation
   metadata (Section 5 of [Messaging]), an empty line to indicate the
   end of the header section, and finally a message body containing the
   payload body (if any, Section 6 of [Messaging]).

   A connection might be used for multiple request/response exchanges,
   as defined in Section 9.3 of [Messaging].

   The following example illustrates a typical message exchange for a
   GET request (Section 7.3.1) on the URI "http://www.example.com/
   hello.txt":

   Client request:

     GET /hello.txt HTTP/1.1
     User-Agent: curl/7.16.3 libcurl/7.16.3 OpenSSL/0.9.7l zlib/1.2.3
     Host: www.example.com
     Accept-Language: en, mi

   Server response:

     HTTP/1.1 200 OK
     Date: Mon, 27 Jul 2009 12:28:53 GMT
     Server: Apache
     Last-Modified: Wed, 22 Jul 2009 19:15:56 GMT
     ETag: "34aa387-d-1568eb00"
     Accept-Ranges: bytes
     Content-Length: 51
     Vary: Accept-Encoding
     Content-Type: text/plain

     Hello World! My payload includes a trailing CRLF.

2.2.  Intermediaries

   HTTP enables the use of intermediaries to satisfy requests through a
   chain of connections.  There are three common forms of HTTP
   intermediary: proxy, gateway, and tunnel.  In some cases, a single
   intermediary might act as an origin server, proxy, gateway, or
   tunnel, switching behavior based on the nature of each request.

            >             >             >             >
       UA =========== A =========== B =========== C =========== O
                  <             <             <             <

   The figure above shows three intermediaries (A, B, and C) between the
   user agent and origin server.  A request or response message that
   travels the whole chain will pass through four separate connections.

   Some HTTP communication options might apply only to the connection
   with the nearest, non-tunnel neighbor, only to the endpoints of the
   chain, or to all connections along the chain.  Although the diagram
   is linear, each participant might be engaged in multiple,
   simultaneous communications.  For example, B might be receiving
   requests from many clients other than A, and/or forwarding requests
   to servers other than C, at the same time that it is handling A's
   request.  Likewise, later requests might be sent through a different
   path of connections, often based on dynamic configuration for load
   balancing.

   The terms "upstream" and "downstream" are used to describe
   directional requirements in relation to the message flow: all
   messages flow from upstream to downstream.  The terms "inbound" and
   "outbound" are used to describe directional requirements in relation
   to the request route: "inbound" means toward the origin server and
   "outbound" means toward the user agent.

   A "proxy" is a message-forwarding agent that is selected by the
   client, usually via local configuration rules, to receive requests
   for some type(s) of absolute URI and attempt to satisfy those
   requests via translation through the HTTP interface.  Some
   translations are minimal, such as for proxy requests for "http" URIs,
   whereas other requests might require translation to and from entirely
   different application-level protocols.  Proxies are often used to
   group an organization's HTTP requests through a common intermediary
   for the sake of security, annotation services, or shared caching.
   Some proxies are designed to apply transformations to selected
   messages or payloads while they are being forwarded, as described in
   Section 5.6.2.

   A "gateway" (a.k.a. "reverse proxy") is an intermediary that acts as
   an origin server for the outbound connection but translates received
   requests and forwards them inbound to another server or servers.
   Gateways are often used to encapsulate legacy or untrusted
   information services, to improve server performance through
   "accelerator" caching, and to enable partitioning or load balancing
   of HTTP services across multiple machines.

   All HTTP requirements applicable to an origin server also apply to
   the outbound communication of a gateway.  A gateway communicates with
   inbound servers using any protocol that it desires, including private
   extensions to HTTP that are outside the scope of this specification.
   However, an HTTP-to-HTTP gateway that wishes to interoperate with
   third-party HTTP servers ought to conform to user agent requirements
   on the gateway's inbound connection.

   A "tunnel" acts as a blind relay between two connections without
   changing the messages.  Once active, a tunnel is not considered a
   party to the HTTP communication, though the tunnel might have been
   initiated by an HTTP request.  A tunnel ceases to exist when both
   ends of the relayed connection are closed.  Tunnels are used to
   extend a virtual connection through an intermediary, such as when
   Transport Layer Security (TLS, [RFC5246]) is used to establish
   confidential communication through a shared firewall proxy.

   The above categories for intermediary only consider those acting as
   participants in the HTTP communication.  There are also
   intermediaries that can act on lower layers of the network protocol
   stack, filtering or redirecting HTTP traffic without the knowledge or
   permission of message senders.  Network intermediaries are
   indistinguishable (at a protocol level) from a man-in-the-middle
   attack, often introducing security flaws or interoperability problems
   due to mistakenly violating HTTP semantics.

   For example, an "interception proxy" [RFC3040] (also commonly known
   as a "transparent proxy" [RFC1919] or "captive portal") differs from
   an HTTP proxy because it is not selected by the client.  Instead, an
   interception proxy filters or redirects outgoing TCP port 80 packets
   (and occasionally other common port traffic).  Interception proxies
   are commonly found on public network access points, as a means of
   enforcing account subscription prior to allowing use of non-local
   Internet services, and within corporate firewalls to enforce network
   usage policies.

   HTTP is defined as a stateless protocol, meaning that each request
   message can be understood in isolation.  Many implementations depend
   on HTTP's stateless design in order to reuse proxied connections or
   dynamically load balance requests across multiple servers.  Hence, a
   server MUST NOT assume that two requests on the same connection are
   from the same user agent unless the connection is secured and
   specific to that agent.  Some non-standard HTTP extensions (e.g.,
   [RFC4559]) have been known to violate this requirement, resulting in
   security and interoperability problems.

2.3.  Caches

   A "cache" is a local store of previous response messages and the
   subsystem that controls its message storage, retrieval, and deletion.
   A cache stores cacheable responses in order to reduce the response
   time and network bandwidth consumption on future, equivalent
   requests.  Any client or server MAY employ a cache, though a cache
   cannot be used by a server while it is acting as a tunnel.

   The effect of a cache is that the request/response chain is shortened
   if one of the participants along the chain has a cached response
   applicable to that request.  The following illustrates the resulting
   chain if B has a cached copy of an earlier response from O (via C)
   for a request that has not been cached by UA or A.

               >             >
          UA =========== A =========== B - - - - - - C - - - - - - O
                     <             <

   A response is "cacheable" if a cache is allowed to store a copy of
   the response message for use in answering subsequent requests.  Even
   when a response is cacheable, there might be additional constraints
   placed by the client or by the origin server on when that cached
   response can be used for a particular request.  HTTP requirements for
   cache behavior and cacheable responses are defined in Section 2 of
   [Caching].

   There is a wide variety of architectures and configurations of caches
   deployed across the World Wide Web and inside large organizations.
   These include national hierarchies of proxy caches to save
   transoceanic bandwidth, collaborative systems that broadcast or
   multicast cache entries, archives of pre-fetched cache entries for
   use in off-line or high-latency environments, and so on.

2.4.  Uniform Resource Identifiers

   Uniform Resource Identifiers (URIs) [RFC3986] are used throughout
   HTTP as the means for identifying resources (Section 2.5).  URI
   references are used to target requests, indicate redirects, and
   define relationships.

   The definitions of "URI-reference", "absolute-URI", "relative-part",
   "authority", "port", "host", "path-abempty", "segment", "query", and
   "fragment" are adopted from the URI generic syntax.  An "absolute-
   path" rule is defined for protocol elements that can contain a non-
   empty path component.  (This rule differs slightly from the path-
   abempty rule of RFC 3986, which allows for an empty path to be used
   in references, and path-absolute rule, which does not allow paths
   that begin with "//".)  A "partial-URI" rule is defined for protocol
   elements that can contain a relative URI but not a fragment
   component.

     URI-reference = <URI-reference, see [RFC3986], Section 4.1>
     absolute-URI  = <absolute-URI, see [RFC3986], Section 4.3>
     relative-part = <relative-part, see [RFC3986], Section 4.2>
     authority     = <authority, see [RFC3986], Section 3.2>
     uri-host      = <host, see [RFC3986], Section 3.2.2>
     port          = <port, see [RFC3986], Section 3.2.3>
     path-abempty  = <path-abempty, see [RFC3986], Section 3.3>
     segment       = <segment, see [RFC3986], Section 3.3>
     query         = <query, see [RFC3986], Section 3.4>
     fragment      = <fragment, see [RFC3986], Section 3.5>

     absolute-path = 1*( "/" segment )
     partial-URI   = relative-part [ "?" query ]

   Each protocol element in HTTP that allows a URI reference will
   indicate in its ABNF production whether the element allows any form
   of reference (URI-reference), only a URI in absolute form (absolute-
   URI), only the path and optional query components, or some
   combination of the above.  Unless otherwise indicated, URI references
   are parsed relative to the effective request URI (Section 5.3).

2.5.  Resources

   The target of an HTTP request is called a "resource".  HTTP does not
   limit the nature of a resource; it merely defines an interface that
   might be used to interact with resources.  Each resource is
   identified by a Uniform Resource Identifier (URI), as described in
   Section 2.4.

   One design goal of HTTP is to separate resource identification from
   request semantics, which is made possible by vesting the request
   semantics in the request method (Section 7) and a few request-
   modifying header fields (Section 8).  If there is a conflict between
   the method semantics and any semantic implied by the URI itself, as
   described in Section 7.2.1, the method semantics take precedence.

   IANA maintains the registry of URI Schemes [BCP115] at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/uri-schemes/>.  [[CREF2: Although
   requests might target any URI scheme, the following schemes are
   inherent to HTTP servers:]]

   +------------+------------------------------------+---------------+
   | URI Scheme | Description                        | Reference     |
   +------------+------------------------------------+---------------+
   | http       | Hypertext Transfer Protocol        | Section 2.5.1 |
   | https      | Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure | Section 2.5.2 |
   +------------+------------------------------------+---------------+

2.5.1.  http URI Scheme

   The "http" URI scheme is hereby defined for the purpose of minting
   identifiers according to their association with the hierarchical
   namespace governed by a potential HTTP origin server listening for
   TCP ([RFC0793]) connections on a given port.

     http-URI = "http:" "//" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]
                [ "#" fragment ]

   The origin server for an "http" URI is identified by the authority
   component, which includes a host identifier and optional TCP port
   ([RFC3986], Section 3.2.2).  The hierarchical path component and
   optional query component serve as an identifier for a potential
   target resource within that origin server's name space.  The optional
   fragment component allows for indirect identification of a secondary
   resource, independent of the URI scheme, as defined in Section 3.5 of
   [RFC3986].

   A sender MUST NOT generate an "http" URI with an empty host
   identifier.  A recipient that processes such a URI reference MUST
   reject it as invalid.

   If the host identifier is provided as an IP address, the origin
   server is the listener (if any) on the indicated TCP port at that IP
   address.  If host is a registered name, the registered name is an
   indirect identifier for use with a name resolution service, such as
   DNS, to find an address for that origin server.  If the port
   subcomponent is empty or not given, TCP port 80 (the reserved port
   for WWW services) is the default.

   Note that the presence of a URI with a given authority component does
   not imply that there is always an HTTP server listening for
   connections on that host and port.  Anyone can mint a URI.  What the
   authority component determines is who has the right to respond
   authoritatively to requests that target the identified resource.  The
   delegated nature of registered names and IP addresses creates a
   federated namespace, based on control over the indicated host and
   port, whether or not an HTTP server is present.  See Section 12.1 for
   security considerations related to establishing authority.

   When an "http" URI is used within a context that calls for access to
   the indicated resource, a client MAY attempt access by resolving the
   host to an IP address, establishing a TCP connection to that address
   on the indicated port, and sending an HTTP request message (Section 2
   of [Messaging]) containing the URI's identifying data to the server.
   If the server responds to that request with a non-interim HTTP
   response message, as described in Section 9, then that response is
   considered an authoritative answer to the client's request.

   Although HTTP is independent of the transport protocol, the "http"
   scheme is specific to TCP-based services because the name delegation
   process depends on TCP for establishing authority.  An HTTP service
   based on some other underlying connection protocol would presumably
   be identified using a different URI scheme, just as the "https"
   scheme (below) is used for resources that require an end-to-end
   secured connection.  Other protocols might also be used to provide
   access to "http" identified resources -- it is only the authoritative
   interface that is specific to TCP.

   The URI generic syntax for authority also includes a deprecated
   userinfo subcomponent ([RFC3986], Section 3.2.1) for including user
   authentication information in the URI.  Some implementations make use
   of the userinfo component for internal configuration of
   authentication information, such as within command invocation
   options, configuration files, or bookmark lists, even though such
   usage might expose a user identifier or password.  A sender MUST NOT
   generate the userinfo subcomponent (and its "@" delimiter) when an
   "http" URI reference is generated within a message as a request
   target or header field value.  Before making use of an "http" URI
   reference received from an untrusted source, a recipient SHOULD parse
   for userinfo and treat its presence as an error; it is likely being
   used to obscure the authority for the sake of phishing attacks.

2.5.2.  https URI Scheme

   The "https" URI scheme is hereby defined for the purpose of minting
   identifiers according to their association with the hierarchical
   namespace governed by a potential HTTP origin server listening to a
   given TCP port for TLS-secured connections ([RFC5246]).

   All of the requirements listed above for the "http" scheme are also
   requirements for the "https" scheme, except that TCP port 443 is the
   default if the port subcomponent is empty or not given, and the user
   agent MUST ensure that its connection to the origin server is secured
   through the use of strong encryption, end-to-end, prior to sending
   the first HTTP request.

     https-URI = "https:" "//" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ]
                 [ "#" fragment ]

   Note that the "https" URI scheme depends on both TLS and TCP for
   establishing authority.  Resources made available via the "https"
   scheme have no shared identity with the "http" scheme even if their
   resource identifiers indicate the same authority (the same host
   listening to the same TCP port).  They are distinct namespaces and
   are considered to be distinct origin servers.  However, an extension
   to HTTP that is defined to apply to entire host domains, such as the
   Cookie protocol [RFC6265], can allow information set by one service
   to impact communication with other services within a matching group
   of host domains.

   The process for authoritative access to an "https" identified
   resource is defined in [RFC2818].

2.5.3.  http and https URI Normalization and Comparison

   Since the "http" and "https" schemes conform to the URI generic
   syntax, such URIs are normalized and compared according to the
   algorithm defined in Section 6 of [RFC3986], using the defaults
   described above for each scheme.

   If the port is equal to the default port for a scheme, the normal
   form is to omit the port subcomponent.  When not being used in
   absolute form as the request target of an OPTIONS request, an empty
   path component is equivalent to an absolute path of "/", so the
   normal form is to provide a path of "/" instead.  The scheme and host
   are case-insensitive and normally provided in lowercase; all other
   components are compared in a case-sensitive manner.  Characters other
   than those in the "reserved" set are equivalent to their percent-
   encoded octets: the normal form is to not encode them (see Sections
   2.1 and 2.2 of [RFC3986]).

   For example, the following three URIs are equivalent:

      http://example.com:80/~smith/home.html
      http://EXAMPLE.com/%7Esmith/home.html
      http://EXAMPLE.com:/%7esmith/home.html

3.  Conformance

3.1.  Implementation Diversity

   When considering the design of HTTP, it is easy to fall into a trap
   of thinking that all user agents are general-purpose browsers and all
   origin servers are large public websites.  That is not the case in
   practice.  Common HTTP user agents include household appliances,
   stereos, scales, firmware update scripts, command-line programs,
   mobile apps, and communication devices in a multitude of shapes and
   sizes.  Likewise, common HTTP origin servers include home automation
   units, configurable networking components, office machines,
   autonomous robots, news feeds, traffic cameras, ad selectors, and
   video-delivery platforms.

   The term "user agent" does not imply that there is a human user
   directly interacting with the software agent at the time of a
   request.  In many cases, a user agent is installed or configured to
   run in the background and save its results for later inspection (or
   save only a subset of those results that might be interesting or
   erroneous).  Spiders, for example, are typically given a start URI
   and configured to follow certain behavior while crawling the Web as a
   hypertext graph.

   The implementation diversity of HTTP means that not all user agents
   can make interactive suggestions to their user or provide adequate
   warning for security or privacy concerns.  In the few cases where
   this specification requires reporting of errors to the user, it is
   acceptable for such reporting to only be observable in an error
   console or log file.  Likewise, requirements that an automated action
   be confirmed by the user before proceeding might be met via advance
   configuration choices, run-time options, or simple avoidance of the
   unsafe action; confirmation does not imply any specific user
   interface or interruption of normal processing if the user has
   already made that choice.

3.2.  Role-based Requirements

   This specification targets conformance criteria according to the role
   of a participant in HTTP communication.  Hence, HTTP requirements are
   placed on senders, recipients, clients, servers, user agents,
   intermediaries, origin servers, proxies, gateways, or caches,
   depending on what behavior is being constrained by the requirement.
   Additional (social) requirements are placed on implementations,
   resource owners, and protocol element registrations when they apply
   beyond the scope of a single communication.

   The verb "generate" is used instead of "send" where a requirement
   differentiates between creating a protocol element and merely
   forwarding a received element downstream.

   An implementation is considered conformant if it complies with all of
   the requirements associated with the roles it partakes in HTTP.

   Conformance includes both the syntax and semantics of protocol
   elements.  A sender MUST NOT generate protocol elements that convey a
   meaning that is known by that sender to be false.  A sender MUST NOT
   generate protocol elements that do not match the grammar defined by
   the corresponding ABNF rules.  Within a given message, a sender MUST
   NOT generate protocol elements or syntax alternatives that are only
   allowed to be generated by participants in other roles (i.e., a role
   that the sender does not have for that message).

3.3.  Parsing Elements

   When a received protocol element is parsed, the recipient MUST be
   able to parse any value of reasonable length that is applicable to
   the recipient's role and that matches the grammar defined by the
   corresponding ABNF rules.  Note, however, that some received protocol
   elements might not be parsed.  For example, an intermediary
   forwarding a message might parse a header-field into generic field-
   name and field-value components, but then forward the header field
   without further parsing inside the field-value.

   HTTP does not have specific length limitations for many of its
   protocol elements because the lengths that might be appropriate will
   vary widely, depending on the deployment context and purpose of the
   implementation.  Hence, interoperability between senders and
   recipients depends on shared expectations regarding what is a
   reasonable length for each protocol element.  Furthermore, what is
   commonly understood to be a reasonable length for some protocol
   elements has changed over the course of the past two decades of HTTP
   use and is expected to continue changing in the future.

   At a minimum, a recipient MUST be able to parse and process protocol
   element lengths that are at least as long as the values that it
   generates for those same protocol elements in other messages.  For
   example, an origin server that publishes very long URI references to
   its own resources needs to be able to parse and process those same
   references when received as a request target.

3.4.  Error Handling

   A recipient MUST interpret a received protocol element according to
   the semantics defined for it by this specification, including
   extensions to this specification, unless the recipient has determined
   (through experience or configuration) that the sender incorrectly
   implements what is implied by those semantics.  For example, an
   origin server might disregard the contents of a received Accept-
   Encoding header field if inspection of the User-Agent header field
   indicates a specific implementation version that is known to fail on
   receipt of certain content codings.

   Unless noted otherwise, a recipient MAY attempt to recover a usable
   protocol element from an invalid construct.  HTTP does not define
   specific error handling mechanisms except when they have a direct
   impact on security, since different applications of the protocol
   require different error handling strategies.  For example, a Web
   browser might wish to transparently recover from a response where the
   Location header field doesn't parse according to the ABNF, whereas a
   systems control client might consider any form of error recovery to
   be dangerous.

3.5.  Protocol Versioning

   The HTTP version number consists of two decimal digits separated by a
   "." (period or decimal point).  The first digit ("major version")
   indicates the HTTP messaging syntax, whereas the second digit ("minor
   version") indicates the highest minor version within that major
   version to which the sender is conformant and able to understand for
   future communication.

   The protocol version as a whole indicates the sender's conformance
   with the set of requirements laid out in that version's corresponding
   specification of HTTP.  [[CREF3: For example, the version "HTTP/1.1"
   is defined by the combined specifications of this document, "HTTP
   Caching" [Caching], and "HTTP/1.1 Messaging" [Messaging].  ]]

   The minor version advertises the sender's communication capabilities
   even when the sender is only using a backwards-compatible subset of
   the protocol, thereby letting the recipient know that more advanced
   features can be used in response (by servers) or in future requests
   (by clients).

   A client SHOULD send a request version equal to the highest version
   to which the client is conformant and whose major version is no
   higher than the highest version supported by the server, if this is
   known.  A client MUST NOT send a version to which it is not
   conformant.

   A client MAY send a lower request version if it is known that the
   server incorrectly implements the HTTP specification, but only after
   the client has attempted at least one normal request and determined
   from the response status code or header fields (e.g., Server) that
   the server improperly handles higher request versions.

   A server SHOULD send a response version equal to the highest version
   to which the server is conformant that has a major version less than
   or equal to the one received in the request.  A server MUST NOT send
   a version to which it is not conformant.  A server can send a 505
   (HTTP Version Not Supported) response if it wishes, for any reason,
   to refuse service of the client's major protocol version.

   HTTP's major version number is incremented when an incompatible
   message syntax is introduced.  The minor number is incremented when
   changes made to the protocol have the effect of adding to the message
   semantics or implying additional capabilities of the sender.

   When an HTTP message is received with a major version number that the
   recipient implements, but a higher minor version number than what the
   recipient implements, the recipient SHOULD process the message as if
   it were in the highest minor version within that major version to
   which the recipient is conformant.  A recipient can assume that a
   message with a higher minor version, when sent to a recipient that
   has not yet indicated support for that higher version, is
   sufficiently backwards-compatible to be safely processed by any
   implementation of the same major version.

   [[CREF4: When a major version of HTTP does not define any minor
   versions, the minor version "0" is implied and ought to be used when
   referring to that protocol within a protocol element that requires
   sending a minor version.  ]]

4.  Message Abstraction

   [[CREF5: Each major version of HTTP defines its own syntax for the
   inclusion of information in messages.  Nevertheless, a common
   abstraction is that a message includes some form of envelope/framing,
   a potential set of named data fields, and a potential body.  This
   section defines the abstraction for message fields as field-name and
   field-value pairs.  ]]

4.1.  Field Names

   Header fields are key:value pairs that can be used to communicate
   data about the message, its payload, the target resource, or the
   connection (i.e., control data).

   The requirements for header field names are defined in [BCP90].

   The field-name token labels the corresponding field-value as having
   the semantics defined by that header field.  For example, the Date
   header field is defined in Section 10.1.1.2 as containing the
   origination timestamp for the message in which it appears.

     field-name     = token

   The interpretation of a header field does not change between minor
   versions of the same major HTTP version, though the default behavior
   of a recipient in the absence of such a field can change.  Unless
   specified otherwise, header fields are defined for all versions of
   HTTP.  In particular, the Host and Connection header fields ought to
   be implemented by all HTTP/1.x implementations whether or not they
   advertise conformance with HTTP/1.1.

   New header fields can be introduced without changing the protocol
   version if their defined semantics allow them to be safely ignored by
   recipients that do not recognize them.  Header field extensibility is
   discussed in Section 4.1.2.

   The following field names are defined by this document:

   +---------------------+----------+----------+-------------------+
   | Header Field Name   | Protocol | Status   | Reference         |
   +---------------------+----------+----------+-------------------+
   | Accept              | http     | standard | Section 8.4.2     |
   | Accept-Charset      | http     | standard | Section 8.4.3     |
   | Accept-Encoding     | http     | standard | Section 8.4.4     |
   | Accept-Language     | http     | standard | Section 8.4.5     |
   | Accept-Ranges       | http     | standard | Section 10.4.1    |
   | Allow               | http     | standard | Section 10.4.2    |
   | Authorization       | http     | standard | Section 8.5.3     |
   | Content-Encoding    | http     | standard | Section 6.2.2     |
   | Content-Language    | http     | standard | Section 6.2.3     |
   | Content-Length      | http     | standard | Section 6.2.4     |
   | Content-Location    | http     | standard | Section 6.2.5     |
   | Content-Range       | http     | standard | Section 6.3.3     |
   | Content-Type        | http     | standard | Section 6.2.1     |
   | Date                | http     | standard | Section 10.1.1.2  |
   | ETag                | http     | standard | Section 10.2.3    |
   | Expect              | http     | standard | Section 8.1.1     |
   | From                | http     | standard | Section 8.6.1     |
   | Host                | http     | standard | Section 5.4       |
   | If-Match            | http     | standard | Section 8.2.3     |
   | If-Modified-Since   | http     | standard | Section 8.2.5     |
   | If-None-Match       | http     | standard | Section 8.2.4     |
   | If-Range            | http     | standard | Section 8.2.7     |
   | If-Unmodified-Since | http     | standard | Section 8.2.6     |
   | Last-Modified       | http     | standard | Section 10.2.2    |
   | Location            | http     | standard | Section 10.1.2    |
   | Max-Forwards        | http     | standard | Section 8.1.2     |
   | Proxy-Authenticate  | http     | standard | Section 10.3.2    |
   | Proxy-Authorization | http     | standard | Section 8.5.4     |
   | Range               | http     | standard | Section 8.3       |
   | Referer             | http     | standard | Section 8.6.2     |
   | Retry-After         | http     | standard | Section 10.1.3    |
   | Server              | http     | standard | Section 10.4.3    |
   | Trailer             | http     | standard | Section 4.4       |
   | User-Agent          | http     | standard | Section 8.6.3     |
   | Vary                | http     | standard | Section 10.1.4    |
   | Via                 | http     | standard | Section 5.6.1     |
   | WWW-Authenticate    | http     | standard | Section 10.3.1    |
   +---------------------+----------+----------+-------------------+

4.1.1.  Field Name Registry

   HTTP header fields are registered within the "Message Headers"
   registry located at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/message-
   headers>, as defined by [BCP90], with the protocol "http".

4.1.2.  Field Extensibility

   Header fields are fully extensible: there is no limit on the
   introduction of new field names, each presumably defining new
   semantics, nor on the number of header fields used in a given
   message.  Existing fields are defined in each part of this
   specification and in many other specifications outside this document
   set.

   New header fields can be defined such that, when they are understood
   by a recipient, they might override or enhance the interpretation of
   previously defined header fields, define preconditions on request
   evaluation, or refine the meaning of responses.

   A proxy MUST forward unrecognized header fields unless the field-name
   is listed in the Connection header field (Section 9.1 of [Messaging])
   or the proxy is specifically configured to block, or otherwise
   transform, such fields.  Other recipients SHOULD ignore unrecognized
   header fields.  These requirements allow HTTP's functionality to be
   enhanced without requiring prior update of deployed intermediaries.

   All defined header fields ought to be registered with IANA in the
   "Message Headers" registry.

4.1.3.  Considerations for New Fields

   Authors of specifications defining new fields are advised to keep the
   name as short as practical and not to prefix the name with "X-"
   unless the header field will never be used on the Internet.  (The
   "X-" prefix idiom has been extensively misused in practice; it was
   intended to only be used as a mechanism for avoiding name collisions
   inside proprietary software or intranet processing, since the prefix
   would ensure that private names never collide with a newly registered
   Internet name; see [BCP178] for further information).

   Authors of specifications defining new header fields are advised to
   consider documenting:

   o  Whether the field is a single value or whether it can be a list
      (delimited by commas; see Section 5 of [Messaging]).

      If it does not use the list syntax, document how to treat messages
      where the field occurs multiple times (a sensible default would be
      to ignore the field, but this might not always be the right
      choice).

      Note that intermediaries and software libraries might combine
      multiple header field instances into a single one, despite the
      field's definition not allowing the list syntax.  A robust format
      enables recipients to discover these situations (good example:
      "Content-Type", as the comma can only appear inside quoted
      strings; bad example: "Location", as a comma can occur inside a
      URI).

   o  Under what conditions the header field can be used; e.g., only in
      responses or requests, in all messages, only on responses to a
      particular request method, etc.

   o  Whether the field should be stored by origin servers that
      understand it upon a PUT request.

   o  Whether the field semantics are further refined by the context,
      such as by existing request methods or status codes.

   o  Whether it is appropriate to list the field-name in the Connection
      header field (i.e., if the header field is to be hop-by-hop; see
      Section 9.1 of [Messaging]).

   o  Under what conditions intermediaries are allowed to insert,
      delete, or modify the field's value.

   o  Whether it is appropriate to list the field-name in a Vary
      response header field (e.g., when the request header field is used
      by an origin server's content selection algorithm; see
      Section 10.1.4).

   o  Whether the header field is useful or allowable in trailers (see
      Section 7.1 of [Messaging]).

   o  Whether the header field ought to be preserved across redirects.

   o  Whether it introduces any additional security considerations, such
      as disclosure of privacy-related data.

4.2.  Field Values

   This specification does not use ABNF rules to define each "Field-
   Name: Field Value" pair, as was done in earlier editions.  Instead,
   this specification uses ABNF rules that are named according to each
   registered field name, wherein the rule defines the valid grammar for
   that field's corresponding field values (i.e., after the field-value
   has been extracted by a generic field parser).

     field-value    = *( field-content / obs-fold )
     field-content  = field-vchar [ 1*( SP / HTAB ) field-vchar ]
     field-vchar    = VCHAR / obs-text

   Historically, HTTP header field values could be extended over
   multiple lines by preceding each extra line with at least one space
   or horizontal tab (obs-fold).  [[CREF6: This document assumes that
   any such obs-fold has been replaced with one or more SP octets prior
   to interpreting the field value, as described in Section 5.2 of
   [Messaging].]]

   Historically, HTTP has allowed field content with text in the
   ISO-8859-1 charset [ISO-8859-1], supporting other charsets only
   through use of [RFC2047] encoding.  In practice, most HTTP header
   field values use only a subset of the US-ASCII charset [USASCII].
   Newly defined header fields SHOULD limit their field values to
   US-ASCII octets.  A recipient SHOULD treat other octets in field
   content (obs-text) as opaque data.

4.2.1.  Field Order

   The order in which header fields with differing field names are
   received is not significant.  However, it is good practice to send
   header fields that contain control data first, such as Host on
   requests and Date on responses, so that implementations can decide
   when not to handle a message as early as possible.  A server MUST NOT
   apply a request to the target resource until the entire request
   header section is received, since later header fields might include
   conditionals, authentication credentials, or deliberately misleading
   duplicate header fields that would impact request processing.

   A sender MUST NOT generate multiple header fields with the same field
   name in a message unless either the entire field value for that
   header field is defined as a comma-separated list [i.e., #(values)]
   or the header field is a well-known exception (as noted below).

   A recipient MAY combine multiple header fields with the same field
   name into one "field-name: field-value" pair, without changing the
   semantics of the message, by appending each subsequent field value to
   the combined field value in order, separated by a comma.  The order
   in which header fields with the same field name are received is
   therefore significant to the interpretation of the combined field
   value; a proxy MUST NOT change the order of these field values when
   forwarding a message.

      Note: In practice, the "Set-Cookie" header field ([RFC6265]) often
      appears multiple times in a response message and does not use the
      list syntax, violating the above requirements on multiple header
      fields with the same name.  Since it cannot be combined into a
      single field-value, recipients ought to handle "Set-Cookie" as a
      special case while processing header fields.  (See Appendix A.2.3
      of [Kri2001] for details.)

4.2.2.  Field Limits

   HTTP does not place a predefined limit on the length of each header
   field or on the length of the header section as a whole, as described
   in Section 3.  Various ad hoc limitations on individual header field
   length are found in practice, often depending on the specific field
   semantics.

   A server that receives a request header field, or set of fields,
   larger than it wishes to process MUST respond with an appropriate 4xx
   (Client Error) status code.  Ignoring such header fields would
   increase the server's vulnerability to request smuggling attacks
   (Section 11.2 of [Messaging]).

   A client MAY discard or truncate received header fields that are
   larger than the client wishes to process if the field semantics are
   such that the dropped value(s) can be safely ignored without changing
   the message framing or response semantics.

4.2.3.  Field Value Components

   Most HTTP header field values are defined using common syntax
   components (token, quoted-string, and comment) separated by
   whitespace or specific delimiting characters.  Delimiters are chosen
   from the set of US-ASCII visual characters not allowed in a token
   (DQUOTE and "(),/:;<=>?@[\]{}").

     token          = 1*tchar

     tchar          = "!" / "#" / "$" / "%" / "&" / "'" / "*"
                    / "+" / "-" / "." / "^" / "_" / "`" / "|" / "~"
                    / DIGIT / ALPHA
                    ; any VCHAR, except delimiters

   A string of text is parsed as a single value if it is quoted using
   double-quote marks.

     quoted-string  = DQUOTE *( qdtext / quoted-pair ) DQUOTE
     qdtext         = HTAB / SP /%x21 / %x23-5B / %x5D-7E / obs-text
     obs-text       = %x80-FF

   Comments can be included in some HTTP header fields by surrounding
   the comment text with parentheses.  Comments are only allowed in
   fields containing "comment" as part of their field value definition.

     comment        = "(" *( ctext / quoted-pair / comment ) ")"
     ctext          = HTAB / SP / %x21-27 / %x2A-5B / %x5D-7E / obs-text

   The backslash octet ("\") can be used as a single-octet quoting
   mechanism within quoted-string and comment constructs.  Recipients
   that process the value of a quoted-string MUST handle a quoted-pair
   as if it were replaced by the octet following the backslash.

     quoted-pair    = "\" ( HTAB / SP / VCHAR / obs-text )

   A sender SHOULD NOT generate a quoted-pair in a quoted-string except
   where necessary to quote DQUOTE and backslash octets occurring within
   that string.  A sender SHOULD NOT generate a quoted-pair in a comment
   except where necessary to quote parentheses ["(" and ")"] and
   backslash octets occurring within that comment.

4.2.4.  Designing New Field Values

   New header field values typically have their syntax defined using
   ABNF ([RFC5234]), using the extension defined in Section 11 as
   necessary, and are usually constrained to the range of US-ASCII
   characters.  Header fields needing a greater range of characters can
   use an encoding such as the one defined in [RFC5987].

   Leading and trailing whitespace in raw field values is removed upon
   field parsing (Section 5.1 of [Messaging]).  Field definitions where
   leading or trailing whitespace in values is significant will have to
   use a container syntax such as quoted-string (Section 4.2.3).

   Because commas (",") are used as a generic delimiter between field-
   values, they need to be treated with care if they are allowed in the
   field-value.  Typically, components that might contain a comma are
   protected with double-quotes using the quoted-string ABNF production.

   For example, a textual date and a URI (either of which might contain
   a comma) could be safely carried in field-values like these:

     Example-URI-Field: "http://example.com/a.html,foo",
                        "http://without-a-comma.example.com/"
     Example-Date-Field: "Sat, 04 May 1996", "Wed, 14 Sep 2005"

   Note that double-quote delimiters almost always are used with the
   quoted-string production; using a different syntax inside double-
   quotes will likely cause unnecessary confusion.

   Many header fields use a format including (case-insensitively) named
   parameters (for instance, Content-Type, defined in Section 6.2.1).
   Allowing both unquoted (token) and quoted (quoted-string) syntax for
   the parameter value enables recipients to use existing parser
   components.  When allowing both forms, the meaning of a parameter
   value ought to be independent of the syntax used for it (for an
   example, see the notes on parameter handling for media types in
   Section 6.1.1).

4.3.  Whitespace

   This specification uses three rules to denote the use of linear
   whitespace: OWS (optional whitespace), RWS (required whitespace), and
   BWS ("bad" whitespace).

   The OWS rule is used where zero or more linear whitespace octets
   might appear.  For protocol elements where optional whitespace is
   preferred to improve readability, a sender SHOULD generate the
   optional whitespace as a single SP; otherwise, a sender SHOULD NOT
   generate optional whitespace except as needed to white out invalid or
   unwanted protocol elements during in-place message filtering.

   The RWS rule is used when at least one linear whitespace octet is
   required to separate field tokens.  A sender SHOULD generate RWS as a
   single SP.

   The BWS rule is used where the grammar allows optional whitespace
   only for historical reasons.  A sender MUST NOT generate BWS in
   messages.  A recipient MUST parse for such bad whitespace and remove
   it before interpreting the protocol element.

     OWS            = *( SP / HTAB )
                    ; optional whitespace
     RWS            = 1*( SP / HTAB )
                    ; required whitespace
     BWS            = OWS
                    ; "bad" whitespace

4.4.  Trailer

   [[CREF7: The "Trailer" header field in a message indicates fields
   that the sender anticipates sending after the message header block
   (i.e., during or after the payload is sent).  This is typically used
   to supply metadata that might be dynamically generated while the data
   is sent, such as a message integrity check, digital signature, or
   post-processing status.  ]]

     Trailer = 1#field-name

   [[CREF8: How, where, and when trailer fields might be sent depends on
   both the protocol in use (HTTP version and/or transfer coding) and
   the semantics of each named header field.  Many header fields cannot
   be processed outside the header section because their evaluation is
   necessary for message routing, authentication, or configuration prior
   to receiving the representation data.  ]]

5.  Message Routing

   HTTP request message routing is determined by each client based on
   the target resource, the client's proxy configuration, and
   establishment or reuse of an inbound connection.  The corresponding
   response routing follows the same connection chain back to the
   client.

5.1.  Identifying a Target Resource

   HTTP is used in a wide variety of applications, ranging from general-
   purpose computers to home appliances.  In some cases, communication
   options are hard-coded in a client's configuration.  However, most
   HTTP clients rely on the same resource identification mechanism and
   configuration techniques as general-purpose Web browsers.

   HTTP communication is initiated by a user agent for some purpose.
   The purpose is a combination of request semantics and a target
   resource upon which to apply those semantics.  A URI reference
   (Section 2.4) is typically used as an identifier for the "target
   resource", which a user agent would resolve to its absolute form in
   order to obtain the "target URI".  The target URI excludes the
   reference's fragment component, if any, since fragment identifiers
   are reserved for client-side processing ([RFC3986], Section 3.5).

5.2.  Routing Inbound

   Once the target URI is determined, a client needs to decide whether a
   network request is necessary to accomplish the desired semantics and,
   if so, where that request is to be directed.

   If the client has a cache [Caching] and the request can be satisfied
   by it, then the request is usually directed there first.

   If the request is not satisfied by a cache, then a typical client
   will check its configuration to determine whether a proxy is to be
   used to satisfy the request.  Proxy configuration is implementation-
   dependent, but is often based on URI prefix matching, selective
   authority matching, or both, and the proxy itself is usually
   identified by an "http" or "https" URI.  If a proxy is applicable,
   the client connects inbound by establishing (or reusing) a connection
   to that proxy.

   If no proxy is applicable, a typical client will invoke a handler
   routine, usually specific to the target URI's scheme, to connect
   directly to an authority for the target resource.  How that is
   accomplished is dependent on the target URI scheme and defined by its
   associated specification, similar to how this specification defines
   origin server access for resolution of the "http" (Section 2.5.1) and
   "https" (Section 2.5.2) schemes.

   HTTP requirements regarding connection management are defined in
   Section 9 of [Messaging].

5.3.  Effective Request URI

   Once an inbound connection is obtained, the client sends an HTTP
   request message (Section 2 of [Messaging]).

   [[CREF9: Depending on the nature of the request, the client's target
   URI might be split into components and transmitted (or implied)
   within various parts of a request message.  These parts are
   recombined by each recipient, in accordance with their local
   configuration and incoming connection context, to form an "effective
   request URI" for identifying the intended target resource with
   respect to that server.  Section 3.3 of [Messaging] defines how a
   server determines the effective request URI for an HTTP/1.1
   request.]]

   For a user agent, the effective request URI is the target URI.

   Once the effective request URI has been constructed, an origin server
   needs to decide whether or not to provide service for that URI via
   the connection in which the request was received.  For example, the
   request might have been misdirected, deliberately or accidentally,
   such that the information within a received request-target or Host
   header field differs from the host or port upon which the connection
   has been made.  If the connection is from a trusted gateway, that
   inconsistency might be expected; otherwise, it might indicate an
   attempt to bypass security filters, trick the server into delivering
   non-public content, or poison a cache.  See Section 12 for security
   considerations regarding message routing.

5.4.  Host

   The "Host" header field in a request provides the host and port
   information from the target URI, enabling the origin server to
   distinguish among resources while servicing requests for multiple
   host names on a single IP address.

     Host = uri-host [ ":" port ] ; Section 2.4

   A client MUST send a Host header field in all HTTP/1.1 request
   messages.  If the target URI includes an authority component, then a
   client MUST send a field-value for Host that is identical to that
   authority component, excluding any userinfo subcomponent and its "@"
   delimiter (Section 2.5.1).  If the authority component is missing or
   undefined for the target URI, then a client MUST send a Host header
   field with an empty field-value.

   Since the Host field-value is critical information for handling a
   request, a user agent SHOULD generate Host as the first header field
   following the request-line.

   For example, a GET request to the origin server for
   <http://www.example.org/pub/WWW/> would begin with:

     GET /pub/WWW/ HTTP/1.1
     Host: www.example.org

   A client MUST send a Host header field in an HTTP/1.1 request even if
   the request-target is in the absolute-form, since this allows the
   Host information to be forwarded through ancient HTTP/1.0 proxies
   that might not have implemented Host.

   When a proxy receives a request with an absolute-form of request-
   target, the proxy MUST ignore the received Host header field (if any)
   and instead replace it with the host information of the request-
   target.  A proxy that forwards such a request MUST generate a new
   Host field-value based on the received request-target rather than
   forward the received Host field-value.

   Since the Host header field acts as an application-level routing
   mechanism, it is a frequent target for malware seeking to poison a
   shared cache or redirect a request to an unintended server.  An
   interception proxy is particularly vulnerable if it relies on the
   Host field-value for redirecting requests to internal servers, or for
   use as a cache key in a shared cache, without first verifying that
   the intercepted connection is targeting a valid IP address for that
   host.

   A server MUST respond with a 400 (Bad Request) status code to any
   HTTP/1.1 request message that lacks a Host header field and to any
   request message that contains more than one Host header field or a
   Host header field with an invalid field-value.

5.5.  Associating a Response to a Request

   HTTP does not include a request identifier for associating a given
   request message with its corresponding one or more response messages.
   Hence, it relies on the order of response arrival to correspond
   exactly to the order in which requests are made on the same
   connection.  More than one response message per request only occurs
   when one or more informational responses (1xx, see Section 9.2)
   precede a final response to the same request.

   A client that has more than one outstanding request on a connection
   MUST maintain a list of outstanding requests in the order sent and
   MUST associate each received response message on that connection to
   the highest ordered request that has not yet received a final (non-
   1xx) response.

5.6.  Message Forwarding

   As described in Section 2.2, intermediaries can serve a variety of
   roles in the processing of HTTP requests and responses.  Some
   intermediaries are used to improve performance or availability.
   Others are used for access control or to filter content.  Since an
   HTTP stream has characteristics similar to a pipe-and-filter
   architecture, there are no inherent limits to the extent an
   intermediary can enhance (or interfere) with either direction of the
   stream.

   An intermediary not acting as a tunnel MUST implement the Connection
   header field, as specified in Section 9.1 of [Messaging], and exclude
   fields from being forwarded that are only intended for the incoming
   connection.

   An intermediary MUST NOT forward a message to itself unless it is
   protected from an infinite request loop.  In general, an intermediary
   ought to recognize its own server names, including any aliases, local
   variations, or literal IP addresses, and respond to such requests
   directly.

   An HTTP message can be parsed as a stream for incremental processing
   or forwarding downstream.  However, recipients cannot rely on
   incremental delivery of partial messages, since some implementations
   will buffer or delay message forwarding for the sake of network
   efficiency, security checks, or payload transformations.

5.6.1.  Via

   The "Via" header field indicates the presence of intermediate
   protocols and recipients between the user agent and the server (on
   requests) or between the origin server and the client (on responses),
   similar to the "Received" header field in email (Section 3.6.7 of
   [RFC5322]).  Via can be used for tracking message forwards, avoiding
   request loops, and identifying the protocol capabilities of senders
   along the request/response chain.

     Via = 1#( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS comment ] )

     received-protocol = [ protocol-name "/" ] protocol-version
                         ; see [Messaging], Section 9.7
     received-by       = ( uri-host [ ":" port ] ) / pseudonym
     pseudonym         = token

   Multiple Via field values represent each proxy or gateway that has
   forwarded the message.  Each intermediary appends its own information
   about how the message was received, such that the end result is
   ordered according to the sequence of forwarding recipients.

   A proxy MUST send an appropriate Via header field, as described
   below, in each message that it forwards.  An HTTP-to-HTTP gateway
   MUST send an appropriate Via header field in each inbound request
   message and MAY send a Via header field in forwarded response
   messages.

   For each intermediary, the received-protocol indicates the protocol
   and protocol version used by the upstream sender of the message.
   Hence, the Via field value records the advertised protocol
   capabilities of the request/response chain such that they remain
   visible to downstream recipients; this can be useful for determining
   what backwards-incompatible features might be safe to use in
   response, or within a later request, as described in Section 3.5.
   For brevity, the protocol-name is omitted when the received protocol
   is HTTP.

   The received-by portion of the field value is normally the host and
   optional port number of a recipient server or client that
   subsequently forwarded the message.  However, if the real host is
   considered to be sensitive information, a sender MAY replace it with
   a pseudonym.  If a port is not provided, a recipient MAY interpret
   that as meaning it was received on the default TCP port, if any, for
   the received-protocol.

   A sender MAY generate comments in the Via header field to identify
   the software of each recipient, analogous to the User-Agent and
   Server header fields.  However, all comments in the Via field are
   optional, and a recipient MAY remove them prior to forwarding the
   message.

   For example, a request message could be sent from an HTTP/1.0 user
   agent to an internal proxy code-named "fred", which uses HTTP/1.1 to
   forward the request to a public proxy at p.example.net, which
   completes the request by forwarding it to the origin server at
   www.example.com.  The request received by www.example.com would then
   have the following Via header field:

     Via: 1.0 fred, 1.1 p.example.net

   An intermediary used as a portal through a network firewall SHOULD
   NOT forward the names and ports of hosts within the firewall region
   unless it is explicitly enabled to do so.  If not enabled, such an
   intermediary SHOULD replace each received-by host of any host behind
   the firewall by an appropriate pseudonym for that host.

   An intermediary MAY combine an ordered subsequence of Via header
   field entries into a single such entry if the entries have identical
   received-protocol values.  For example,

     Via: 1.0 ricky, 1.1 ethel, 1.1 fred, 1.0 lucy

   could be collapsed to

     Via: 1.0 ricky, 1.1 mertz, 1.0 lucy

   A sender SHOULD NOT combine multiple entries unless they are all
   under the same organizational control and the hosts have already been
   replaced by pseudonyms.  A sender MUST NOT combine entries that have
   different received-protocol values.

5.6.2.  Transformations

   Some intermediaries include features for transforming messages and
   their payloads.  A proxy might, for example, convert between image
   formats in order to save cache space or to reduce the amount of
   traffic on a slow link.  However, operational problems might occur
   when these transformations are applied to payloads intended for
   critical applications, such as medical imaging or scientific data
   analysis, particularly when integrity checks or digital signatures
   are used to ensure that the payload received is identical to the
   original.

   An HTTP-to-HTTP proxy is called a "transforming proxy" if it is
   designed or configured to modify messages in a semantically
   meaningful way (i.e., modifications, beyond those required by normal
   HTTP processing, that change the message in a way that would be
   significant to the original sender or potentially significant to
   downstream recipients).  For example, a transforming proxy might be
   acting as a shared annotation server (modifying responses to include
   references to a local annotation database), a malware filter, a
   format transcoder, or a privacy filter.  Such transformations are
   presumed to be desired by whichever client (or client organization)
   selected the proxy.

   If a proxy receives a request-target with a host name that is not a
   fully qualified domain name, it MAY add its own domain to the host
   name it received when forwarding the request.  A proxy MUST NOT
   change the host name if the request-target contains a fully qualified
   domain name.

   A proxy MUST NOT modify the "absolute-path" and "query" parts of the
   received request-target when forwarding it to the next inbound
   server, except as noted above to replace an empty path with "/" or
   "*".

   A proxy MAY modify the message body through application or removal of
   a transfer coding (Section 7 of [Messaging]).

   A proxy MUST NOT transform the payload (Section 6.3) of a message
   that contains a no-transform cache-control directive (Section 5.2 of
   [Caching]).

   A proxy MAY transform the payload of a message that does not contain
   a no-transform cache-control directive.  A proxy that transforms a
   payload MUST add a Warning header field with the warn-code of 214
   ("Transformation Applied") if one is not already in the message (see
   Section 5.5 of [Caching]).  A proxy that transforms the payload of a
   200 (OK) response can further inform downstream recipients that a
   transformation has been applied by changing the response status code
   to 203 (Non-Authoritative Information) (Section 9.3.4).

   A proxy SHOULD NOT modify header fields that provide information
   about the endpoints of the communication chain, the resource state,
   or the selected representation (other than the payload) unless the
   field's definition specifically allows such modification or the
   modification is deemed necessary for privacy or security.

6.  Representations

   Considering that a resource could be anything, and that the uniform
   interface provided by HTTP is similar to a window through which one
   can observe and act upon such a thing only through the communication
   of messages to some independent actor on the other side, an
   abstraction is needed to represent ("take the place of") the current
   or desired state of that thing in our communications.  That
   abstraction is called a representation [REST].

   For the purposes of HTTP, a "representation" is information that is
   intended to reflect a past, current, or desired state of a given
   resource, in a format that can be readily communicated via the
   protocol, and that consists of a set of representation metadata and a
   potentially unbounded stream of representation data.

   An origin server might be provided with, or be capable of generating,
   multiple representations that are each intended to reflect the
   current state of a target resource.  In such cases, some algorithm is
   used by the origin server to select one of those representations as
   most applicable to a given request, usually based on content
   negotiation.  This "selected representation" is used to provide the
   data and metadata for evaluating conditional requests Section 8.2 and
   constructing the payload for 200 (OK) and 304 (Not Modified)
   responses to GET (Section 7.3.1).

6.1.  Representation Data

   The representation data associated with an HTTP message is either
   provided as the payload body of the message or referred to by the
   message semantics and the effective request URI.  The representation
   data is in a format and encoding defined by the representation
   metadata header fields.

   The data type of the representation data is determined via the header
   fields Content-Type and Content-Encoding.  These define a two-layer,
   ordered encoding model:

     representation-data := Content-Encoding( Content-Type( bits ) )

6.1.1.  Media Type

   HTTP uses media types [RFC2046] in the Content-Type (Section 6.2.1)
   and Accept (Section 8.4.2) header fields in order to provide open and
   extensible data typing and type negotiation.  Media types define both
   a data format and various processing models: how to process that data
   in accordance with each context in which it is received.

     media-type = type "/" subtype *( OWS ";" OWS parameter )
     type       = token
     subtype    = token

   The type/subtype MAY be followed by parameters in the form of
   name=value pairs.

     parameter      = token "=" ( token / quoted-string )

   The type, subtype, and parameter name tokens are case-insensitive.
   Parameter values might or might not be case-sensitive, depending on
   the semantics of the parameter name.  The presence or absence of a
   parameter might be significant to the processing of a media-type,
   depending on its definition within the media type registry.

   A parameter value that matches the token production can be
   transmitted either as a token or within a quoted-string.  The quoted
   and unquoted values are equivalent.  For example, the following
   examples are all equivalent, but the first is preferred for
   consistency:

     text/html;charset=utf-8
     text/html;charset=UTF-8
     Text/HTML;Charset="utf-8"
     text/html; charset="utf-8"

   Media types ought to be registered with IANA according to the
   procedures defined in [BCP13].

      Note: Unlike some similar constructs in other header fields, media
      type parameters do not allow whitespace (even "bad" whitespace)
      around the "=" character.

6.1.1.1.  Charset

   HTTP uses charset names to indicate or negotiate the character
   encoding scheme of a textual representation [RFC6365].  A charset is
   identified by a case-insensitive token.

     charset = token

   Charset names ought to be registered in the IANA "Character Sets"
   registry (<https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets>)
   according to the procedures defined in [RFC2978].

6.1.1.2.  Canonicalization and Text Defaults

   Media types are registered with a canonical form in order to be
   interoperable among systems with varying native encoding formats.
   Representations selected or transferred via HTTP ought to be in
   canonical form, for many of the same reasons described by the
   Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (MIME) [RFC2045].  However, the
   performance characteristics of email deployments (i.e., store and
   forward messages to peers) are significantly different from those
   common to HTTP and the Web (server-based information services).
   Furthermore, MIME's constraints for the sake of compatibility with
   older mail transfer protocols do not apply to HTTP (see Appendix B of
   [Messaging]).

   MIME's canonical form requires that media subtypes of the "text" type
   use CRLF as the text line break.  HTTP allows the transfer of text
   media with plain CR or LF alone representing a line break, when such
   line breaks are consistent for an entire representation.  An HTTP
   sender MAY generate, and a recipient MUST be able to parse, line
   breaks in text media that consist of CRLF, bare CR, or bare LF.  In
   addition, text media in HTTP is not limited to charsets that use
   octets 13 and 10 for CR and LF, respectively.  This flexibility
   regarding line breaks applies only to text within a representation
   that has been assigned a "text" media type; it does not apply to
   "multipart" types or HTTP elements outside the payload body (e.g.,
   header fields).

   If a representation is encoded with a content-coding, the underlying
   data ought to be in a form defined above prior to being encoded.

6.1.1.3.  Multipart Types

   MIME provides for a number of "multipart" types -- encapsulations of
   one or more representations within a single message body.  All
   multipart types share a common syntax, as defined in Section 5.1.1 of
   [RFC2046], and include a boundary parameter as part of the media type
   value.  The message body is itself a protocol element; a sender MUST
   generate only CRLF to represent line breaks between body parts.

   HTTP message framing does not use the multipart boundary as an
   indicator of message body length, though it might be used by
   implementations that generate or process the payload.  For example,
   the "multipart/form-data" type is often used for carrying form data
   in a request, as described in [RFC2388], and the "multipart/
   byteranges" type is defined by this specification for use in some 206
   (Partial Content) responses Section 9.3.7.

6.1.2.  Content Codings

   Content coding values indicate an encoding transformation that has
   been or can be applied to a representation.  Content codings are
   primarily used to allow a representation to be compressed or
   otherwise usefully transformed without losing the identity of its
   underlying media type and without loss of information.  Frequently,
   the representation is stored in coded form, transmitted directly, and
   only decoded by the final recipient.

     content-coding   = token

   Content-coding values are used in the Accept-Encoding (Section 8.4.4)
   and Content-Encoding (Section 6.2.2) header fields.

   The following content-coding values are defined by this
   specification:

   +------------+------------------------------------------+-----------+
   | Name       | Description                              | Reference |
   +------------+------------------------------------------+-----------+
   | compress   | UNIX "compress" data format [Welch]      | Section 6 |
   |            |                                          | .1.2.1    |
   | deflate    | "deflate" compressed data ([RFC1951])    | Section 6 |
   |            | inside the "zlib" data format            | .1.2.2    |
   |            | ([RFC1950])                              |           |
   | gzip       | GZIP file format [RFC1952]               | Section 6 |
   |            |                                          | .1.2.3    |
   | identity   | Reserved (synonym for "no encoding" in   | Section 8 |
   |            | Accept-Encoding)                         | .4.4      |
   | x-compress | Deprecated (alias for compress)          | Section 6 |
   |            |                                          | .1.2.1    |
   | x-gzip     | Deprecated (alias for gzip)              | Section 6 |
   |            |                                          | .1.2.3    |
   +------------+------------------------------------------+-----------+

6.1.2.1.  Compress Coding

   The "compress" coding is an adaptive Lempel-Ziv-Welch (LZW) coding
   [Welch] that is commonly produced by the UNIX file compression
   program "compress".  A recipient SHOULD consider "x-compress" to be
   equivalent to "compress".

6.1.2.2.  Deflate Coding

   The "deflate" coding is a "zlib" data format [RFC1950] containing a
   "deflate" compressed data stream [RFC1951] that uses a combination of
   the Lempel-Ziv (LZ77) compression algorithm and Huffman coding.

      Note: Some non-conformant implementations send the "deflate"
      compressed data without the zlib wrapper.

6.1.2.3.  Gzip Coding

   The "gzip" coding is an LZ77 coding with a 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy
   Check (CRC) that is commonly produced by the gzip file compression
   program [RFC1952].  A recipient SHOULD consider "x-gzip" to be
   equivalent to "gzip".

6.1.2.4.  Content Coding Extensibility

   Additional content codings, outside the scope of this specification,
   have been specified for use in HTTP.  All such content codings ought
   to be registered within the "HTTP Content Coding Registry".

6.1.2.4.1.  Content Coding Registry

   The "HTTP Content Coding Registry", maintained by IANA at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/>, registers
   content-coding names.

   Content coding registrations MUST include the following fields:

   o  Name

   o  Description

   o  Pointer to specification text

   Names of content codings MUST NOT overlap with names of transfer
   codings (Section 7 of [Messaging]), unless the encoding
   transformation is identical (as is the case for the compression
   codings defined in Section 6.1.2).

   Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   Section 4.1 of [RFC5226]) and MUST conform to the purpose of content
   coding defined in Section 6.1.2.

6.1.3.  Language Tags

   A language tag, as defined in [RFC5646], identifies a natural
   language spoken, written, or otherwise conveyed by human beings for
   communication of information to other human beings.  Computer
   languages are explicitly excluded.

   HTTP uses language tags within the Accept-Language and Content-
   Language header fields.  Accept-Language uses the broader language-
   range production defined in Section 8.4.5, whereas Content-Language
   uses the language-tag production defined below.

     language-tag = <Language-Tag, see [RFC5646], Section 2.1>

   A language tag is a sequence of one or more case-insensitive subtags,
   each separated by a hyphen character ("-", %x2D).  In most cases, a
   language tag consists of a primary language subtag that identifies a
   broad family of related languages (e.g., "en" = English), which is
   optionally followed by a series of subtags that refine or narrow that
   language's range (e.g., "en-CA" = the variety of English as
   communicated in Canada).  Whitespace is not allowed within a language
   tag.  Example tags include:

     fr, en-US, es-419, az-Arab, x-pig-latin, man-Nkoo-GN

   See [RFC5646] for further information.

6.1.4.  Range Units

   A representation can be partitioned into subranges according to
   various structural units, depending on the structure inherent in the
   representation's media type.  This "range unit" is used in the
   Accept-Ranges (Section 10.4.1) response header field to advertise
   support for range requests, the Range (Section 8.3) request header
   field to delineate the parts of a representation that are requested,
   and the Content-Range (Section 6.3.3) payload header field to
   describe which part of a representation is being transferred.

     range-unit       = bytes-unit / other-range-unit

   The following range unit names are defined by this document:

   +-------------+---------------------------------------+-------------+
   | Range Unit  | Description                           | Reference   |
   | Name        |                                       |             |
   +-------------+---------------------------------------+-------------+
   | bytes       | a range of octets                     | Section 6.1 |
   |             |                                       | .4.1        |
   | none        | reserved as keyword, indicating no    | Section 10. |
   |             | ranges are supported                  | 4.1         |
   +-------------+---------------------------------------+-------------+

6.1.4.1.  Byte Ranges

   Since representation data is transferred in payloads as a sequence of
   octets, a byte range is a meaningful substructure for any
   representation transferable over HTTP (Section 6).  The "bytes" range
   unit is defined for expressing subranges of the data's octet
   sequence.

     bytes-unit       = "bytes"

   A byte-range request can specify a single range of bytes or a set of
   ranges within a single representation.

     byte-ranges-specifier = bytes-unit "=" byte-range-set
     byte-range-set  = 1#( byte-range-spec / suffix-byte-range-spec )
     byte-range-spec = first-byte-pos "-" [ last-byte-pos ]
     first-byte-pos  = 1*DIGIT
     last-byte-pos   = 1*DIGIT

   The first-byte-pos value in a byte-range-spec gives the byte-offset
   of the first byte in a range.  The last-byte-pos value gives the
   byte-offset of the last byte in the range; that is, the byte
   positions specified are inclusive.  Byte offsets start at zero.

   Examples of byte-ranges-specifier values:

   o  The first 500 bytes (byte offsets 0-499, inclusive):

        bytes=0-499

   o  The second 500 bytes (byte offsets 500-999, inclusive):

        bytes=500-999

   A byte-range-spec is invalid if the last-byte-pos value is present
   and less than the first-byte-pos.

   A client can limit the number of bytes requested without knowing the
   size of the selected representation.  If the last-byte-pos value is
   absent, or if the value is greater than or equal to the current
   length of the representation data, the byte range is interpreted as
   the remainder of the representation (i.e., the server replaces the
   value of last-byte-pos with a value that is one less than the current
   length of the selected representation).

   A client can request the last N bytes of the selected representation
   using a suffix-byte-range-spec.

     suffix-byte-range-spec = "-" suffix-length
     suffix-length = 1*DIGIT

   If the selected representation is shorter than the specified suffix-
   length, the entire representation is used.

   Additional examples, assuming a representation of length 10000:

   o  The final 500 bytes (byte offsets 9500-9999, inclusive):

        bytes=-500

      Or:

        bytes=9500-

   o  The first and last bytes only (bytes 0 and 9999):

        bytes=0-0,-1

   o  Other valid (but not canonical) specifications of the second 500
      bytes (byte offsets 500-999, inclusive):

        bytes=500-600,601-999
        bytes=500-700,601-999

   If a valid byte-range-set includes at least one byte-range-spec with
   a first-byte-pos that is less than the current length of the
   representation, or at least one suffix-byte-range-spec with a non-
   zero suffix-length, then the byte-range-set is satisfiable.
   Otherwise, the byte-range-set is unsatisfiable.

   In the byte-range syntax, first-byte-pos, last-byte-pos, and suffix-
   length are expressed as decimal number of octets.  Since there is no
   predefined limit to the length of a payload, recipients MUST
   anticipate potentially large decimal numerals and prevent parsing
   errors due to integer conversion overflows.

6.1.4.2.  Other Range Units

   Range units are intended to be extensible.  New range units ought to
   be registered with IANA, as defined in Section 6.1.4.3.

     other-range-unit = token

6.1.4.3.  Range Unit Registry

   The "HTTP Range Unit Registry" defines the namespace for the range
   unit names and refers to their corresponding specifications.  It is
   maintained at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters>.

   Registration of an HTTP Range Unit MUST include the following fields:

   o  Name
   o  Description

   o  Pointer to specification text

   Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

6.2.  Representation Metadata

   Representation header fields provide metadata about the
   representation.  When a message includes a payload body, the
   representation header fields describe how to interpret the
   representation data enclosed in the payload body.  In a response to a
   HEAD request, the representation header fields describe the
   representation data that would have been enclosed in the payload body
   if the same request had been a GET.

   The following header fields convey representation metadata:

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in... |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Content-Type      | Section 6.2.1 |
   | Content-Encoding  | Section 6.2.2 |
   | Content-Language  | Section 6.2.3 |
   | Content-Length    | Section 6.2.4 |
   | Content-Location  | Section 6.2.5 |
   +-------------------+---------------+

6.2.1.  Content-Type

   The "Content-Type" header field indicates the media type of the
   associated representation: either the representation enclosed in the
   message payload or the selected representation, as determined by the
   message semantics.  The indicated media type defines both the data
   format and how that data is intended to be processed by a recipient,
   within the scope of the received message semantics, after any content
   codings indicated by Content-Encoding are decoded.

     Content-Type = media-type

   Media types are defined in Section 6.1.1.  An example of the field is

     Content-Type: text/html; charset=ISO-8859-4

   A sender that generates a message containing a payload body SHOULD
   generate a Content-Type header field in that message unless the
   intended media type of the enclosed representation is unknown to the
   sender.  If a Content-Type header field is not present, the recipient
   MAY either assume a media type of "application/octet-stream"
   ([RFC2046], Section 4.5.1) or examine the data to determine its type.

   In practice, resource owners do not always properly configure their
   origin server to provide the correct Content-Type for a given
   representation, with the result that some clients will examine a
   payload's content and override the specified type.  Clients that do
   so risk drawing incorrect conclusions, which might expose additional
   security risks (e.g., "privilege escalation").  Furthermore, it is
   impossible to determine the sender's intent by examining the data
   format: many data formats match multiple media types that differ only
   in processing semantics.  Implementers are encouraged to provide a
   means of disabling such "content sniffing" when it is used.

6.2.2.  Content-Encoding

   The "Content-Encoding" header field indicates what content codings
   have been applied to the representation, beyond those inherent in the
   media type, and thus what decoding mechanisms have to be applied in
   order to obtain data in the media type referenced by the Content-Type
   header field.  Content-Encoding is primarily used to allow a
   representation's data to be compressed without losing the identity of
   its underlying media type.

     Content-Encoding = 1#content-coding

   An example of its use is

     Content-Encoding: gzip

   If one or more encodings have been applied to a representation, the
   sender that applied the encodings MUST generate a Content-Encoding
   header field that lists the content codings in the order in which
   they were applied.  Additional information about the encoding
   parameters can be provided by other header fields not defined by this
   specification.

   Unlike Transfer-Encoding (Section 6.1 of [Messaging]), the codings
   listed in Content-Encoding are a characteristic of the
   representation; the representation is defined in terms of the coded
   form, and all other metadata about the representation is about the
   coded form unless otherwise noted in the metadata definition.
   Typically, the representation is only decoded just prior to rendering
   or analogous usage.

   If the media type includes an inherent encoding, such as a data
   format that is always compressed, then that encoding would not be
   restated in Content-Encoding even if it happens to be the same
   algorithm as one of the content codings.  Such a content coding would
   only be listed if, for some bizarre reason, it is applied a second
   time to form the representation.  Likewise, an origin server might
   choose to publish the same data as multiple representations that
   differ only in whether the coding is defined as part of Content-Type
   or Content-Encoding, since some user agents will behave differently
   in their handling of each response (e.g., open a "Save as ..." dialog
   instead of automatic decompression and rendering of content).

   An origin server MAY respond with a status code of 415 (Unsupported
   Media Type) if a representation in the request message has a content
   coding that is not acceptable.

6.2.3.  Content-Language

   The "Content-Language" header field describes the natural language(s)
   of the intended audience for the representation.  Note that this
   might not be equivalent to all the languages used within the
   representation.

     Content-Language = 1#language-tag

   Language tags are defined in Section 6.1.3.  The primary purpose of
   Content-Language is to allow a user to identify and differentiate
   representations according to the users' own preferred language.
   Thus, if the content is intended only for a Danish-literate audience,
   the appropriate field is

     Content-Language: da

   If no Content-Language is specified, the default is that the content
   is intended for all language audiences.  This might mean that the
   sender does not consider it to be specific to any natural language,
   or that the sender does not know for which language it is intended.

   Multiple languages MAY be listed for content that is intended for
   multiple audiences.  For example, a rendition of the "Treaty of
   Waitangi", presented simultaneously in the original Maori and English
   versions, would call for

     Content-Language: mi, en

   However, just because multiple languages are present within a
   representation does not mean that it is intended for multiple
   linguistic audiences.  An example would be a beginner's language
   primer, such as "A First Lesson in Latin", which is clearly intended
   to be used by an English-literate audience.  In this case, the
   Content-Language would properly only include "en".

   Content-Language MAY be applied to any media type -- it is not
   limited to textual documents.

6.2.4.  Content-Length

   [[CREF10: The "Content-Length" header field indicates the number of
   data octets (body length) for the representation.  In some cases,
   Content-Length is used to define or estimate message framing.  ]]

     Content-Length = 1*DIGIT

   An example is

     Content-Length: 3495

   A sender MUST NOT send a Content-Length header field in any message
   that contains a Transfer-Encoding header field.

   A user agent SHOULD send a Content-Length in a request message when
   no Transfer-Encoding is sent and the request method defines a meaning
   for an enclosed payload body.  For example, a Content-Length header
   field is normally sent in a POST request even when the value is 0
   (indicating an empty payload body).  A user agent SHOULD NOT send a
   Content-Length header field when the request message does not contain
   a payload body and the method semantics do not anticipate such a
   body.

   A server MAY send a Content-Length header field in a response to a
   HEAD request (Section 7.3.2); a server MUST NOT send Content-Length
   in such a response unless its field-value equals the decimal number
   of octets that would have been sent in the payload body of a response
   if the same request had used the GET method.

   A server MAY send a Content-Length header field in a 304 (Not
   Modified) response to a conditional GET request (Section 9.4.5); a
   server MUST NOT send Content-Length in such a response unless its
   field-value equals the decimal number of octets that would have been
   sent in the payload body of a 200 (OK) response to the same request.

   A server MUST NOT send a Content-Length header field in any response
   with a status code of 1xx (Informational) or 204 (No Content).  A
   server MUST NOT send a Content-Length header field in any 2xx
   (Successful) response to a CONNECT request (Section 7.3.6).

   Aside from the cases defined above, in the absence of Transfer-
   Encoding, an origin server SHOULD send a Content-Length header field
   when the payload body size is known prior to sending the complete
   header section.  This will allow downstream recipients to measure
   transfer progress, know when a received message is complete, and
   potentially reuse the connection for additional requests.

   Any Content-Length field value greater than or equal to zero is
   valid.  Since there is no predefined limit to the length of a
   payload, a recipient MUST anticipate potentially large decimal
   numerals and prevent parsing errors due to integer conversion
   overflows (Section 12.5).

   If a message is received that has multiple Content-Length header
   fields with field-values consisting of the same decimal value, or a
   single Content-Length header field with a field value containing a
   list of identical decimal values (e.g., "Content-Length: 42, 42"),
   indicating that duplicate Content-Length header fields have been
   generated or combined by an upstream message processor, then the
   recipient MUST either reject the message as invalid or replace the
   duplicated field-values with a single valid Content-Length field
   containing that decimal value prior to determining the message body
   length or forwarding the message.

6.2.5.  Content-Location

   The "Content-Location" header field references a URI that can be used
   as an identifier for a specific resource corresponding to the
   representation in this message's payload.  In other words, if one
   were to perform a GET request on this URI at the time of this
   message's generation, then a 200 (OK) response would contain the same
   representation that is enclosed as payload in this message.

     Content-Location = absolute-URI / partial-URI

   The Content-Location value is not a replacement for the effective
   Request URI (Section 5.3).  It is representation metadata.  It has
   the same syntax and semantics as the header field of the same name
   defined for MIME body parts in Section 4 of [RFC2557].  However, its
   appearance in an HTTP message has some special implications for HTTP
   recipients.

   If Content-Location is included in a 2xx (Successful) response
   message and its value refers (after conversion to absolute form) to a
   URI that is the same as the effective request URI, then the recipient
   MAY consider the payload to be a current representation of that
   resource at the time indicated by the message origination date.  For
   a GET (Section 7.3.1) or HEAD (Section 7.3.2) request, this is the
   same as the default semantics when no Content-Location is provided by
   the server.  For a state-changing request like PUT (Section 7.3.4) or
   POST (Section 7.3.3), it implies that the server's response contains
   the new representation of that resource, thereby distinguishing it
   from representations that might only report about the action (e.g.,
   "It worked!").  This allows authoring applications to update their
   local copies without the need for a subsequent GET request.

   If Content-Location is included in a 2xx (Successful) response
   message and its field-value refers to a URI that differs from the
   effective request URI, then the origin server claims that the URI is
   an identifier for a different resource corresponding to the enclosed
   representation.  Such a claim can only be trusted if both identifiers
   share the same resource owner, which cannot be programmatically
   determined via HTTP.

   o  For a response to a GET or HEAD request, this is an indication
      that the effective request URI refers to a resource that is
      subject to content negotiation and the Content-Location field-
      value is a more specific identifier for the selected
      representation.

   o  For a 201 (Created) response to a state-changing method, a
      Content-Location field-value that is identical to the Location
      field-value indicates that this payload is a current
      representation of the newly created resource.

   o  Otherwise, such a Content-Location indicates that this payload is
      a representation reporting on the requested action's status and
      that the same report is available (for future access with GET) at
      the given URI.  For example, a purchase transaction made via a
      POST request might include a receipt document as the payload of
      the 200 (OK) response; the Content-Location field-value provides
      an identifier for retrieving a copy of that same receipt in the
      future.

   A user agent that sends Content-Location in a request message is
   stating that its value refers to where the user agent originally
   obtained the content of the enclosed representation (prior to any
   modifications made by that user agent).  In other words, the user
   agent is providing a back link to the source of the original
   representation.

   An origin server that receives a Content-Location field in a request
   message MUST treat the information as transitory request context
   rather than as metadata to be saved verbatim as part of the
   representation.  An origin server MAY use that context to guide in
   processing the request or to save it for other uses, such as within
   source links or versioning metadata.  However, an origin server MUST
   NOT use such context information to alter the request semantics.

   For example, if a client makes a PUT request on a negotiated resource
   and the origin server accepts that PUT (without redirection), then
   the new state of that resource is expected to be consistent with the
   one representation supplied in that PUT; the Content-Location cannot
   be used as a form of reverse content selection identifier to update
   only one of the negotiated representations.  If the user agent had
   wanted the latter semantics, it would have applied the PUT directly
   to the Content-Location URI.

6.3.  Payload

   Some HTTP messages transfer a complete or partial representation as
   the message "payload".  In some cases, a payload might contain only
   the associated representation's header fields (e.g., responses to
   HEAD) or only some part(s) of the representation data (e.g., the 206
   (Partial Content) status code).

   Header fields that specifically describe the payload, rather than the
   associated representation, are referred to as "payload header
   fields".  Payload header fields are defined in other parts of this
   specification, due to their impact on message parsing.

   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...              |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Content-Range     | Section 6.3.3              |
   | Trailer           | Section 4.4                |
   | Transfer-Encoding | Section 6.1 of [Messaging] |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+

6.3.1.  Purpose

   The purpose of a payload in a request is defined by the method
   semantics.  For example, a representation in the payload of a PUT
   request (Section 7.3.4) represents the desired state of the target
   resource if the request is successfully applied, whereas a
   representation in the payload of a POST request (Section 7.3.3)
   represents information to be processed by the target resource.

   In a response, the payload's purpose is defined by both the request
   method and the response status code.  For example, the payload of a
   200 (OK) response to GET (Section 7.3.1) represents the current state
   of the target resource, as observed at the time of the message
   origination date (Section 10.1.1.2), whereas the payload of the same
   status code in a response to POST might represent either the
   processing result or the new state of the target resource after
   applying the processing.  Response messages with an error status code
   usually contain a payload that represents the error condition, such
   that it describes the error state and what next steps are suggested
   for resolving it.

6.3.2.  Identification

   When a complete or partial representation is transferred in a message
   payload, it is often desirable for the sender to supply, or the
   recipient to determine, an identifier for a resource corresponding to
   that representation.

   For a request message:

   o  If the request has a Content-Location header field, then the
      sender asserts that the payload is a representation of the
      resource identified by the Content-Location field-value.  However,
      such an assertion cannot be trusted unless it can be verified by
      other means (not defined by this specification).  The information
      might still be useful for revision history links.

   o  Otherwise, the payload is unidentified.

   For a response message, the following rules are applied in order
   until a match is found:

   1.  If the request method is GET or HEAD and the response status code
       is 200 (OK), 204 (No Content), 206 (Partial Content), or 304 (Not
       Modified), the payload is a representation of the resource
       identified by the effective request URI (Section 5.3).

   2.  If the request method is GET or HEAD and the response status code
       is 203 (Non-Authoritative Information), the payload is a
       potentially modified or enhanced representation of the target
       resource as provided by an intermediary.

   3.  If the response has a Content-Location header field and its
       field-value is a reference to the same URI as the effective
       request URI, the payload is a representation of the resource
       identified by the effective request URI.

   4.  If the response has a Content-Location header field and its
       field-value is a reference to a URI different from the effective
       request URI, then the sender asserts that the payload is a
       representation of the resource identified by the Content-Location
       field-value.  However, such an assertion cannot be trusted unless
       it can be verified by other means (not defined by this
       specification).

   5.  Otherwise, the payload is unidentified.

6.3.3.  Content-Range

   The "Content-Range" header field is sent in a single part 206
   (Partial Content) response to indicate the partial range of the
   selected representation enclosed as the message payload, sent in each
   part of a multipart 206 response to indicate the range enclosed
   within each body part, and sent in 416 (Range Not Satisfiable)
   responses to provide information about the selected representation.

     Content-Range       = byte-content-range
                         / other-content-range

     byte-content-range  = bytes-unit SP
                           ( byte-range-resp / unsatisfied-range )

     byte-range-resp     = byte-range "/" ( complete-length / "*" )
     byte-range          = first-byte-pos "-" last-byte-pos
     unsatisfied-range   = "*/" complete-length

     complete-length     = 1*DIGIT

     other-content-range = other-range-unit SP other-range-resp
     other-range-resp    = *CHAR

   If a 206 (Partial Content) response contains a Content-Range header
   field with a range unit (Section 6.1.4) that the recipient does not
   understand, the recipient MUST NOT attempt to recombine it with a
   stored representation.  A proxy that receives such a message SHOULD
   forward it downstream.

   For byte ranges, a sender SHOULD indicate the complete length of the
   representation from which the range has been extracted, unless the
   complete length is unknown or difficult to determine.  An asterisk
   character ("*") in place of the complete-length indicates that the
   representation length was unknown when the header field was
   generated.

   The following example illustrates when the complete length of the
   selected representation is known by the sender to be 1234 bytes:

     Content-Range: bytes 42-1233/1234

   and this second example illustrates when the complete length is
   unknown:

     Content-Range: bytes 42-1233/*

   A Content-Range field value is invalid if it contains a byte-range-
   resp that has a last-byte-pos value less than its first-byte-pos
   value, or a complete-length value less than or equal to its last-
   byte-pos value.  The recipient of an invalid Content-Range MUST NOT
   attempt to recombine the received content with a stored
   representation.

   A server generating a 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) response to a byte-
   range request SHOULD send a Content-Range header field with an
   unsatisfied-range value, as in the following example:

     Content-Range: bytes */1234

   The complete-length in a 416 response indicates the current length of
   the selected representation.

   The Content-Range header field has no meaning for status codes that
   do not explicitly describe its semantic.  For this specification,
   only the 206 (Partial Content) and 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) status
   codes describe a meaning for Content-Range.

   The following are examples of Content-Range values in which the
   selected representation contains a total of 1234 bytes:

   o  The first 500 bytes:

        Content-Range: bytes 0-499/1234

   o  The second 500 bytes:

        Content-Range: bytes 500-999/1234

   o  All except for the first 500 bytes:

        Content-Range: bytes 500-1233/1234

   o  The last 500 bytes:

        Content-Range: bytes 734-1233/1234

6.3.4.  Media Type multipart/byteranges

   When a 206 (Partial Content) response message includes the content of
   multiple ranges, they are transmitted as body parts in a multipart
   message body ([RFC2046], Section 5.1) with the media type of
   "multipart/byteranges".

   The multipart/byteranges media type includes one or more body parts,
   each with its own Content-Type and Content-Range fields.  The
   required boundary parameter specifies the boundary string used to
   separate each body part.

   Implementation Notes:

   1.  Additional CRLFs might precede the first boundary string in the
       body.

   2.  Although [RFC2046] permits the boundary string to be quoted, some
       existing implementations handle a quoted boundary string
       incorrectly.

   3.  A number of clients and servers were coded to an early draft of
       the byteranges specification that used a media type of multipart/
       x-byteranges, which is almost (but not quite) compatible with
       this type.

   Despite the name, the "multipart/byteranges" media type is not
   limited to byte ranges.  The following example uses an "exampleunit"
   range unit:

     HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
     Date: Tue, 14 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
     Last-Modified: Tue, 14 July 04:58:08 GMT
     Content-Length: 2331785
     Content-Type: multipart/byteranges; boundary=THIS_STRING_SEPARATES

     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
     Content-Type: video/example
     Content-Range: exampleunit 1.2-4.3/25

     ...the first range...
     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
     Content-Type: video/example
     Content-Range: exampleunit 11.2-14.3/25

     ...the second range
     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES--

   The following information serves as the registration form for the
   multipart/byteranges media type.

   Type name:  multipart

   Subtype name:  byteranges

   Required parameters:  boundary

   Optional parameters:  N/A

   Encoding considerations:  only "7bit", "8bit", or "binary" are
      permitted

   Security considerations:  see Section 12

   Interoperability considerations:  N/A

   Published specification:  This specification (see Section 6.3.4).

   Applications that use this media type:  HTTP components supporting
      multiple ranges in a single request.

   Fragment identifier considerations:  N/A

   Additional information:

      Deprecated alias names for this type:  N/A

      Magic number(s):  N/A

      File extension(s):  N/A

      Macintosh file type code(s):  N/A

   Person and email address to contact for further information:  See Aut
      hors' Addresses section.

   Intended usage:  COMMON

   Restrictions on usage:  N/A

   Author:  See Authors' Addresses section.

   Change controller:  IESG

6.4.  Content Negotiation

   When responses convey payload information, whether indicating a
   success or an error, the origin server often has different ways of
   representing that information; for example, in different formats,
   languages, or encodings.  Likewise, different users or user agents
   might have differing capabilities, characteristics, or preferences
   that could influence which representation, among those available,
   would be best to deliver.  For this reason, HTTP provides mechanisms
   for content negotiation.

   This specification defines two patterns of content negotiation that
   can be made visible within the protocol: "proactive", where the
   server selects the representation based upon the user agent's stated
   preferences, and "reactive" negotiation, where the server provides a
   list of representations for the user agent to choose from.  Other
   patterns of content negotiation include "conditional content", where
   the representation consists of multiple parts that are selectively
   rendered based on user agent parameters, "active content", where the
   representation contains a script that makes additional (more
   specific) requests based on the user agent characteristics, and
   "Transparent Content Negotiation" ([RFC2295]), where content
   selection is performed by an intermediary.  These patterns are not
   mutually exclusive, and each has trade-offs in applicability and
   practicality.

   Note that, in all cases, HTTP is not aware of the resource semantics.
   The consistency with which an origin server responds to requests,
   over time and over the varying dimensions of content negotiation, and
   thus the "sameness" of a resource's observed representations over
   time, is determined entirely by whatever entity or algorithm selects
   or generates those responses.  HTTP pays no attention to the man
   behind the curtain.

6.4.1.  Proactive Negotiation

   When content negotiation preferences are sent by the user agent in a
   request to encourage an algorithm located at the server to select the
   preferred representation, it is called proactive negotiation (a.k.a.,
   server-driven negotiation).  Selection is based on the available
   representations for a response (the dimensions over which it might
   vary, such as language, content-coding, etc.) compared to various
   information supplied in the request, including both the explicit
   negotiation fields of Section 8.4 and implicit characteristics, such
   as the client's network address or parts of the User-Agent field.

   Proactive negotiation is advantageous when the algorithm for
   selecting from among the available representations is difficult to
   describe to a user agent, or when the server desires to send its
   "best guess" to the user agent along with the first response (hoping
   to avoid the round trip delay of a subsequent request if the "best
   guess" is good enough for the user).  In order to improve the
   server's guess, a user agent MAY send request header fields that
   describe its preferences.

   Proactive negotiation has serious disadvantages:

   o  It is impossible for the server to accurately determine what might
      be "best" for any given user, since that would require complete
      knowledge of both the capabilities of the user agent and the
      intended use for the response (e.g., does the user want to view it
      on screen or print it on paper?);

   o  Having the user agent describe its capabilities in every request
      can be both very inefficient (given that only a small percentage
      of responses have multiple representations) and a potential risk
      to the user's privacy;

   o  It complicates the implementation of an origin server and the
      algorithms for generating responses to a request; and,

   o  It limits the reusability of responses for shared caching.

   A user agent cannot rely on proactive negotiation preferences being
   consistently honored, since the origin server might not implement
   proactive negotiation for the requested resource or might decide that
   sending a response that doesn't conform to the user agent's
   preferences is better than sending a 406 (Not Acceptable) response.

   A Vary header field (Section 10.1.4) is often sent in a response
   subject to proactive negotiation to indicate what parts of the
   request information were used in the selection algorithm.

6.4.2.  Reactive Negotiation

   With reactive negotiation (a.k.a., agent-driven negotiation),
   selection of the best response representation (regardless of the
   status code) is performed by the user agent after receiving an
   initial response from the origin server that contains a list of
   resources for alternative representations.  If the user agent is not
   satisfied by the initial response representation, it can perform a
   GET request on one or more of the alternative resources, selected
   based on metadata included in the list, to obtain a different form of
   representation for that response.  Selection of alternatives might be
   performed automatically by the user agent or manually by the user
   selecting from a generated (possibly hypertext) menu.

   Note that the above refers to representations of the response, in
   general, not representations of the resource.  The alternative
   representations are only considered representations of the target
   resource if the response in which those alternatives are provided has
   the semantics of being a representation of the target resource (e.g.,
   a 200 (OK) response to a GET request) or has the semantics of
   providing links to alternative representations for the target
   resource (e.g., a 300 (Multiple Choices) response to a GET request).

   A server might choose not to send an initial representation, other
   than the list of alternatives, and thereby indicate that reactive
   negotiation by the user agent is preferred.  For example, the
   alternatives listed in responses with the 300 (Multiple Choices) and
   406 (Not Acceptable) status codes include information about the
   available representations so that the user or user agent can react by
   making a selection.

   Reactive negotiation is advantageous when the response would vary
   over commonly used dimensions (such as type, language, or encoding),
   when the origin server is unable to determine a user agent's
   capabilities from examining the request, and generally when public
   caches are used to distribute server load and reduce network usage.

   Reactive negotiation suffers from the disadvantages of transmitting a
   list of alternatives to the user agent, which degrades user-perceived
   latency if transmitted in the header section, and needing a second
   request to obtain an alternate representation.  Furthermore, this
   specification does not define a mechanism for supporting automatic
   selection, though it does not prevent such a mechanism from being
   developed as an extension.

7.  Request Methods

7.1.  Overview

   The request method token is the primary source of request semantics;
   it indicates the purpose for which the client has made this request
   and what is expected by the client as a successful result.

   The request method's semantics might be further specialized by the
   semantics of some header fields when present in a request (Section 8)
   if those additional semantics do not conflict with the method.  For
   example, a client can send conditional request header fields
   (Section 8.2) to make the requested action conditional on the current
   state of the target resource.

     method = token

   HTTP was originally designed to be usable as an interface to
   distributed object systems.  The request method was envisioned as
   applying semantics to a target resource in much the same way as
   invoking a defined method on an identified object would apply
   semantics.  The method token is case-sensitive because it might be
   used as a gateway to object-based systems with case-sensitive method
   names.

   Unlike distributed objects, the standardized request methods in HTTP
   are not resource-specific, since uniform interfaces provide for
   better visibility and reuse in network-based systems [REST].  Once
   defined, a standardized method ought to have the same semantics when
   applied to any resource, though each resource determines for itself
   whether those semantics are implemented or allowed.

   This specification defines a number of standardized methods that are
   commonly used in HTTP, as outlined by the following table.  By
   convention, standardized methods are defined in all-uppercase US-
   ASCII letters.

   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+
   | Method  | Description                                     | Sec.  |
   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+
   | GET     | Transfer a current representation of the target | 7.3.1 |
   |         | resource.                                       |       |
   | HEAD    | Same as GET, but only transfer the status line  | 7.3.2 |
   |         | and header section.                             |       |
   | POST    | Perform resource-specific processing on the     | 7.3.3 |
   |         | request payload.                                |       |
   | PUT     | Replace all current representations of the      | 7.3.4 |
   |         | target resource with the request payload.       |       |
   | DELETE  | Remove all current representations of the       | 7.3.5 |
   |         | target resource.                                |       |
   | CONNECT | Establish a tunnel to the server identified by  | 7.3.6 |
   |         | the target resource.                            |       |
   | OPTIONS | Describe the communication options for the      | 7.3.7 |
   |         | target resource.                                |       |
   | TRACE   | Perform a message loop-back test along the path | 7.3.8 |
   |         | to the target resource.                         |       |
   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+

   All general-purpose servers MUST support the methods GET and HEAD.
   All other methods are OPTIONAL.

   The set of methods allowed by a target resource can be listed in an
   Allow header field (Section 10.4.2).  However, the set of allowed
   methods can change dynamically.  When a request method is received
   that is unrecognized or not implemented by an origin server, the
   origin server SHOULD respond with the 501 (Not Implemented) status
   code.  When a request method is received that is known by an origin
   server but not allowed for the target resource, the origin server
   SHOULD respond with the 405 (Method Not Allowed) status code.

7.2.  Common Method Properties

   +---------+------+------------+----------------+
   | Method  | Safe | Idempotent | Reference      |
   +---------+------+------------+----------------+
   | CONNECT | no   | no         | Section 7.3.6  |
   | DELETE  | no   | yes        | Section 7.3.5  |
   | GET     | yes  | yes        | Section 7.3.1  |
   | HEAD    | yes  | yes        | Section 7.3.2  |
   | OPTIONS | yes  | yes        | Section 7.3.7  |
   | POST    | no   | no         | Section 7.3.3  |
   | PUT     | no   | yes        | Section 7.3.4  |
   | TRACE   | yes  | yes        | Section 7.3.8  |
   +---------+------+------------+----------------+

7.2.1.  Safe Methods

   Request methods are considered "safe" if their defined semantics are
   essentially read-only; i.e., the client does not request, and does
   not expect, any state change on the origin server as a result of
   applying a safe method to a target resource.  Likewise, reasonable
   use of a safe method is not expected to cause any harm, loss of
   property, or unusual burden on the origin server.

   This definition of safe methods does not prevent an implementation
   from including behavior that is potentially harmful, that is not
   entirely read-only, or that causes side effects while invoking a safe
   method.  What is important, however, is that the client did not
   request that additional behavior and cannot be held accountable for
   it.  For example, most servers append request information to access
   log files at the completion of every response, regardless of the
   method, and that is considered safe even though the log storage might
   become full and crash the server.  Likewise, a safe request initiated
   by selecting an advertisement on the Web will often have the side
   effect of charging an advertising account.

   Of the request methods defined by this specification, the GET, HEAD,
   OPTIONS, and TRACE methods are defined to be safe.

   The purpose of distinguishing between safe and unsafe methods is to
   allow automated retrieval processes (spiders) and cache performance
   optimization (pre-fetching) to work without fear of causing harm.  In
   addition, it allows a user agent to apply appropriate constraints on
   the automated use of unsafe methods when processing potentially
   untrusted content.

   A user agent SHOULD distinguish between safe and unsafe methods when
   presenting potential actions to a user, such that the user can be
   made aware of an unsafe action before it is requested.

   When a resource is constructed such that parameters within the
   effective request URI have the effect of selecting an action, it is
   the resource owner's responsibility to ensure that the action is
   consistent with the request method semantics.  For example, it is
   common for Web-based content editing software to use actions within
   query parameters, such as "page?do=delete".  If the purpose of such a
   resource is to perform an unsafe action, then the resource owner MUST
   disable or disallow that action when it is accessed using a safe
   request method.  Failure to do so will result in unfortunate side
   effects when automated processes perform a GET on every URI reference
   for the sake of link maintenance, pre-fetching, building a search
   index, etc.

7.2.2.  Idempotent Methods

   A request method is considered "idempotent" if the intended effect on
   the server of multiple identical requests with that method is the
   same as the effect for a single such request.  Of the request methods
   defined by this specification, PUT, DELETE, and safe request methods
   are idempotent.

   Like the definition of safe, the idempotent property only applies to
   what has been requested by the user; a server is free to log each
   request separately, retain a revision control history, or implement
   other non-idempotent side effects for each idempotent request.

   Idempotent methods are distinguished because the request can be
   repeated automatically if a communication failure occurs before the
   client is able to read the server's response.  For example, if a
   client sends a PUT request and the underlying connection is closed
   before any response is received, then the client can establish a new
   connection and retry the idempotent request.  It knows that repeating
   the request will have the same intended effect, even if the original
   request succeeded, though the response might differ.

7.2.3.  Cacheable Methods

   Request methods can be defined as "cacheable" to indicate that
   responses to them are allowed to be stored for future reuse; for
   specific requirements see [Caching].  In general, safe methods that
   do not depend on a current or authoritative response are defined as
   cacheable; this specification defines GET, HEAD, and POST as
   cacheable, although the overwhelming majority of cache
   implementations only support GET and HEAD.

7.3.  Method Definitions

7.3.1.  GET

   The GET method requests transfer of a current selected representation
   for the target resource.  GET is the primary mechanism of information
   retrieval and the focus of almost all performance optimizations.
   Hence, when people speak of retrieving some identifiable information
   via HTTP, they are generally referring to making a GET request.

   It is tempting to think of resource identifiers as remote file system
   pathnames and of representations as being a copy of the contents of
   such files.  In fact, that is how many resources are implemented (see
   Section 12.3 for related security considerations).  However, there
   are no such limitations in practice.  The HTTP interface for a
   resource is just as likely to be implemented as a tree of content
   objects, a programmatic view on various database records, or a
   gateway to other information systems.  Even when the URI mapping
   mechanism is tied to a file system, an origin server might be
   configured to execute the files with the request as input and send
   the output as the representation rather than transfer the files
   directly.  Regardless, only the origin server needs to know how each
   of its resource identifiers corresponds to an implementation and how
   each implementation manages to select and send a current
   representation of the target resource in a response to GET.

   A client can alter the semantics of GET to be a "range request",
   requesting transfer of only some part(s) of the selected
   representation, by sending a Range header field in the request
   (Section 8.3).

   A payload within a GET request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a GET request might cause some existing
   implementations to reject the request.

   The response to a GET request is cacheable; a cache MAY use it to
   satisfy subsequent GET and HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated
   by the Cache-Control header field (Section 5.2 of [Caching]).

7.3.2.  HEAD

   The HEAD method is identical to GET except that the server MUST NOT
   send a message body in the response (i.e., the response terminates at
   the end of the header section).  The server SHOULD send the same
   header fields in response to a HEAD request as it would have sent if
   the request had been a GET, except that the payload header fields
   (Section 6.3) MAY be omitted.  This method can be used for obtaining
   metadata about the selected representation without transferring the
   representation data and is often used for testing hypertext links for
   validity, accessibility, and recent modification.

   A payload within a HEAD request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a HEAD request might cause some existing
   implementations to reject the request.

   The response to a HEAD request is cacheable; a cache MAY use it to
   satisfy subsequent HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated by the
   Cache-Control header field (Section 5.2 of [Caching]).  A HEAD
   response might also have an effect on previously cached responses to
   GET; see Section 4.3.5 of [Caching].

7.3.3.  POST

   The POST method requests that the target resource process the
   representation enclosed in the request according to the resource's
   own specific semantics.  For example, POST is used for the following
   functions (among others):

   o  Providing a block of data, such as the fields entered into an HTML
      form, to a data-handling process;

   o  Posting a message to a bulletin board, newsgroup, mailing list,
      blog, or similar group of articles;

   o  Creating a new resource that has yet to be identified by the
      origin server; and

   o  Appending data to a resource's existing representation(s).

   An origin server indicates response semantics by choosing an
   appropriate status code depending on the result of processing the
   POST request; almost all of the status codes defined by this
   specification might be received in a response to POST (the exceptions
   being 206 (Partial Content), 304 (Not Modified), and 416 (Range Not
   Satisfiable)).

   If one or more resources has been created on the origin server as a
   result of successfully processing a POST request, the origin server
   SHOULD send a 201 (Created) response containing a Location header
   field that provides an identifier for the primary resource created
   (Section 10.1.2) and a representation that describes the status of
   the request while referring to the new resource(s).

   Responses to POST requests are only cacheable when they include
   explicit freshness information (see Section 4.2.1 of [Caching]).
   However, POST caching is not widely implemented.  For cases where an
   origin server wishes the client constructs to be able to cache the result of a
   POST in a way that can be reused by a later GET, the origin server
   MAY send a 200 (OK) response containing the result and a Content-
   Location header field that has the same value as the POST's effective
   request URI (Section 6.2.5).

   If the result of processing a POST would be equivalent to a
   representation of an existing resource, an origin server MAY redirect
   the user agent to that resource by sending a 303 (See Other) response
   with the existing resource's identifier in the Location field.  This
   has the benefits of providing the user agent a resource identifier
   and transferring the representation via a method more amenable to
   shared caching, though at the cost of an extra request if the user
   agent does not already have the representation cached.

7.3.4.  PUT

   The PUT method requests that the state of the target resource be
   created or replaced with the state defined by the representation
   enclosed in the request message payload.  A successful PUT of a given
   representation would suggest that a subsequent GET on that same
   target resource will result in an equivalent representation being
   sent in a 200 (OK) response.  However, there is no guarantee that
   such a state change will be observable, since the target resource
   might be acted upon by other user agents in parallel, or might be
   subject to dynamic processing by the origin server, before any
   subsequent GET is received.  A successful response only implies that
   the user agent's intent was achieved at the time of its processing by
   the origin server.

   If the target resource does not have a current representation and the
   PUT successfully creates one, then the origin server MUST inform the
   user agent by sending a 201 (Created) response.  If the target
   resource does have a current representation and that representation
   is successfully modified in accordance with the state of the enclosed
   representation, then the origin server MUST send either a 200 (OK) or
   a 204 (No Content) response to indicate successful completion of the
   request.

   An origin server SHOULD ignore unrecognized header fields received in
   a PUT request (i.e., do not save them as part of the resource state).

   An origin server SHOULD verify that the PUT representation is
   consistent with any constraints the server has for the target
   resource that cannot or will not be changed by the PUT.  This is
   particularly important when the origin server uses internal
   configuration information related to the URI in order to set the
   values for representation metadata on GET responses.  When a PUT
   representation is inconsistent with the target resource, the origin
   server SHOULD either make them consistent, by transforming the
   representation or changing the resource configuration, or respond
   with an appropriate error message containing sufficient information
   to explain why the representation is unsuitable.  The 409 (Conflict)
   or 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status codes are suggested, with the
   latter being specific to constraints on Content-Type values.

   For example, if the target resource is configured to always have a
   Content-Type of "text/html" and the representation being PUT has a
   Content-Type of "image/jpeg", the origin server ought to do one of:

   a.  reconfigure the target resource to reflect the new media type;

   b.  transform the PUT representation to a format consistent with that
       of the resource before saving it as the new resource state; or,

   c.  reject the request with a 415 (Unsupported Media Type) response
       indicating that the target resource is limited to "text/html",
       perhaps including a link to a different resource that would be a
       suitable target for the new representation.

   HTTP does not define exactly how a PUT method affects the state of an
   origin server beyond what can be expressed by the intent of the user
   agent request and the semantics of the origin server response.  It
   does not define what a resource might be, in any sense of that word,
   beyond the interface provided via HTTP.  It does not define how
   resource state is "stored", nor how such storage might change as a
   result of a change in resource state, nor how the origin server
   translates resource state into representations.  Generally speaking,
   all implementation details behind the resource interface are
   intentionally hidden by the server.

   An origin server MUST NOT send a validator header field
   (Section 10.2), such as an ETag or Last-Modified field, in a
   successful response to PUT unless the request's representation data
   was saved without any transformation applied to the body (i.e., the
   resource's new representation data is identical to the representation
   data received in the PUT request) and the validator field value
   reflects the new representation.  This requirement allows a user
   agent to know when the representation body it has in memory remains
   current as a result of the PUT, thus not in need of being retrieved
   again from the origin server, and that the new validator(s) received
   in the response can be used for future conditional requests in order
   to prevent accidental overwrites (Section 8.2).

   The fundamental difference between the POST and PUT methods is
   highlighted by the different intent for the enclosed representation.
   The target resource in a POST request is intended to handle the
   enclosed representation according to the resource's own semantics,
   whereas the enclosed representation in a PUT request is defined as
   replacing the state of the target resource.  Hence, the intent of PUT
   is idempotent and visible to intermediaries, even though the exact
   effect is only known by the origin server.

   Proper interpretation of a PUT request presumes that the user agent
   knows which target resource is desired.  A service that selects a
   proper URI on behalf of the client, after receiving a state-changing
   request, SHOULD be implemented using the POST method rather than PUT.
   If the origin server will not make the requested PUT state change to
   the target resource and instead wishes to have it applied to a
   different resource, such as when the resource has been moved to a
   different URI, then the origin server MUST send an appropriate 3xx
   (Redirection) response; the user agent MAY then make its own decision
   regarding whether or not to redirect the request.

   A PUT request applied to the target resource can have side effects on
   other resources.  For example, an article might have a URI for
   identifying "the current version" (a resource) that is separate from
   the URIs identifying each particular version (different resources
   that at one point shared the same state as the current version
   resource).  A successful PUT request on "the current version" URI
   might therefore create a new version resource in addition to changing
   the state of the target resource, and might also cause links to be
   added between the related resources.

   An origin server that allows PUT on a given target resource MUST send
   a 400 (Bad Request) response to a PUT request that contains a
   Content-Range header field (Section 6.3.3), since the payload is
   likely to be partial content that has been mistakenly PUT as a full
   representation.  Partial content updates are possible by targeting a
   separately identified resource with state that overlaps a portion of
   the larger resource, or by using a different method that has been
   specifically defined for partial updates (for example, the PATCH
   method defined in [RFC5789]).

   Responses to the PUT method are not cacheable.  If a successful PUT
   request messages to communicate specific intentions, examines
   received passes through a cache that has one or more stored responses
   for the effective request URI, those stored responses will be
   invalidated (see Section 4.4 of [Caching]).

7.3.5.  DELETE

   The DELETE method requests that the origin server remove the
   association between the target resource and its current
   functionality.  In effect, this method is similar to see if the intentions were carried out, rm command
   in UNIX: it expresses a deletion operation on the URI mapping of the
   origin server rather than an expectation that the previously
   associated information be deleted.

   If the target resource has one or more current representations, they
   might or might not be destroyed by the origin server, and
   determines how the
   associated storage might or might not be reclaimed, depending
   entirely on the nature of the resource and its implementation by the
   origin server (which are beyond the scope of this specification).
   Likewise, other implementation aspects of a resource might need to interpret be
   deactivated or archived as a result of a DELETE, such as database or
   gateway connections.  In general, it is assumed that the results.  This document defines
   HTTP/1.1 origin
   server will only allow DELETE on resources for which it has a
   prescribed mechanism for accomplishing the deletion.

   Relatively few resources allow the DELETE method -- its primary use
   is for remote authoring environments, where the user has some
   direction regarding its effect.  For example, a resource that was
   previously created using a PUT request, or identified via the
   Location header field after a 201 (Created) response to a POST
   request, might allow a corresponding DELETE request to undo those
   actions.  Similarly, custom user agent implementations that implement
   an authoring function, such as revision control clients using HTTP
   for remote operations, might use DELETE based on an assumption that
   the server's URI space has been crafted to correspond to a version
   repository.

   If a DELETE method is successfully applied, the origin server SHOULD
   send a 202 (Accepted) status code if the action will likely succeed
   but has not yet been enacted, a 204 (No Content) status code if the
   action has been enacted and no further information is to be supplied,
   or a 200 (OK) status code if the action has been enacted and the
   response semantics in terms of message includes a representation describing the architecture status.

   A payload within a DELETE request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a DELETE request might cause some existing
   implementations to reject the request.

   Responses to the DELETE method are not cacheable.  If a DELETE
   request passes through a cache that has one or more stored responses
   for the effective request URI, those stored responses will be
   invalidated (see Section 4.4 of [Caching]).

7.3.6.  CONNECT

   The CONNECT method requests that the recipient establish a tunnel to
   the destination origin server identified by the request-target and,
   if successful, thereafter restrict its behavior to blind forwarding
   of packets, in both directions, until the tunnel is closed.  Tunnels
   are commonly used to create an end-to-end virtual connection, through
   one or more proxies, which can then be secured using TLS (Transport
   Layer Security, [RFC5246]).

   CONNECT is intended only for use in [MESSGNG].

   HTTP provides requests to a uniform interface proxy.  An origin
   server that receives a CONNECT request for interacting itself MAY respond with a resource
   2xx (Successful) status code to indicate that a connection is
   established.  However, most origin servers do not implement CONNECT.

   A client sending a CONNECT request MUST send the authority form of
   request-target (Section 2), regardless 3.2 of its type, nature, or implementation, via [Messaging]); i.e., the manipulation request-target
   consists of only the host name and transfer port number of representations (Section 3).

   HTTP semantics include the intentions defined tunnel
   destination, separated by each a colon.  For example,

     CONNECT server.example.com:80 HTTP/1.1
     Host: server.example.com:80

   The recipient proxy can establish a tunnel either by directly
   connecting to the request-target or, if configured to use another
   proxy, by forwarding the CONNECT request method
   (Section 4), extensions to those semantics the next inbound proxy.
   Any 2xx (Successful) response indicates that might be described in
   request header fields (Section 5), the meaning of status codes sender (and all
   inbound proxies) will switch to
   indicate a machine-readable response (Section 6), and tunnel mode immediately after the meaning of
   other control data and resource metadata
   blank line that might be given in
   response concludes the successful response's header fields (Section 7).

   This document also defines representation metadata section;
   data received after that describe how
   a payload blank line is intended to be interpreted from the server identified by a recipient,
   the request
   header fields request-target.  Any response other than a successful response
   indicates that might influence content selection, the tunnel has not yet been formed and that the various
   selection algorithms
   connection remains governed by HTTP.

   A tunnel is closed when a tunnel intermediary detects that are collectively referred either
   side has closed its connection: the intermediary MUST attempt to as "content
   negotiation" (Section 3.4).

   This specification obsoletes RFC 7231, with send
   any outstanding data that came from the changes being
   summarized in Appendix B.

1.1.  Conformance and Error Handling

   The key words "MUST", "MUST NOT", "REQUIRED", "SHALL", "SHALL NOT",
   "SHOULD", "SHOULD NOT", "RECOMMENDED", "MAY", and "OPTIONAL" in this
   document are closed side to be interpreted as described in [RFC2119].

   Conformance criteria the other
   side, close both connections, and considerations regarding error handling then discard any remaining data
   left undelivered.

   Proxy authentication might be used to establish the authority to
   create a tunnel.  For example,

     CONNECT server.example.com:80 HTTP/1.1
     Host: server.example.com:80
     Proxy-Authorization: basic aGVsbG86d29ybGQ=

   There are
   defined significant risks in Section 2.5 of [MESSGNG].

1.2.  Syntax Notation

   This specification uses establishing a tunnel to arbitrary
   servers, particularly when the Augmented Backus-Naur Form (ABNF)
   notation of [RFC5234] with destination is a list extension, defined in Section 7 well-known or
   reserved TCP port that is not intended for Web traffic.  For example,
   a CONNECT to a request-target of
   [MESSGNG], "example.com:25" would suggest that allows
   the proxy connect to the reserved port for compact definition SMTP traffic; if allowed,
   that could trick the proxy into relaying spam email.  Proxies that
   support CONNECT SHOULD restrict its use to a limited set of comma-separated
   lists using known
   ports or a configurable whitelist of safe request targets.

   A server MUST NOT send any Transfer-Encoding or Content-Length header
   fields in a 2xx (Successful) response to CONNECT.  A client MUST
   ignore any Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding header fields received
   in a successful response to CONNECT.

   A payload within a '#' operator (similar CONNECT request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a CONNECT request might cause some existing
   implementations to how the '*' operator indicates
   repetition).  Appendix C describes rules imported from other
   documents.  Appendix D shows reject the collected grammar with all list
   operators expanded request.

   Responses to standard ABNF notation.

   This specification uses the terms "character", "character encoding
   scheme", "charset", and "protocol element" as they CONNECT method are defined in
   [RFC6365].

2.  Resources not cacheable.

7.3.7.  OPTIONS

   The OPTIONS method requests information about the communication
   options available for the target resource, at either the origin
   server or an intervening intermediary.  This method allows a client
   to determine the options and/or requirements associated with a
   resource, or the capabilities of a server, without implying a
   resource action.

   An OPTIONS request with an HTTP asterisk ("*") as the request-target
   (Section 3.2 of [Messaging]) applies to the server in general rather
   than to a specific resource.  Since a server's communication options
   typically depend on the resource, the "*" request is called only useful as a "resource".  HTTP
   "ping" or "no-op" type of method; it does not
   limit nothing beyond allowing the nature
   client to test the capabilities of a resource; it merely defines an interface that
   might the server.  For example, this can
   be used to interact with resources.  Each resource is
   identified by a Uniform Resource Identifier (URI), as described in
   Section 2.7 of [MESSGNG].

   When test a client constructs an proxy for HTTP/1.1 conformance (or lack thereof).

   If the request-target is not an asterisk, the OPTIONS request message, it sends applies
   to the options that are available when communicating with the target URI in one of various forms, as defined in (Section 5.3 of
   [MESSGNG]).  When
   resource.

   A server generating a request is received, successful response to OPTIONS SHOULD send any
   header fields that might indicate optional features implemented by
   the server reconstructs an
   effective request URI for and applicable to the target resource (Section 5.5 of
   [MESSGNG]).

   One design goal of HTTP (e.g., Allow),
   including potential extensions not defined by this specification.
   The response payload, if any, might also describe the communication
   options in a machine or human-readable representation.  A standard
   format for such a representation is not defined by this
   specification, but might be defined by future extensions to separate resource identification from
   request semantics, which HTTP.  A
   server MUST generate a Content-Length field with a value of "0" if no
   payload body is made possible by vesting to be sent in the response.

   A client MAY send a Max-Forwards header field in an OPTIONS request
   semantics
   to target a specific recipient in the request method (Section 4) and chain (see
   Section 8.1.2).  A proxy MUST NOT generate a few request-
   modifying Max-Forwards header fields (Section 5).  If there is
   field while forwarding a conflict between
   the method semantics and any semantic implied by the URI itself, as
   described in Section 4.2.1, the method semantics take precedence.

3.  Representations

   Considering request unless that request was received
   with a resource could be anything, and Max-Forwards field.

   A client that generates an OPTIONS request containing a payload body
   MUST send a valid Content-Type header field describing the uniform
   interface provided by
   representation media type.  Although this specification does not
   define any use for such a payload, future extensions to HTTP is similar might
   use the OPTIONS body to make more detailed queries about the target
   resource.

   Responses to the OPTIONS method are not cacheable.

7.3.8.  TRACE

   The TRACE method requests a window through which one
   can observe and act upon such a thing only through remote, application-level loop-back of
   the communication request message.  The final recipient of messages to some independent actor on the other side, an
   abstraction is needed request SHOULD
   reflect the message received, excluding some fields described below,
   back to represent ("take the place of") client as the current
   or desired state message body of that thing in our communications.  That
   abstraction is called a representation [REST].

   For the purposes of HTTP, 200 (OK) response with a "representation" is information that
   Content-Type of "message/http" (Section 10.1 of [Messaging]).  The
   final recipient is
   intended either the origin server or the first server to reflect
   receive a past, current, or desired state Max-Forwards value of a given
   resource, zero (0) in the request
   (Section 8.1.2).

   A client MUST NOT generate header fields in a format TRACE request
   containing sensitive data that can might be readily communicated via disclosed by the
   protocol, and that consists of a set of representation metadata and a
   potentially unbounded stream of representation data.

   An origin server might response.
   For example, it would be provided with, foolish for a user agent to send stored user
   credentials Section 8.5 or be capable cookies [RFC6265] in a TRACE request.  The
   final recipient of generating,
   multiple representations the request SHOULD exclude any request header
   fields that are each intended likely to reflect contain sensitive data when that recipient
   generates the
   current state of a target resource.  In such cases, some algorithm is
   used by response body.

   TRACE allows the origin server to select one of those representations as
   most applicable client to a given request, usually based on content
   negotiation.  This "selected representation" see what is used to provide being received at the
   data other
   end of the request chain and metadata use that data for evaluating conditional requests [CONDTNL] and
   constructing testing or diagnostic
   information.  The value of the payload for 200 (OK) and 304 (Not Modified)
   responses to GET (Section 4.3.1).

3.1.  Representation Metadata

   Representation Via header fields provide metadata about the
   representation.  When a message includes field (Section 5.6.1) is of
   particular interest, since it acts as a payload body, trace of the
   representation request chain.
   Use of the Max-Forwards header fields describe how field allows the client to interpret limit the
   representation data enclosed in
   length of the payload body.  In request chain, which is useful for testing a response to chain of
   proxies forwarding messages in an infinite loop.

   A client MUST NOT send a
   HEAD request, message body in a TRACE request.

   Responses to the representation header fields describe TRACE method are not cacheable.

7.4.  Method Extensibility

   Additional methods, outside the
   representation data that would scope of this specification, have
   been enclosed specified for use in HTTP.  All such methods ought to be
   registered within the payload body
   if the same request had been a GET. "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method
   Registry".

7.4.1.  Method Registry

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method Registry", maintained
   by IANA at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-methods>, registers
   method names.

   HTTP method registrations MUST include the following header fields convey representation metadata:

   +-------------------+-----------------+
   | Header Field fields:

   o  Method Name | Defined in...   |
   +-------------------+-----------------+
   | Content-Type      | Section 3.1.1.5 |
   | Content-Encoding  | (see Section 3.1.2.2 |
   | Content-Language  | 7)

   o  Safe ("yes" or "no", see Section 3.1.3.2 |
   | Content-Location  | 7.2.1)

   o  Idempotent ("yes" or "no", see Section 3.1.4.2 |
   +-------------------+-----------------+

3.1.1.  Processing Representation Data

3.1.1.1.  Media Type

   HTTP uses Internet media types [RFC2046] in the Content-Type
   (Section 3.1.1.5) and Accept (Section 5.3.2) header fields in order 7.2.2)

   o  Pointer to provide open and extensible data typing and type negotiation.
   Media types define both a data format and various processing models:
   how specification text

   Values to process be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

7.4.2.  Considerations for New Methods

   Standardized methods are generic; that data in accordance with each context in which is, they are potentially
   applicable to any resource, not just one particular media type, kind
   of resource, or application.  As such, it is received.

     media-type = type "/" subtype *( OWS ";" OWS parameter )
     type       = token
     subtype    = token

   The type/subtype MAY preferred that new
   methods be followed by parameters registered in the form of
   name=value pairs.

     parameter      = token "=" ( token / quoted-string )

   The type, subtype, and parameter name tokens are case-insensitive.
   Parameter values might a document that isn't specific to a single
   application or might not data format, since orthogonal technologies deserve
   orthogonal specification.

   Since message parsing (Section 6 of [Messaging]) needs to be case-sensitive, depending on
   the
   independent of method semantics (aside from responses to HEAD),
   definitions of new methods cannot change the parameter name.  The presence parsing algorithm or absence of a
   parameter might be significant to
   prohibit the processing presence of a media-type,
   depending message body on its definition within either the media type registry.

   A parameter value that matches request or the token production
   response message.  Definitions of new methods can be
   transmitted either as specify that only a token or within
   zero-length message body is allowed by requiring a quoted-string.  The quoted
   and unquoted values are equivalent.  For example, the following
   examples are all equivalent, but the first Content-Length
   header field with a value of "0".

   A new method definition needs to indicate whether it is preferred for
   consistency:

     text/html;charset=utf-8
     text/html;charset=UTF-8
     Text/HTML;Charset="utf-8"
     text/html; charset="utf-8"

   Internet media types ought safe
   (Section 7.2.1), idempotent (Section 7.2.2), cacheable
   (Section 7.2.3), what semantics are to be registered associated with IANA according to the procedures defined in [BCP13].

      Note: Unlike some similar constructs payload
   body if any is present in other header fields, media
      type parameters do not allow whitespace (even "bad" whitespace)
      around the "=" character.

3.1.1.2.  Charset

   HTTP uses charset names request and what refinements the method
   makes to indicate header field or negotiate status code semantics.  If the character
   encoding scheme of a textual representation [RFC6365].  A charset new method is
   identified by a case-insensitive token.

     charset = token

   Charset names
   cacheable, its definition ought to be registered in the IANA "Character Sets"
   registry (<http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets>) according
   to the procedures defined in [RFC2978].

3.1.1.3.  Canonicalization describe how, and Text Defaults

   Internet media types are registered with under what
   conditions, a canonical form in order cache can store a response and use it to satisfy a
   subsequent request.  The new method ought to describe whether it can
   be interoperable among systems with varying native encoding formats.
   Representations selected or transferred via HTTP made conditional (Section 8.2) and, if so, how a server responds
   when the condition is false.  Likewise, if the new method might have
   some use for partial response semantics (Section 8.3), it ought to
   document this, too.

      Note: Avoid defining a method name that starts with "M-", since
      that prefix might be in
   canonical form, for many of misinterpreted as having the same reasons described semantics
      assigned to it by [RFC2774].

8.  Request Header Fields

   A client sends request header fields to provide more information
   about the
   Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (MIME) [RFC2045].  However, request context, make the
   performance characteristics of email deployments (i.e., store and
   forward messages to peers) are significantly different from those
   common to HTTP and request conditional based on the Web (server-based information services).
   Furthermore, MIME's constraints
   target resource state, suggest preferred formats for the sake of compatibility with
   older mail transfer protocols do not apply to HTTP (see Appendix A).

   MIME's canonical form requires that media subtypes of response,
   supply authentication credentials, or modify the "text" type
   use CRLF expected request
   processing.  These fields act as request modifiers, similar to the text line break.  HTTP allows the transfer of text
   media with plain CR or LF alone representing
   parameters on a line break, when such
   line breaks programming language method invocation.

8.1.  Controls

   Controls are consistent for an entire representation.  An HTTP
   sender MAY generate, and a recipient MUST be able to parse, line
   breaks in text media request header fields that consist direct specific handling of CRLF, bare CR, or bare LF.  In
   addition, text media
   the request.

   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...              |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Cache-Control     | Section 5.2 of [Caching]   |
   | Expect            | Section 8.1.1              |
   | Host              | Section 5.4                |
   | Max-Forwards      | Section 8.1.2              |
   | Pragma            | Section 5.4 of [Caching]   |
   | TE                | Section 7.4 of [Messaging] |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+

8.1.1.  Expect

   The "Expect" header field in HTTP is not limited to charsets that use
   octets 13 and 10 for CR and LF, respectively.  This flexibility
   regarding line breaks applies only to text within a representation
   that has been assigned request indicates a "text" media type; it does not apply certain set of
   behaviors (expectations) that need to
   "multipart" types or HTTP elements outside be supported by the payload body (e.g.,
   header fields).

   If a representation server in
   order to properly handle this request.  The only such expectation
   defined by this specification is encoded 100-continue.

     Expect  = "100-continue"

   The Expect field-value is case-insensitive.

   A server that receives an Expect field-value other than 100-continue
   MAY respond with a content-coding, the underlying
   data ought 417 (Expectation Failed) status code to indicate
   that the unexpected expectation cannot be in a form defined above prior met.

   A 100-continue expectation informs recipients that the client is
   about to being encoded.

3.1.1.4.  Multipart Types

   MIME provides for a number of "multipart" types -- encapsulations of
   one or more representations within send a single (presumably large) message body.  All
   multipart types share a common syntax, as defined body in Section 5.1.1 of
   [RFC2046], this request and include
   wishes to receive a boundary parameter as part of 100 (Continue) interim response if the media type
   value.  The message body request-
   line and header fields are not sufficient to cause an immediate
   success, redirect, or error response.  This allows the client to wait
   for an indication that it is itself a protocol element; a sender MUST
   generate only CRLF worthwhile to represent line breaks between body parts.

   HTTP send the message framing does not use body
   before actually doing so, which can improve efficiency when the multipart boundary as an
   indicator of
   message body length, though it might be used by
   implementations that generate is huge or process the payload.  For example, when the "multipart/form-data" type client anticipates that an error is often used for carrying form data
   in
   likely (e.g., when sending a request, as described in [RFC2388], and the "multipart/
   byteranges" type is defined by this specification state-changing method, for use in some 206
   (Partial Content) responses [RANGERQ].

3.1.1.5.  Content-Type

   The "Content-Type" header field indicates the media type of the
   associated representation: either the representation enclosed in the
   message payload or first
   time, without previously verified authentication credentials).

   For example, a request that begins with

     PUT /somewhere/fun HTTP/1.1
     Host: origin.example.com
     Content-Type: video/h264
     Content-Length: 1234567890987
     Expect: 100-continue

   allows the selected representation, origin server to immediately respond with an error
   message, such as determined by 401 (Unauthorized) or 405 (Method Not Allowed),
   before the
   message semantics.  The indicated media type defines both client starts filling the pipes with an unnecessary data
   format and how
   transfer.

   Requirements for clients:

   o  A client MUST NOT generate a 100-continue expectation in a request
      that data is intended to be processed by does not include a recipient,
   within the scope of the received message semantics, after any content
   codings indicated by Content-Encoding are decoded.

     Content-Type = media-type

   Media types are defined in Section 3.1.1.1.  An example of the field
   is

     Content-Type: text/html; charset=ISO-8859-4 body.

   o  A sender client that generates will wait for a 100 (Continue) response before
      sending the request message containing a payload body SHOULD
   generate a Content-Type MUST send an Expect header field in
      containing a 100-continue expectation.

   o  A client that message unless the
   intended media type of the enclosed representation is unknown to the
   sender.  If sends a Content-Type header field 100-continue expectation is not present, the recipient
   MAY either assume a media type of "application/octet-stream"
   ([RFC2046], Section 4.5.1) or examine the data required to determine its type.

   In practice, resource owners do not always properly configure their
   origin server
      wait for any specific length of time; such a client MAY proceed to provide
      send the correct Content-Type for message body even if it has not yet received a given
   representation, with response.
      Furthermore, since 100 (Continue) responses cannot be sent through
      an HTTP/1.0 intermediary, such a client SHOULD NOT wait for an
      indefinite period before sending the result message body.

   o  A client that some clients will examine receives a
   payload's content and override 417 (Expectation Failed) status code in
      response to a request containing a 100-continue expectation SHOULD
      repeat that request without a 100-continue expectation, since the specified type.  Clients
      417 response merely indicates that do
   so risk drawing incorrect conclusions, which might expose additional
   security risks the response chain does not
      support expectations (e.g., "privilege escalation").  Furthermore, it is
   impossible to determine the sender's intent by examining the data
   format: many data formats match multiple media types passes through an HTTP/1.0 server).

   Requirements for servers:

   o  A server that differ only receives a 100-continue expectation in processing semantics.  Implementers are encouraged to provide an HTTP/1.0
      request MUST ignore that expectation.

   o  A server MAY omit sending a
   means of disabling such "content sniffing" when 100 (Continue) response if it has
      already received some or all of the message body for the
      corresponding request, or if the framing indicates that there is used.

3.1.2.  Encoding for Compression or Integrity

3.1.2.1.  Content Codings

   Content coding values indicate an encoding transformation
      no message body.

   o  A server that has
   been or can be applied to sends a representation.  Content codings are
   primarily used to allow 100 (Continue) response MUST ultimately send
      a representation to be compressed or
   otherwise usefully transformed without losing the identity of its
   underlying media type and without loss of information.  Frequently, final status code, once the representation message body is stored in coded form, transmitted directly, received and
   only decoded by
      processed, unless the connection is closed prematurely.

   o  A server that responds with a final recipient.

     content-coding   = token

   All content-coding values are case-insensitive and ought to be
   registered within status code before reading the "HTTP Content Coding Registry", as defined in
   Section 8.4.  They are used
      entire message body SHOULD indicate in that response whether it
      intends to close the Accept-Encoding (Section 5.3.4) connection or continue reading and Content-Encoding (Section 3.1.2.2) header fields.

   The following content-coding values are defined by this
   specification:

      compress (and x-compress): See Section 4.2.1 of [MESSGNG].

      deflate: See Section 4.2.2 of [MESSGNG].

      gzip (and x-gzip): See discarding
      the request message (see Section 4.2.3 9.6 of [MESSGNG].

3.1.2.2.  Content-Encoding

   The "Content-Encoding" [Messaging]).

   An origin server MUST, upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request-
   line and a complete header field section that contains a 100-continue
   expectation and indicates what content codings
   have been applied to the representation, beyond those inherent in a request message body will follow, either
   send an immediate response with a final status code, if that status
   can be determined by examining just the
   media type, request-line and thus what decoding mechanisms have header
   fields, or send an immediate 100 (Continue) response to be applied in
   order encourage the
   client to obtain data in send the media type referenced by request's message body.  The origin server MUST
   NOT wait for the Content-Type message body before sending the 100 (Continue)
   response.

   A proxy MUST, upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request-line and
   a complete header field.  Content-Encoding is primarily used to allow section that contains a
   representation's data to 100-continue expectation
   and indicates a request message body will follow, either send an
   immediate response with a final status code, if that status can be compressed without losing
   determined by examining just the identity of
   its underlying media type.

     Content-Encoding = 1#content-coding

   An example of its use is

     Content-Encoding: gzip

   If one request-line and header fields, or more encodings have been applied to
   begin forwarding the request toward the origin server by sending a representation,
   corresponding request-line and header section to the
   sender next inbound
   server.  If the proxy believes (from configuration or past
   interaction) that applied the encodings MUST next inbound server only supports HTTP/1.0, the
   proxy MAY generate a Content-Encoding an immediate 100 (Continue) response to encourage
   the client to begin sending the message body.

      Note: The Expect header field that lists was added after the content codings in original
      publication of HTTP/1.1 [RFC2068] as both the order in which
   they were applied.  Additional information about means to request an
      interim 100 (Continue) response and the encoding
   parameters can be provided by other header fields general mechanism for
      indicating must-understand extensions.  However, the extension
      mechanism has not defined been used by this
   specification.

   Unlike Transfer-Encoding (Section 3.3.1 of [MESSGNG]), the codings
   listed in Content-Encoding are a characteristic of clients and the
   representation; must-understand
      requirements have not been implemented by many servers, rendering
      the representation is defined extension mechanism useless.  This specification has removed
      the extension mechanism in terms of order to simplify the coded
   form, definition and all other metadata about
      processing of 100-continue.

8.1.2.  Max-Forwards

   The "Max-Forwards" header field provides a mechanism with the representation is about TRACE
   (Section 7.3.8) and OPTIONS (Section 7.3.7) request methods to limit
   the
   coded form unless otherwise noted in number of times that the metadata definition.
   Typically, request is forwarded by proxies.  This
   can be useful when the representation client is only decoded just prior attempting to rendering
   or analogous usage.

   If the media type includes an inherent encoding, such as trace a data
   format that is always compressed, then request that encoding would not be
   restated in Content-Encoding even if it happens
   appears to be failing or looping mid-chain.

     Max-Forwards = 1*DIGIT

   The Max-Forwards value is a decimal integer indicating the same
   algorithm as one remaining
   number of the content codings.  Such a content coding would
   only times this request message can be listed if, for some bizarre reason, it is applied forwarded.

   Each intermediary that receives a second
   time TRACE or OPTIONS request containing
   a Max-Forwards header field MUST check and update its value prior to form
   forwarding the representation.  Likewise, an origin server might
   choose to publish request.  If the same data received value is zero (0), the
   intermediary MUST NOT forward the request; instead, the intermediary
   MUST respond as multiple representations that
   differ only in whether the coding final recipient.  If the received Max-Forwards
   value is defined as part of Content-Type
   or Content-Encoding, since some user agents will behave differently
   in their handling of each response (e.g., open a "Save as ..." dialog
   instead of automatic decompression and rendering of content).

   An origin server MAY respond with a status code of 415 (Unsupported
   Media Type) if a representation greater than zero, the intermediary MUST generate an updated
   Max-Forwards field in the request forwarded message has with a content
   coding field-value that
   is not acceptable.

3.1.3.  Audience Language

3.1.3.1.  Language Tags

   A language tag, as defined in [RFC5646], identifies a natural
   language spoken, written, or otherwise conveyed by human beings for
   communication of information to other human beings.  Computer
   languages are explicitly excluded.

   HTTP uses language tags within the Accept-Language and Content-
   Language header fields.  Accept-Language uses lesser of a) the broader language-
   range production defined in Section 5.3.5, whereas Content-Language
   uses received value decremented by one (1) or b)
   the language-tag production defined below.

     language-tag = <Language-Tag, see [RFC5646], Section 2.1> recipient's maximum supported value for Max-Forwards.

   A language tag is recipient MAY ignore a sequence of Max-Forwards header field received with any
   other request methods.

8.2.  Preconditions

   A conditional request is an HTTP request with one or more case-insensitive subtags,
   each separated by a hyphen character ("-", %x2D).  In most cases, a
   language tag consists of a primary language subtag that identifies a
   broad family of related languages (e.g., "en" = English), which is
   optionally followed by a series of subtags that refine or narrow that
   language's range (e.g., "en-CA" = the variety of English as
   communicated in Canada).  Whitespace is not allowed within a language
   tag.  Example tags include:

     fr, en-US, es-419, az-Arab, x-pig-latin, man-Nkoo-GN

   See [RFC5646] for further information.

3.1.3.2.  Content-Language

   The "Content-Language" request
   header field describes the natural language(s)
   of the intended audience for the representation.  Note fields that this
   might not be equivalent indicate a precondition to all be tested before
   applying the languages used within request method to the
   representation.

     Content-Language = 1#language-tag

   Language tags target resource.  Section 8.2.1
   defines when preconditions are defined in applied.  Section 3.1.3.1.  The primary purpose 8.2.2 defines the
   order of
   Content-Language evaluation when more than one precondition is present.

   Conditional GET requests are the most efficient mechanism for HTTP
   cache updates [Caching].  Conditionals can also be applied to allow a user to identify state-
   changing methods, such as PUT and differentiate
   representations according DELETE, to prevent the users' own preferred language.
   Thus, if the content is intended only for a Danish-literate audience,
   the appropriate field is

     Content-Language: da

   If no Content-Language is specified, the default is that "lost
   update" problem: one client accidentally overwriting the content
   is intended for all language audiences.  This might mean work of
   another client that has been acting in parallel.

   Conditional request preconditions are based on the
   sender does not consider it to be specific to any natural language,
   or that state of the sender does not know for which language it is intended.

   Multiple languages MAY be listed for content that is intended for
   multiple audiences.  For example,
   target resource as a rendition of whole (its current value set) or the "Treaty of
   Waitangi", presented simultaneously state as
   observed in the original Maori and English
   versions, would call for

     Content-Language: mi, en

   However, just because multiple languages are present within a previously obtained representation does not mean (one value in that it is intended for
   set).  A resource might have multiple
   linguistic audiences.  An example would be a beginner's language
   primer, such as "A First Lesson in Latin", which is clearly intended current representations, each
   with its own observable state.  The conditional request mechanisms
   assume that the mapping of requests to a "selected representation"
   (Section 6) will be used by an English-literate audience.  In this case, consistent over time if the
   Content-Language would properly only include "en".

   Content-Language MAY be applied to any media type -- it is not
   limited server intends to textual documents.

3.1.4.  Identification

3.1.4.1.  Identifying a Representation

   When a complete or partial representation is transferred in a message
   payload, it
   take advantage of conditionals.  Regardless, if the mapping is often desirable for
   inconsistent and the sender server is unable to supply, or select the
   recipient appropriate
   representation, then no harm will result when the precondition
   evaluates to determine, an identifier for false.

   The following request header fields allow a resource corresponding client to
   that representation.

   For place a request message:

   o  If
   precondition on the request has a Content-Location header field, then state of the
      sender asserts target resource, so that the payload is a representation of the
      resource identified by action
   corresponding to the Content-Location field-value.  However,
      such an assertion cannot be trusted unless it can method semantics will not be verified by
      other means (not applied if the
   precondition evaluates to false.  Each precondition defined by this specification).  The information
      might still be useful for revision history links.

   o  Otherwise, the payload is unidentified.

   For a response message, the following rules are applied in order
   until
   specification consists of a match is found:

   1.  If the request method is GET or HEAD and the response status code
       is 200 (OK), 204 (No Content), 206 (Partial Content), or 304 (Not
       Modified), the payload is comparison between a representation set of validators
   obtained from prior representations of the target resource
       identified by to the effective request URI (Section 5.5
   current state of
       [MESSGNG]).

   2.  If the request method is GET or HEAD and the response status code
       is 203 (Non-Authoritative Information), validators for the payload is a
       potentially modified or enhanced selected representation
   (Section 10.2).  Hence, these preconditions evaluate whether the
   state of the target resource as provided has changed since a given state known by
   the client.  The effect of such an intermediary.

   3.  If evaluation depends on the response has method
   semantics and choice of conditional, as defined in Section 8.2.1.

   +---------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name   | Defined in... |
   +---------------------+---------------+
   | If-Match            | Section 8.2.3 |
   | If-None-Match       | Section 8.2.4 |
   | If-Modified-Since   | Section 8.2.5 |
   | If-Unmodified-Since | Section 8.2.6 |
   | If-Range            | Section 8.2.7 |
   +---------------------+---------------+

8.2.1.  Evaluation

   Except when excluded below, a Content-Location header field recipient cache or origin server MUST
   evaluate received request preconditions after it has successfully
   performed its normal request checks and just before it would perform
   the action associated with the request method.  A server MUST ignore
   all received preconditions if its
       field-value is a reference response to the same URI as the effective request URI,
   without those conditions would have been a status code other than a
   2xx (Successful) or 412 (Precondition Failed).  In other words,
   redirects and failures take precedence over the payload evaluation of
   preconditions in conditional requests.

   A server that is not the origin server for the target resource and
   cannot act as a representation of cache for requests on the target resource
       identified by MUST NOT
   evaluate the effective conditional request URI.

   4.  If the response has a Content-Location header field fields defined by this
   specification, and its
       field-value is a reference to a URI different from it MUST forward them if the effective request URI, then the sender asserts that the payload is a
       representation of the resource identified by forwarded,
   since the Content-Location
       field-value.  However, such an assertion cannot be trusted unless
       it can generating client intends that they be verified evaluated by other means (not a
   server that can provide a current representation.  Likewise, a server
   MUST ignore the conditional request header fields defined by this
       specification).

   5.  Otherwise, the payload is unidentified.

3.1.4.2.  Content-Location

   The "Content-Location" header field references
   specification when received with a URI request method that can be used
   as an identifier for does not
   involve the selection or modification of a specific resource corresponding selected representation,
   such as CONNECT, OPTIONS, or TRACE.

   Conditional request header fields that are defined by extensions to
   HTTP might place conditions on all recipients, on the
   representation state of the
   target resource in this message's payload.  In other words, if one
   were to perform general, or on a group of resources.  For
   instance, the "If" header field in WebDAV can make a GET request
   conditional on this URI at various aspects of multiple resources, such as locks,
   if the time recipient understands and implements that field ([RFC4918],
   Section 10.4).

   Although conditional request header fields are defined as being
   usable with the HEAD method (to keep HEAD's semantics consistent with
   those of this
   message's generation, then GET), there is no point in sending a 200 (OK) conditional HEAD
   because a successful response would contain is around the same
   representation that is enclosed size as payload in this message.

     Content-Location = absolute-URI / partial-URI

   The Content-Location value a 304 (Not
   Modified) response and more useful than a 412 (Precondition Failed)
   response.

8.2.2.  Precedence

   When more than one conditional request header field is not present in a replacement for the effective
   Request URI (Section 5.5 of [MESSGNG]).  It is representation
   metadata.  It has
   request, the same syntax and semantics as order in which the header field
   of fields are evaluated becomes
   important.  In practice, the same name fields defined for MIME body parts in Section 4 of
   [RFC2557].  However, its appearance this document are
   consistently implemented in an HTTP message has some
   special implications for HTTP recipients.

   If Content-Location a single, logical order, since "lost
   update" preconditions have more strict requirements than cache
   validation, a validated cache is included in more efficient than a 2xx (Successful) response
   message partial
   response, and its value refers (after conversion to absolute form) entity tags are presumed to a
   URI that is the same as be more accurate than date
   validators.

   A recipient cache or origin server MUST evaluate the effective request URI, then
   preconditions defined by this specification in the following order:

   1.  When recipient
   MAY consider is the payload origin server and If-Match is present,
       evaluate the If-Match precondition:

       *  if true, continue to step 3

       *  if false, respond 412 (Precondition Failed) unless it can be a current representation of
          determined that
   resource at the time indicated by the message origination date.  For
   a GET (Section 4.3.1) or HEAD (Section 4.3.2) request, this state-changing request has already
          succeeded (see Section 8.2.3)

   2.  When recipient is the
   same as the default semantics when no Content-Location origin server, If-Match is provided by not present, and
       If-Unmodified-Since is present, evaluate the server.  For a state-changing request like PUT (Section 4.3.4) or
   POST (Section 4.3.3), If-Unmodified-Since
       precondition:

       *  if true, continue to step 3

       *  if false, respond 412 (Precondition Failed) unless it implies can be
          determined that the server's response contains
   the new representation of that resource, thereby distinguishing it
   from representations that might only report about state-changing request has already
          succeeded (see Section 8.2.6)

   3.  When If-None-Match is present, evaluate the action (e.g.,
   "It worked!").  This allows authoring applications If-None-Match
       precondition:

       *  if true, continue to update their
   local copies without the need step 5

       *  if false for a subsequent GET/HEAD, respond 304 (Not Modified)

       *  if false for other methods, respond 412 (Precondition Failed)

   4.  When the method is GET request.

   If Content-Location or HEAD, If-None-Match is included in a 2xx (Successful) response
   message not present, and its field-value refers
       If-Modified-Since is present, evaluate the If-Modified-Since
       precondition:

       *  if true, continue to a URI that differs from step 5

       *  if false, respond 304 (Not Modified)

   5.  When the
   effective request URI, then method is GET and both Range and If-Range are present,
       evaluate the origin server claims that If-Range precondition:

       *  if the URI validator matches and the Range specification is
   an identifier for a different resource corresponding
          applicable to the enclosed
   representation.  Such a claim can only be trusted if both identifiers
   share selected representation, respond 206
          (Partial Content)

   6.  Otherwise,

       *  all conditions are met, so perform the same resource owner, which cannot be programmatically
   determined via HTTP.

   o  For a response requested action and
          respond according to a GET its success or HEAD request, this is an indication
      that the effective request URI refers failure.

   Any extension to a resource HTTP/1.1 that is
      subject defines additional conditional request
   header fields ought to content negotiation and define its own expectations regarding the Content-Location field-
      value is a more specific identifier
   order for the selected
      representation.

   o  For a 201 (Created) response evaluating such fields in relation to a state-changing method, a
      Content-Location field-value those defined in this
   document and other conditionals that is identical to might be found in practice.

8.2.3.  If-Match

   The "If-Match" header field makes the Location
      field-value indicates that this payload is a request method conditional on
   the recipient origin server either having at least one current
   representation of the newly created resource.

   o  Otherwise, such a Content-Location indicates that this payload target resource, when the field-value is "*",
   or having a current representation reporting on of the requested action's status and target resource that the same report is available (for future access with GET) at
      the given URI.  For example, a purchase transaction made via a
      POST request might include has an
   entity-tag matching a receipt document as member of the payload list of entity-tags provided in
   the 200 (OK) response; field-value.

   An origin server MUST use the Content-Location field-value provides
      an identifier strong comparison function when
   comparing entity-tags for retrieving a copy of that same receipt in If-Match (Section 10.2.3.2), since the
      future.

   A user agent that sends Content-Location in a request message is
   stating that its value refers
   client intends this precondition to where the user agent originally
   obtained prevent the content of method from being
   applied if there have been any changes to the enclosed representation (prior data.

     If-Match = "*" / 1#entity-tag

   Examples:

     If-Match: "xyzzy"
     If-Match: "xyzzy", "r2d2xxxx", "c3piozzzz"
     If-Match: *

   If-Match is most often used with state-changing methods (e.g., POST,
   PUT, DELETE) to any
   modifications made by that prevent accidental overwrites when multiple user agent).  In other words,
   agents might be acting in parallel on the user
   agent is providing a back link same resource (i.e., to
   prevent the source of "lost update" problem).  It can also be used with safe
   methods to abort a request if the original
   representation. selected representation does not
   match one already stored (or partially stored) from a prior request.

   An origin server that receives a Content-Location an If-Match header field in a request
   message MUST treat evaluate
   the information as transitory request context
   rather than as metadata condition prior to be saved verbatim as part performing the method (Section 8.2.1).  If the
   field-value is "*", the condition is false if the origin server does
   not have a current representation for the target resource.  If the
   field-value is a list of entity-tags, the condition is false if none
   of the listed tags match the entity-tag of the selected
   representation.

   An origin server MAY use that context to guide in
   processing MUST NOT perform the request or requested method if a received
   If-Match condition evaluates to save it for other uses, such as within
   source links or versioning metadata.  However, an false; instead, the origin server
   MUST
   NOT use such context information to alter respond with either a) the request semantics.

   For example, 412 (Precondition Failed) status code
   or b) one of the 2xx (Successful) status codes if a client makes a PUT request on a negotiated resource
   and the origin server accepts
   has verified that PUT (without redirection), then
   the new a state of that resource change is expected to be consistent with being requested and the
   one representation supplied final
   state is already reflected in that PUT; the Content-Location cannot
   be used as a form of reverse content selection identifier to update
   only one current state of the negotiated representations.  If target
   resource (i.e., the change requested by the user agent had
   wanted the latter semantics, it would have applied has already
   succeeded, but the PUT directly
   to user agent might not be aware of it, perhaps
   because the Content-Location URI.

3.2.  Representation Data

   The representation data associated with an HTTP message is either
   provided as prior response was lost or a compatible change was made
   by some other user agent).  In the payload body of latter case, the message or referred to by origin server
   MUST NOT send a validator header field in the
   message semantics and response unless it can
   verify that the effective request URI.  The representation
   data is in a format and encoding defined duplicate of an immediately prior change
   made by the representation
   metadata header fields. same user agent.

   The data type of the representation data is determined via the If-Match header
   fields Content-Type field can be ignored by caches and Content-Encoding.  These define intermediaries
   because it is not applicable to a two-layer,
   ordered encoding model:

     representation-data := Content-Encoding( Content-Type( bits ) )

3.3.  Payload Semantics

   Some HTTP messages transfer stored response.

8.2.4.  If-None-Match

   The "If-None-Match" header field makes the request method conditional
   on a complete recipient cache or partial origin server either not having any current
   representation as of the message "payload".  In some cases, a payload might contain only target resource, when the associated representation's header fields (e.g., responses to
   HEAD) field-value is "*",
   or only some part(s) having a selected representation with an entity-tag that does not
   match any of those listed in the representation data (e.g., field-value.

   A recipient MUST use the 206
   (Partial Content) status code).

   The purpose weak comparison function when comparing
   entity-tags for If-None-Match (Section 10.2.3.2), since weak entity-
   tags can be used for cache validation even if there have been changes
   to the representation data.

     If-None-Match = "*" / 1#entity-tag

   Examples:

     If-None-Match: "xyzzy"
     If-None-Match: W/"xyzzy"
     If-None-Match: "xyzzy", "r2d2xxxx", "c3piozzzz"
     If-None-Match: W/"xyzzy", W/"r2d2xxxx", W/"c3piozzzz"
     If-None-Match: *

   If-None-Match is primarily used in conditional GET requests to enable
   efficient updates of cached information with a payload in minimum amount of
   transaction overhead.  When a request is defined by client desires to update one or more
   stored responses that have entity-tags, the method
   semantics.  For example, client SHOULD generate an
   If-None-Match header field containing a representation in the payload list of those entity-tags
   when making a PUT
   request (Section 4.3.4) represents GET request; this allows recipient servers to send a
   304 (Not Modified) response to indicate when one of those stored
   responses matches the desired state selected representation.

   If-None-Match can also be used with a value of "*" to prevent an
   unsafe request method (e.g., PUT) from inadvertently modifying an
   existing representation of the target resource if when the request is successfully applied, whereas a
   representation in client
   believes that the payload of resource does not have a POST request current representation
   (Section 4.3.3)
   represents information 7.2.1).  This is a variation on the "lost update" problem
   that might arise if more than one client attempts to be processed by create an
   initial representation for the target resource.

   In a response,

   An origin server that receives an If-None-Match header field MUST
   evaluate the payload's purpose is defined by both condition prior to performing the request method and
   (Section 8.2.1).  If the response status code.  For example, field-value is "*", the payload of a
   200 (OK) response to GET (Section 4.3.1) represents condition is false
   if the origin server has a current state
   of representation for the target resource, as observed at
   resource.  If the time field-value is a list of entity-tags, the message
   origination date (Section 7.1.1.2), whereas the payload condition
   is false if one of the same
   status code in a response to POST might represent either the
   processing result or listed tags match the new state entity-tag of the target resource after
   applying the processing.  Response messages with an error status code
   usually contain a payload that represents the error condition, such
   that it describes the error state and what next steps are suggested
   for resolving it.

   Header fields that specifically describe
   selected representation.

   An origin server MUST NOT perform the payload, rather than requested method if the
   associated representation, are referred
   condition evaluates to as "payload header
   fields".  Payload false; instead, the origin server MUST respond
   with either a) the 304 (Not Modified) status code if the request
   method is GET or HEAD or b) the 412 (Precondition Failed) status code
   for all other request methods.

   Requirements on cache handling of a received If-None-Match header fields
   field are defined in other parts of this
   specification, due to their impact on message parsing.

   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...              |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+
   | Content-Length    | Section 3.3.2 of [MESSGNG] |
   | Content-Range     | Section 4.2 of [RANGERQ]   |
   | Trailer           | Section 4.4 of [MESSGNG]   |
   | Transfer-Encoding | Section 3.3.1 4.3.2 of [MESSGNG] |
   +-------------------+----------------------------+

3.4.  Content Negotiation

   When responses convey payload information, whether indicating [Caching].

8.2.5.  If-Modified-Since

   The "If-Modified-Since" header field makes a
   success GET or an error, HEAD request
   method conditional on the origin server often has different ways of
   representing that information; for example, selected representation's modification date
   being more recent than the date provided in different formats,
   languages, or encodings.  Likewise, different users or user agents
   might have differing capabilities, characteristics, or preferences
   that could influence which representation, among those available,
   would be best to deliver.  For this reason, HTTP provides mechanisms
   for content negotiation.

   This specification defines two patterns the field-value.
   Transfer of content negotiation the selected representation's data is avoided if that
   can be made visible within
   data has not changed.

     If-Modified-Since = HTTP-date

   An example of the protocol: "proactive", where field is:

     If-Modified-Since: Sat, 29 Oct 1994 19:43:31 GMT

   A recipient MUST ignore If-Modified-Since if the
   server selects request contains an
   If-None-Match header field; the representation based upon condition in If-None-Match is
   considered to be a more accurate replacement for the user agent's stated
   preferences, condition in If-
   Modified-Since, and "reactive" negotiation, where the server provides a
   list of representations two are only combined for the user agent to choose from.  Other
   patterns of content negotiation include "conditional content", where
   the representation consists sake of multiple parts
   interoperating with older intermediaries that are selectively
   rendered based on user agent parameters, "active content", where might not implement If-
   None-Match.

   A recipient MUST ignore the
   representation contains If-Modified-Since header field if the
   received field-value is not a script that makes additional (more
   specific) requests based on valid HTTP-date, or if the user agent characteristics, and
   "Transparent Content Negotiation" ([RFC2295]), where content
   selection request
   method is performed by neither GET nor HEAD.

   A recipient MUST interpret an intermediary.  These patterns are not
   mutually exclusive, and each has trade-offs in applicability and
   practicality.

   Note that, If-Modified-Since field-value's
   timestamp in all cases, HTTP is not aware terms of the resource semantics.
   The consistency with which an origin server responds server's clock.

   If-Modified-Since is typically used for two distinct purposes: 1) to requests,
   over time and over the varying dimensions
   allow efficient updates of content negotiation, a cached representation that does not have
   an entity-tag and
   thus 2) to limit the "sameness" scope of a resource's observed representations over
   time, is determined entirely by whatever entity or algorithm selects
   or generates those responses.  HTTP pays no attention web traversal to the man
   behind the curtain.

3.4.1.  Proactive Negotiation
   resources that have recently changed.

   When content negotiation preferences are sent by the user agent in used for cache updates, a
   request cache will typically use the value of
   the cached message's Last-Modified field to encourage an algorithm located at generate the field value
   of If-Modified-Since.  This behavior is most interoperable for cases
   where clocks are poorly synchronized or when the server has chosen to select
   only honor exact timestamp matches (due to a problem with Last-
   Modified dates that appear to go "back in time" when the
   preferred representation, it origin
   server's clock is called proactive negotiation (a.k.a.,
   server-driven negotiation).  Selection corrected or a representation is restored from an
   archived backup).  However, caches occasionally generate the field
   value based on the available
   representations for a response (the dimensions over which it might
   vary, other data, such as language, content-coding, etc.) compared to various
   information supplied in the request, including both the explicit
   negotiation fields Date header field of Section 5.3 and implicit characteristics, such
   as the client's network address
   cached message or parts of the User-Agent field.

   Proactive negotiation is advantageous local clock time that the message was received,
   particularly when the algorithm cached message does not contain a Last-Modified
   field.

   When used for
   selecting from among limiting the available representations is difficult to
   describe scope of retrieval to a recent time
   window, a user agent, agent will generate an If-Modified-Since field value
   based on either its own local clock or when a Date header field received
   from the server desires to send its
   "best guess" in a prior response.  Origin servers that choose an
   exact timestamp match based on the selected representation's Last-
   Modified field will not be able to help the user agent along with limit its data
   transfers to only those changed during the first response (hoping specified window.

   An origin server that receives an If-Modified-Since header field
   SHOULD evaluate the condition prior to avoid performing the round trip delay of a subsequent request method
   (Section 8.2.1).  The origin server SHOULD NOT perform the requested
   method if the "best
   guess" selected representation's last modification date is good enough for the user).  In order
   earlier than or equal to improve the
   server's guess, a user agent MAY send request header fields that
   describe its preferences.

   Proactive negotiation has serious disadvantages:

   o  It is impossible for date provided in the field-value;
   instead, the origin server to accurately determine what might
      be "best" for any given user, since SHOULD generate a 304 (Not Modified)
   response, including only those metadata that would require complete
      knowledge are useful for
   identifying or updating a previously cached response.

   Requirements on cache handling of both the capabilities a received If-Modified-Since header
   field are defined in Section 4.3.2 of [Caching].

8.2.6.  If-Unmodified-Since

   The "If-Unmodified-Since" header field makes the user agent and request method
   conditional on the
      intended use for selected representation's last modification date
   being earlier than or equal to the response (e.g., does date provided in the user want to view it
      on screen or print it on paper?);

   o  Having field-value.
   This field accomplishes the same purpose as If-Match for cases where
   the user agent describe its capabilities in every request
      can be both very inefficient (given that only a small percentage
      of responses does not have multiple representations) and a potential risk
      to the user's privacy;

   o  It complicates an entity-tag for the implementation representation.

     If-Unmodified-Since = HTTP-date

   An example of the field is:

     If-Unmodified-Since: Sat, 29 Oct 1994 19:43:31 GMT

   A recipient MUST ignore If-Unmodified-Since if the request contains
   an origin server and If-Match header field; the
      algorithms for generating responses condition in If-Match is considered to
   be a request; and,

   o  It limits more accurate replacement for the reusability of responses condition in If-Unmodified-
   Since, and the two are only combined for shared caching.

   A user agent cannot rely on proactive negotiation preferences being
   consistently honored, since the origin server sake of interoperating
   with older intermediaries that might not implement
   proactive negotiation for If-Match.

   A recipient MUST ignore the requested resource or might decide that
   sending a response that doesn't conform to If-Unmodified-Since header field if the user agent's
   preferences
   received field-value is better than sending not a 406 (Not Acceptable) response. valid HTTP-date.

   A Vary header field (Section 7.1.4) recipient MUST interpret an If-Unmodified-Since field-value's
   timestamp in terms of the origin server's clock.

   If-Unmodified-Since is most often sent used with state-changing methods
   (e.g., POST, PUT, DELETE) to prevent accidental overwrites when
   multiple user agents might be acting in parallel on a response
   subject to proactive negotiation resource that
   does not supply entity-tags with its representations (i.e., to indicate what parts of
   prevent the
   request information were "lost update" problem).  It can also be used in the selection algorithm.

3.4.2.  Reactive Negotiation

   With reactive negotiation (a.k.a., agent-driven negotiation),
   selection of with safe
   methods to abort a request if the best response selected representation (regardless of the
   status code) is performed by the user agent after receiving an
   initial response does not
   match one already stored (or partially stored) from the a prior request.

   An origin server that contains a list of
   resources for alternative representations.  If receives an If-Unmodified-Since header field
   MUST evaluate the user agent is not
   satisfied by condition prior to performing the initial response representation, it can method
   (Section 8.2.1).  The origin server MUST NOT perform a
   GET request on one or more of the alternative resources, requested
   method if the selected
   based on metadata included representation's last modification date is
   more recent than the date provided in the list, to obtain a different form of
   representation for that response.  Selection of alternatives might be
   performed automatically by field-value; instead the user agent
   origin server MUST respond with either a) the 412 (Precondition
   Failed) status code or manually by b) one of the user
   selecting from a generated (possibly hypertext) menu.

   Note that 2xx (Successful) status codes if
   the above refers to representations of origin server has verified that a state change is being requested
   and the response, final state is already reflected in
   general, not representations of the resource.  The alternative
   representations are only considered representations current state of the
   target resource if (i.e., the response in which those alternatives are provided change requested by the user agent has
   already succeeded, but the semantics of being a representation user agent might not be aware of that
   because the target resource (e.g.,
   a 200 (OK) prior response to a GET request) message was lost or has a compatible change
   was made by some other user agent).  In the semantics of
   providing links to alternative representations for latter case, the target
   resource (e.g., a 300 (Multiple Choices) response to a GET request).

   A origin
   server might choose not to MUST NOT send an initial representation, other
   than a validator header field in the list of alternatives, and thereby indicate response unless
   it can verify that reactive
   negotiation by the user agent request is preferred.  For example, the
   alternatives listed in responses with the 300 (Multiple Choices) and
   406 (Not Acceptable) status codes include information about the
   available representations so that a duplicate of an immediately prior
   change made by the same user or user agent agent.

   The If-Unmodified-Since header field can react be ignored by
   making a selection.

   Reactive negotiation caches and
   intermediaries because it is advantageous when the response would vary
   over commonly used dimensions (such as type, language, or encoding),
   when the origin server not applicable to a stored response.

8.2.7.  If-Range

   The "If-Range" header field provides a special conditional request
   mechanism that is unable similar to determine a user agent's
   capabilities from examining the request, If-Match and generally when public
   caches are used If-Unmodified-Since
   header fields but that instructs the recipient to distribute server load and reduce network usage.

   Reactive negotiation suffers from ignore the disadvantages Range
   header field if the validator doesn't match, resulting in transfer of
   the new selected representation instead of transmitting a
   list 412 (Precondition
   Failed) response.

   If a client has a partial copy of alternatives a representation and wishes to have
   an up-to-date copy of the user agent, which degrades user-perceived
   latency if transmitted in entire representation, it could use the
   Range header section, field with a conditional GET (using either or both of
   If-Unmodified-Since and needing If-Match.)  However, if the precondition
   fails because the representation has been modified, the client would
   then have to make a second request to obtain an alternate the entire current
   representation.  Furthermore, this
   specification does not define a mechanism for supporting automatic
   selection, though it does not prevent such a mechanism from being
   developed as an extension.

4.  Request Methods

4.1.  Overview

   The request method token is the primary source of request semantics;
   it indicates "If-Range" header field allows a client to "short-circuit" the purpose for which
   second request.  Informally, its meaning is as follows: if the client has made this request
   and what
   representation is expected by unchanged, send me the part(s) that I am requesting
   in Range; otherwise, send me the entire representation.

     If-Range = entity-tag / HTTP-date

   A client as MUST NOT generate an If-Range header field in a successful result.

   The request method's semantics might be further specialized by the
   semantics of some that
   does not contain a Range header fields when present field.  A server MUST ignore an If-
   Range header field received in a request (Section 5)
   if those additional semantics do that does not conflict with the method.  For
   example, contain a client can send conditional request
   Range header fields
   (Section 5.2) to make the requested action conditional on the current
   state of the target resource ([CONDTNL]).

     method = token

   HTTP was originally designed to be usable as field.  An origin server MUST ignore an interface to
   distributed object systems.  The If-Range header
   field received in a request method was envisioned as
   applying semantics to for a target resource in much the same way as
   invoking a defined method on that does not
   support Range requests.

   A client MUST NOT generate an identified object would apply
   semantics.  The method token If-Range header field containing an
   entity-tag that is case-sensitive because it might be
   used marked as a gateway to object-based systems with case-sensitive method
   names.

   Unlike distributed objects, weak.  A client MUST NOT generate an If-
   Range header field containing an HTTP-date unless the standardized request methods in HTTP
   are not resource-specific, since uniform interfaces provide client has no
   entity-tag for
   better visibility the corresponding representation and reuse in network-based systems [REST].  Once
   defined, the date is a standardized method ought to have
   strong validator in the same semantics sense defined by Section 10.2.2.2.

   A server that evaluates an If-Range precondition MUST use the strong
   comparison function when
   applied to any resource, though each resource determines for itself
   whether those semantics are implemented or allowed.

   This specification defines a number of standardized methods comparing entity-tags (Section 10.2.3.2) and
   MUST evaluate the condition as false if an HTTP-date validator is
   provided that are
   commonly used is not a strong validator in HTTP, as outlined the sense defined by
   Section 10.2.2.2.  A valid entity-tag can be distinguished from a
   valid HTTP-date by examining the following table.  By
   convention, standardized methods are defined in all-uppercase US-
   ASCII letters.

   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+
   | Method  | Description                                     | Sec.  |
   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+
   | GET     | Transfer first two characters for a current representation of DQUOTE.

   If the target | 4.3.1 |
   |         | resource.                                       |       |
   | HEAD    | Same as GET, but only transfer validator given in the status line  | 4.3.2 |
   |         | and If-Range header section.                             |       |
   | POST    | Perform resource-specific processing on field matches the     | 4.3.3 |
   |         | request payload.                                |       |
   | PUT     | Replace all
   current representations of the      | 4.3.4 |
   |         | target resource with validator for the request payload.       |       |
   | DELETE  | Remove all current representations selected representation of the       | 4.3.5 |
   |         | target resource.                                |       |
   | CONNECT | Establish a tunnel to
   resource, then the server identified by  | 4.3.6 |
   |         | the target resource.                            |       |
   | OPTIONS | Describe the communication options for SHOULD process the      | 4.3.7 |
   |         | target resource.                                |       |
   | TRACE   | Perform a message loop-back test along Range header field as
   requested.  If the path | 4.3.8 |
   |         | to validator does not match, the target resource.                         |       |
   +---------+-------------------------------------------------+-------+

   All general-purpose servers server MUST support the methods GET and HEAD.
   All other methods are OPTIONAL.

   Additional methods, outside ignore
   the scope of Range header field.  Note that this specification, have
   been standardized for use in HTTP.  All such methods ought to be
   registered within the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method
   Registry" maintained by IANA, as defined in Section 8.1.

   The set of methods allowed comparison by a target resource can be listed in exact match,
   including when the validator is an
   Allow HTTP-date, differs from the
   "earlier than or equal to" comparison used when evaluating an If-
   Unmodified-Since conditional.

8.3.  Range

   The "Range" header field (Section 7.4.1).  However, the set of allowed
   methods can change dynamically.  When on a GET request modifies the method is received
   that is unrecognized
   semantics to request transfer of only one or not implemented by an origin server, more subranges of the
   origin server SHOULD respond with
   selected representation data, rather than the 501 (Not Implemented) status
   code. entire selected
   representation data.

     Range = byte-ranges-specifier / other-ranges-specifier
     other-ranges-specifier = other-range-unit "=" other-range-set
     other-range-set = 1*VCHAR

   Clients often encounter interrupted data transfers as a result of
   canceled requests or dropped connections.  When a request method client has stored a
   partial representation, it is received desirable to request the remainder of
   that is known by representation in a subsequent request rather than transfer the
   entire representation.  Likewise, devices with limited local storage
   might benefit from being able to request only a subset of a larger
   representation, such as a single page of a very large document, or
   the dimensions of an origin
   server but embedded image.

   Range requests are an OPTIONAL feature of HTTP, designed so that
   recipients not allowed implementing this feature (or not supporting it for
   the target resource, the origin server
   SHOULD resource) can respond with the 405 (Method Not Allowed) status code.

4.2.  Common Method Properties

4.2.1.  Safe Methods

   Request methods are considered "safe" as if their defined semantics it is a normal GET request
   without impacting interoperability.  Partial responses are
   essentially read-only; i.e., the client does not request, and does indicated
   by a distinct status code to not expect, any state change on be mistaken for full responses by
   caches that might not implement the origin feature.

   A server as a result of
   applying a safe method MAY ignore the Range header field.  However, origin servers
   and intermediate caches ought to a target resource.  Likewise, reasonable
   use support byte ranges when possible,
   since Range supports efficient recovery from partially failed
   transfers and partial retrieval of large representations.  A server
   MUST ignore a safe Range header field received with a request method other
   than GET.

   Although the range request mechanism is not expected designed to cause any harm, loss of
   property, or unusual burden on the allow for
   extensible range types, this specification only defines requests for
   byte ranges.

   An origin server.

   This definition of safe methods server MUST ignore a Range header field that contains a
   range unit it does not prevent an implementation
   from including behavior that is potentially harmful, understand.  A proxy MAY discard a Range
   header field that is contains a range unit it does not
   entirely read-only, understand.

   A server that supports range requests MAY ignore or reject a Range
   header field that causes side effects while invoking consists of more than two overlapping ranges, or a safe
   method.  What is important, however, is
   set of many small ranges that the client did are not listed in ascending order,
   since both are indications of either a broken client or a deliberate
   denial-of-service attack (Section 12.13).  A client SHOULD NOT
   request multiple ranges that additional behavior and cannot be held accountable for
   it.  For example, most servers append request information are inherently less efficient to access
   log files at the completion of every response, regardless of the
   method, process
   and transfer than a single range that is considered safe even though the log storage might
   become full and crash encompasses the server.  Likewise, same data.

   A client that is requesting multiple ranges SHOULD list those ranges
   in ascending order (the order in which they would typically be
   received in a safe complete representation) unless there is a specific
   need to request initiated
   by selecting a later part earlier.  For example, a user agent
   processing a large representation with an advertisement on the Web will often have the side
   effect internal catalog of charging an advertising account.

   Of the parts
   might need to request methods defined by this specification, later parts first, particularly if the GET, HEAD,
   OPTIONS,
   representation consists of pages stored in reverse order and TRACE methods are defined the user
   agent wishes to be safe. transfer one page at a time.

   The purpose of distinguishing between safe and unsafe methods Range header field is to
   allow automated retrieval processes (spiders) evaluated after evaluating the precondition
   header fields defined in Section 8.2, and cache performance
   optimization (pre-fetching) to work without fear only if the result in
   absence of causing harm. the Range header field would be a 200 (OK) response.  In
   addition, it allows
   other words, Range is ignored when a user agent conditional GET would result in
   a 304 (Not Modified) response.

   The If-Range header field (Section 8.2.7) can be used as a
   precondition to apply appropriate constraints on applying the automated use Range header field.

   If all of unsafe methods when processing potentially
   untrusted content.

   A user agent SHOULD distinguish between safe the preconditions are true, the server supports the Range
   header field for the target resource, and unsafe methods when
   presenting potential actions to a user, such that the user can be
   made aware of an unsafe action before it is requested.

   When specified range(s) are
   valid and satisfiable (as defined in Section 6.1.4.1), the server
   SHOULD send a resource is constructed such 206 (Partial Content) response with a payload
   containing one or more partial representations that parameters within the
   effective request URI have correspond to the effect
   satisfiable ranges requested.

   If all of selecting an action, it is the resource owner's responsibility to ensure that preconditions are true, the action is
   consistent with server supports the request method semantics.  For example, it is
   common Range
   header field for Web-based content editing software to use actions within
   query parameters, such as "page?do=delete".  If the purpose of such a
   resource is to perform an unsafe action, then target resource, and the resource owner MUST
   disable specified range(s) are
   invalid or disallow that action when it is accessed using unsatisfiable, the server SHOULD send a safe 416 (Range Not
   Satisfiable) response.

8.4.  Content Negotiation

   The following request method.  Failure header fields are sent by a user agent to do so will result
   engage in unfortunate side
   effects when automated processes perform a GET on every URI reference
   for the sake proactive negotiation of link maintenance, pre-fetching, building a search
   index, etc.

4.2.2.  Idempotent Methods

   A request method is considered "idempotent" if the intended effect on response content, as defined
   in Section 6.4.1.  The preferences sent in these fields apply to any
   content in the server response, including representations of multiple identical requests with the target
   resource, representations of error or processing status, and
   potentially even the miscellaneous text strings that method is might appear
   within the
   same as protocol.

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in... |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Accept            | Section 8.4.2 |
   | Accept-Charset    | Section 8.4.3 |
   | Accept-Encoding   | Section 8.4.4 |
   | Accept-Language   | Section 8.4.5 |
   +-------------------+---------------+

8.4.1.  Quality Values

   Many of the effect request header fields for proactive negotiation use a single such request.  Of the request methods
   defined by this specification, PUT, DELETE, and safe request methods
   are idempotent.

   Like
   common parameter, named "q" (case-insensitive), to assign a relative
   "weight" to the definition preference for that associated kind of safe, the idempotent property only applies content.  This
   weight is referred to
   what has been requested by the user; as a server "quality value" (or "qvalue") because the
   same parameter name is free often used within server configurations to log each
   request separately, retain
   assign a revision control history, or implement
   other non-idempotent side effects for each idempotent request.

   Idempotent methods are distinguished because weight to the request relative quality of the various
   representations that can be
   repeated automatically if selected for a communication failure occurs before the
   client resource.

   The weight is able normalized to read the server's response.  For example, if a
   client sends a PUT request and real number in the underlying connection is closed
   before any response range 0 through 1,
   where 0.001 is received, then the client can establish a new
   connection least preferred and retry the idempotent request.  It knows that repeating 1 is the request will have most preferred; a
   value of 0 means "not acceptable".  If no "q" parameter is present,
   the same intended effect, even if default weight is 1.

     weight = OWS ";" OWS "q=" qvalue
     qvalue = ( "0" [ "." 0*3DIGIT ] )
            / ( "1" [ "." 0*3("0") ] )

   A sender of qvalue MUST NOT generate more than three digits after the original
   request succeeded, though
   decimal point.  User configuration of these values ought to be
   limited in the response might differ.

4.2.3.  Cacheable Methods

   Request methods same fashion.

8.4.2.  Accept

   The "Accept" header field can be defined as "cacheable" used by user agents to indicate specify
   response media types that
   responses to them are allowed to acceptable.  Accept header fields can
   be stored for future reuse; for
   specific requirements see [CACHING].  In general, safe methods used to indicate that
   do not depend on the request is specifically limited to a current or authoritative response are defined as
   cacheable; this specification defines GET, HEAD, and POST
   small set of desired types, as
   cacheable, although in the overwhelming majority of cache
   implementations only support GET and HEAD.

4.3.  Method Definitions

4.3.1.  GET

   The GET method requests transfer case of a current selected representation request for the target resource.  GET an in-
   line image.

     Accept = #( media-range [ accept-params ] )

     media-range    = ( "*/*"
                      / ( type "/" "*" )
                      / ( type "/" subtype )
                      ) *( OWS ";" OWS parameter )
     accept-params  = weight *( accept-ext )
     accept-ext = OWS ";" OWS token [ "=" ( token / quoted-string ) ]

   The asterisk "*" character is the primary mechanism of information
   retrieval used to group media types into ranges,
   with "*/*" indicating all media types and the focus of almost "type/*" indicating all performance optimizations.
   Hence, when people speak
   subtypes of retrieving some identifiable information
   via HTTP, they that type.  The media-range can include media type
   parameters that are generally referring to making a GET request.

   It is tempting applicable to think of resource identifiers as remote file system
   pathnames and of representations as being a copy of the contents of
   such files.  In fact, that is how many resources are implemented (see
   Section 9.1 for related security considerations).  However, there are
   no such limitations in practice.  The HTTP interface range.

   Each media-range might be followed by zero or more applicable media
   type parameters (e.g., charset), an optional "q" parameter for
   indicating a resource relative weight (Section 8.4.1), and then zero or more
   extension parameters.  The "q" parameter is just as likely to be implemented necessary if any
   extensions (accept-ext) are present, since it acts as a tree separator
   between the two parameter sets.

      Note: Use of content objects, a
   programmatic view on various database records, or a gateway to other
   information systems.  Even when the URI mapping mechanism "q" parameter name to separate media type
      parameters from Accept extension parameters is tied due to historical
      practice.  Although this prevents any media type parameter named
      "q" from being used with a file system, media range, such an origin server might be configured event is believed
      to execute be unlikely given the
   files with lack of any "q" parameters in the request as input IANA
      media type registry and send the output as the
   representation rather than transfer the files directly.  Regardless,
   only the origin server needs to know how each rare usage of its resource
   identifiers corresponds to an implementation and how each
   implementation manages to select and any media type
      parameters in Accept.  Future media types are discouraged from
      registering any parameter named "q".

   The example

     Accept: audio/*; q=0.2, audio/basic

   is interpreted as "I prefer audio/basic, but send a current representation of me any audio type
   if it is the target resource best available after an 80% markdown in a response to GET. quality".

   A client can alter request without any Accept header field implies that the semantics of GET to be a "range request",
   requesting transfer of only some part(s) of user agent
   will accept any media type in response.  If the selected
   representation, by sending a Range header field is
   present in the request
   ([RANGERQ]).

   A payload within a GET request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a GET request might cause some existing
   implementations to reject and none of the available representations for
   the request.

   The response to have a GET request media type that is cacheable; a cache MAY use it to
   satisfy subsequent GET and HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated
   by listed as acceptable, the
   origin server can either honor the Cache-Control header field (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]).

4.3.2.  HEAD

   The HEAD method is identical to GET except that the server MUST NOT
   send by sending a message body in the response (i.e., the 406 (Not
   Acceptable) response terminates at
   the end of or disregard the header section).  The server SHOULD send field by treating the same
   header fields in
   response to a HEAD request as if it is not subject to content negotiation.

   A more elaborate example is

     Accept: text/plain; q=0.5, text/html,
             text/x-dvi; q=0.8, text/x-c

   Verbally, this would have sent be interpreted as "text/html and text/x-c are
   the equally preferred media types, but if they do not exist, then
   send the request had been a GET, except text/x-dvi representation, and if that does not exist, send
   the payload header fields
   (Section 3.3) MAY be omitted.  This method text/plain representation".

   Media ranges can be used for obtaining
   metadata about the selected representation without transferring the
   representation data and is often used for testing hypertext links for
   validity, accessibility, and recent modification.

   A payload within overridden by more specific media ranges or
   specific media types.  If more than one media range applies to a HEAD request message
   given type, the most specific reference has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on precedence.  For example,

     Accept: text/*, text/plain, text/plain;format=flowed, */*

   have the following precedence:

   1.  text/plain;format=flowed

   2.  text/plain

   3.  text/*

   4.  */*

   The media type quality factor associated with a HEAD request might given type is
   determined by finding the media range with the highest precedence
   that matches the type.  For example,

     Accept: text/*;q=0.3, text/html;q=0.7, text/html;level=1,
             text/html;level=2;q=0.4, */*;q=0.5

   would cause some existing
   implementations to reject the request.

   The response following values to be associated:

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Media Type        | Quality Value |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | text/html;level=1 | 1             |
   | text/html         | 0.7           |
   | text/plain        | 0.3           |
   | image/jpeg        | 0.5           |
   | text/html;level=2 | 0.4           |
   | text/html;level=3 | 0.7           |
   +-------------------+---------------+

   Note: A user agent might be provided with a HEAD request default set of quality
   values for certain media ranges.  However, unless the user agent is cacheable; a cache MAY use it
   closed system that cannot interact with other rendering agents, this
   default set ought to
   satisfy subsequent HEAD requests unless otherwise indicated be configurable by the
   Cache-Control user.

8.4.3.  Accept-Charset

   The "Accept-Charset" header field (Section 5.2 can be sent by a user agent to
   indicate what charsets are acceptable in textual response content.
   This field allows user agents capable of understanding more
   comprehensive or special-purpose charsets to signal that capability
   to an origin server that is capable of [CACHING]). representing information in
   those charsets.

     Accept-Charset = 1#( ( charset / "*" ) [ weight ] )

   Charset names are defined in Section 6.1.1.1.  A HEAD
   response might also have an effect on previously cached responses user agent MAY
   associate a quality value with each charset to
   GET; see indicate the user's
   relative preference for that charset, as defined in Section 4.3.5 of [CACHING].

4.3.3.  POST 8.4.1.
   An example is

     Accept-Charset: iso-8859-5, unicode-1-1;q=0.8

   The POST method requests that special value "*", if present in the target resource process Accept-Charset field,
   matches every charset that is not mentioned elsewhere in the
   representation enclosed Accept-
   Charset field.  If no "*" is present in an Accept-Charset field, then
   any charsets not explicitly mentioned in the request according field are considered
   "not acceptable" to the resource's
   own specific semantics.  For example, POST is used for the following
   functions (among others):

   o  Providing a block of data, such as client.

   A request without any Accept-Charset header field implies that the fields entered into an HTML
      form, to a data-handling process;

   o  Posting a message
   user agent will accept any charset in response.  Most general-purpose
   user agents do not send Accept-Charset, unless specifically
   configured to do so, because a bulletin board, newsgroup, mailing list,
      blog, or similar group detailed list of articles;

   o  Creating supported charsets
   makes it easier for a new resource that has yet server to be identified identify an individual by virtue of
   the
      origin server; and

   o  Appending data to a resource's existing representation(s).

   An origin server indicates response semantics by choosing user agent's request characteristics (Section 12.11).

   If an
   appropriate status code depending on the result Accept-Charset header field is present in a request and none of processing
   the
   POST request; almost all of available representations for the status codes defined by this
   specification might be received in a response to POST (the exceptions
   being 206 (Partial Content), 304 (Not Modified), and 416 (Range Not
   Satisfiable)).

   If one or more resources has been created on the origin server as a
   result of successfully processing a POST request, charset that is
   listed as acceptable, the origin server
   SHOULD send a 201 (Created) response containing can either honor the header
   field, by sending a Location 406 (Not Acceptable) response, or disregard the
   header field that provides an identifier for by treating the primary resource created
   (Section 7.1.2) and a representation that describes the status of the
   request while referring to the new resource(s).

   Responses to POST requests are only cacheable when they include
   explicit freshness information (see Section 4.2.1 of [CACHING]).
   However, POST caching as if it is not widely implemented.  For cases where an
   origin server wishes the client subject to
   content negotiation.

8.4.4.  Accept-Encoding

   The "Accept-Encoding" header field can be able used by user agents to cache
   indicate what response content-codings (Section 6.1.2) are acceptable
   in the result of response.  An "identity" token is used as a
   POST synonym for "no
   encoding" in a way that can order to communicate when no encoding is preferred.

     Accept-Encoding  = #( codings [ weight ] )
     codings          = content-coding / "identity" / "*"

   Each codings value MAY be reused by a later GET, given an associated quality value
   representing the origin server
   MAY send a 200 (OK) response containing preference for that encoding, as defined in
   Section 8.4.1.  The asterisk "*" symbol in an Accept-Encoding field
   matches any available content-coding not explicitly listed in the result and a Content-
   Location
   header field.

   For example,

     Accept-Encoding: compress, gzip
     Accept-Encoding:
     Accept-Encoding: *
     Accept-Encoding: compress;q=0.5, gzip;q=1.0
     Accept-Encoding: gzip;q=1.0, identity; q=0.5, *;q=0

   A request without an Accept-Encoding header field implies that has the same value as the POST's effective
   request URI (Section 3.1.4.2).

   If
   user agent has no preferences regarding content-codings.  Although
   this allows the result of processing a POST would be equivalent server to use any content-coding in a
   representation of an existing resource, an origin server MAY redirect response, it
   does not imply that the user agent will be able to that resource by sending correctly process
   all encodings.

   A server tests whether a 303 (See Other) response
   with the existing resource's identifier content-coding for a given representation is
   acceptable using these rules:

   1.  If no Accept-Encoding field is in the Location field.  This
   has the benefits of providing request, any content-coding
       is considered acceptable by the user agent a resource identifier
   and transferring agent.

   2.  If the representation via has no content-coding, then it is
       acceptable by default unless specifically excluded by the Accept-
       Encoding field stating either "identity;q=0" or "*;q=0" without a method
       more amenable to
   shared caching, though at specific entry for "identity".

   3.  If the cost representation's content-coding is one of an extra request if the user
   agent does not already have the representation cached.

4.3.4.  PUT

   The PUT method requests that content-
       codings listed in the state Accept-Encoding field, then it is
       acceptable unless it is accompanied by a qvalue of the target resource be
   created or replaced with the state 0.  (As
       defined by the representation
   enclosed in the request message payload.  A successful PUT Section 8.4.1, a qvalue of 0 means "not acceptable".)

   4.  If multiple content-codings are acceptable, then the acceptable
       content-coding with the highest non-zero qvalue is preferred.

   An Accept-Encoding header field with a given
   representation would suggest combined field-value that a subsequent GET on is
   empty implies that same
   target resource will result the user agent does not want any content-coding in
   response.  If an equivalent representation being
   sent Accept-Encoding header field is present in a 200 (OK) response.  However, there is no guarantee that
   such request
   and none of the available representations for the response have a state change will be observable, since
   content-coding that is listed as acceptable, the target resource origin server SHOULD
   send a response without any content-coding.

      Note: Most HTTP/1.0 applications do not recognize or obey qvalues
      associated with content-codings.  This means that qvalues might
      not work and are not permitted with x-gzip or x-compress.

8.4.5.  Accept-Language

   The "Accept-Language" header field can be acted upon used by other user agents in parallel, or might be
   subject to dynamic processing by
   indicate the origin server, before any
   subsequent GET is received.  A successful response only implies set of natural languages that are preferred in the user agent's intent was achieved at the time
   response.  Language tags are defined in Section 6.1.3.

     Accept-Language = 1#( language-range [ weight ] )
     language-range  =
               <language-range, see [RFC4647], Section 2.1>

   Each language-range can be given an associated quality value
   representing an estimate of its processing by the origin server.

   If user's preference for the target resource does not have a current representation languages
   specified by that range, as defined in Section 8.4.1.  For example,

     Accept-Language: da, en-gb;q=0.8, en;q=0.7

   would mean: "I prefer Danish, but will accept British English and the
   PUT successfully creates one, then the origin server MUST inform
   other types of English".

   A request without any Accept-Language header field implies that the
   user agent by sending a 201 (Created) will accept any language in response.  If the target
   resource does have a current representation and that representation header field
   is successfully modified present in accordance with the state a request and none of the enclosed
   representation, then available representations for
   the response have a matching language tag, the origin server MUST send can
   either a 200 (OK) or
   a 204 (No Content) disregard the header field by treating the response as if it
   is not subject to indicate successful completion of content negotiation or honor the
   request.

   An origin server SHOULD ignore unrecognized header fields received in field by
   sending a PUT request (i.e., do not save them as part of the resource state).

   An origin server SHOULD verify that 406 (Not Acceptable) response.  However, the PUT representation latter is
   consistent with any constraints the server has for the target
   resource that cannot or will not
   encouraged, as doing so can prevent users from accessing content that
   they might be changed by the PUT.  This is
   particularly important when the origin server uses internal
   configuration information related to the URI in order able to set the
   values use (with translation software, for representation metadata on GET responses.  When a PUT
   representation is inconsistent with the target resource, the origin
   server SHOULD either make them consistent, by transforming the
   representation or changing example).

   Note that some recipients treat the resource configuration, or respond
   with order in which language tags are
   listed as an appropriate error message containing sufficient information
   to explain why the representation is unsuitable.  The 409 (Conflict)
   or 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status codes indication of descending priority, particularly for tags
   that are suggested, with assigned equal quality values (no value is the
   latter being specific to constraints on Content-Type values. same as q=1).
   However, this behavior cannot be relied upon.  For example, if the target resource is configured consistency and to always have
   maximize interoperability, many user agents assign each language tag
   a
   Content-Type unique quality value while also listing them in order of "text/html" and the representation being PUT has a
   Content-Type decreasing
   quality.  Additional discussion of "image/jpeg", language priority lists can be
   found in Section 2.3 of [RFC4647].

   For matching, Section 3 of [RFC4647] defines several matching
   schemes.  Implementations can offer the origin server ought most appropriate matching
   scheme for their requirements.  The "Basic Filtering" scheme
   ([RFC4647], Section 3.3.1) is identical to do one of:

   a.  reconfigure the target resource matching scheme that
   was previously defined for HTTP in Section 14.4 of [RFC2616].

   It might be contrary to reflect the new media type;

   b.  transform privacy expectations of the PUT representation user to a format consistent send
   an Accept-Language header field with that the complete linguistic
   preferences of the resource before saving it as user in every request (Section 12.11).

   Since intelligibility is highly dependent on the new resource state; or,

   c.  reject individual user,
   user agents need to allow user control over the request with linguistic preference
   (either through configuration of the user agent itself or by
   defaulting to a 415 (Unsupported Media Type) response
       indicating user controllable system setting).  A user agent that
   does not provide such control to the target resource is limited user MUST NOT send an Accept-
   Language header field.

      Note: User agents ought to "text/html",
       perhaps including a link provide guidance to users when setting
      a different resource preference, since users are rarely familiar with the details of
      language matching as described above.  For example, users might
      assume that would on selecting "en-gb", they will be served any kind of
      English document if British English is not available.  A user
      agent might suggest, in such a
       suitable target for case, to add "en" to the new representation. list for
      better matching behavior.

8.5.  Authentication Credentials

   HTTP does not define exactly how provides a PUT method affects the state of general framework for access control and
   authentication, via an
   origin server beyond what extensible set of challenge-response
   authentication schemes, which can be expressed used by the intent of the user
   agent a server to challenge a
   client request and the semantics of the origin server response.  It
   does not define what by a resource might be, in any sense of client to provide authentication information.

   Two header fields are used for carrying authentication credentials.
   Note that word,
   beyond various custom mechanisms for user authentication use the interface provided via HTTP.  It does not define how
   resource state is "stored", nor how such storage might change
   Cookie header field for this purpose, as defined in [RFC6265].

   +---------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name   | Defined in... |
   +---------------------+---------------+
   | Authorization       | Section 8.5.3 |
   | Proxy-Authorization | Section 8.5.4 |
   +---------------------+---------------+

8.5.1.  Challenge and Response

   HTTP provides a
   result of simple challenge-response authentication framework
   that can be used by a change in resource state, nor how the origin server
   translates resource state into representations.  Generally speaking,
   all implementation details behind the resource interface are
   intentionally hidden to challenge a client request and by the server.

   An origin server MUST NOT send a validator header field
   (Section 7.2), such
   client to provide authentication information.  It uses a case-
   insensitive token as an ETag or Last-Modified field, in a
   successful response to PUT unless the request's representation data
   was saved without any transformation applied means to identify the body (i.e., authentication scheme,
   followed by additional information necessary for achieving
   authentication via that scheme.  The latter can be either a comma-
   separated list of parameters or a single sequence of characters
   capable of holding base64-encoded information.

   Authentication parameters are name=value pairs, where the
   resource's new representation data name token
   is identical to the representation
   data received in the PUT request) matched case-insensitively, and the validator field value
   reflects the new representation.  This requirement each parameter name MUST only
   occur once per challenge.

     auth-scheme    = token

     auth-param     = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )

     token68        = 1*( ALPHA / DIGIT /
                          "-" / "." / "_" / "~" / "+" / "/" ) *"="

   The token68 syntax allows a user
   agent to know when the representation body 66 unreserved URI characters
   ([RFC3986]), plus a few others, so that it has in memory remains
   current as can hold a result of the PUT, thus not in need of being retrieved
   again from the origin server, base64,
   base64url (URL and that the new validator(s) received
   in the filename safe alphabet), base32, or base16 (hex)
   encoding, with or without padding, but excluding whitespace
   ([RFC4648]).

   A 401 (Unauthorized) response can be message is used for future conditional requests in order by an origin server to prevent accidental overwrites (Section 5.2).

   The fundamental difference between
   challenge the POST and PUT methods authorization of a user agent, including a WWW-
   Authenticate header field containing at least one challenge
   applicable to the requested resource.

   A 407 (Proxy Authentication Required) response message is
   highlighted used by the different intent for the enclosed representation.
   The target resource in a POST request is intended
   proxy to handle challenge the
   enclosed representation according authorization of a client, including a Proxy-
   Authenticate header field containing at least one challenge
   applicable to the resource's own semantics,
   whereas proxy for the enclosed representation in requested resource.

     challenge   = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / #auth-param ) ]

      Note: Many clients fail to parse a PUT request challenge that contains an
      unknown scheme.  A workaround for this problem is defined to list well-
      supported schemes (such as
   replacing the state of the target resource.  Hence, the intent of PUT
   is idempotent and visible "basic") first.

   A user agent that wishes to intermediaries, even though the exact
   effect is only known by the authenticate itself with an origin server.

   Proper interpretation of server
   -- usually, but not necessarily, after receiving a PUT request presumes that 401 (Unauthorized)
   -- can do so by including an Authorization header field with the user agent
   knows which target resource is desired.
   request.

   A service client that selects wishes to authenticate itself with a
   proper URI on behalf of the client, proxy -- usually,
   but not necessarily, after receiving a state-changing
   request, SHOULD be implemented using 407 (Proxy Authentication
   Required) -- can do so by including a Proxy-Authorization header
   field with the POST method rather than PUT.
   If request.

   Both the origin server will not make Authorization field value and the requested PUT state change to Proxy-Authorization field
   value contain the target resource and instead wishes to have it applied to a
   different resource, such as when client's credentials for the realm of the resource has been moved to
   being requested, based upon a
   different URI, then challenge received in a response
   (possibly at some point in the origin server MUST send an appropriate 3xx
   (Redirection) response; past).  When creating their values,
   the user agent MAY then make its own decision
   regarding whether or not ought to redirect do so by selecting the request.

   A PUT request applied challenge with what it
   considers to be the target resource can have side effects on
   other resources.  For example, an article might have a URI for
   identifying "the current version" (a resource) most secure auth-scheme that is separate it understands,
   obtaining credentials from the URIs identifying each particular version (different resources
   that at one point shared the same state user as appropriate.  Transmission of
   credentials within header field values implies significant security
   considerations regarding the current version
   resource).  A successful PUT confidentiality of the underlying
   connection, as described in Section 12.14.1.

     credentials = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / #auth-param ) ]

   Upon receipt of a request on "the current version" URI
   might therefore create for a new version protected resource in addition to changing
   the state of the target resource, and might also cause links to be
   added between that omits
   credentials, contains invalid credentials (e.g., a bad password) or
   partial credentials (e.g., when the related resources.

   An authentication scheme requires
   more than one round trip), an origin server that allows PUT on a given target resource MUST SHOULD send a 400 (Bad Request) 401
   (Unauthorized) response to a PUT request that contains a
   Content-Range WWW-Authenticate header field (Section 4.2 of [RANGERQ]), since the
   payload is likely to be partial content that has been mistakenly PUT
   as a full representation.  Partial content updates are possible by
   targeting a separately identified resource
   with state that overlaps a
   portion of the larger resource, or by using a different method that
   has been specifically defined for partial updates (for example, the
   PATCH method defined in [RFC5789]).

   Responses at least one (possibly new) challenge applicable to the PUT method are not cacheable.  If
   requested resource.

   Likewise, upon receipt of a successful PUT request passes through a cache that has one omits proxy credentials or more stored responses
   for the effective request URI, those stored responses will be
   invalidated (see Section 4.4 of [CACHING]).

4.3.5.  DELETE

   The DELETE method requests
   contains invalid or partial proxy credentials, a proxy that requires
   authentication SHOULD generate a 407 (Proxy Authentication Required)
   response that contains a Proxy-Authenticate header field with at
   least one (possibly new) challenge applicable to the origin proxy.

   A server remove that receives valid credentials that are not adequate to
   gain access ought to respond with the
   association between 403 (Forbidden) status code
   (Section 9.5.4).

   HTTP does not restrict applications to this simple challenge-response
   framework for access authentication.  Additional mechanisms can be
   used, such as authentication at the target resource transport level or via message
   encapsulation, and its current
   functionality.  In effect, with additional header fields specifying
   authentication information.  However, such additional mechanisms are
   not defined by this method specification.

8.5.2.  Protection Space (Realm)

   The "realm" authentication parameter is similar reserved for use by
   authentication schemes that wish to the rm command
   in UNIX: it expresses indicate a deletion operation on the URI mapping scope of the
   origin server rather than an expectation that the previously
   associated information be deleted.

   If the target resource has one or more current representations, they
   might or might not be destroyed protection.

   A protection space is defined by the origin server, canonical root URI (the scheme
   and the
   associated storage might or might not be reclaimed, depending
   entirely on the nature authority components of the resource and its implementation by effective request URI; see
   Section 5.3) of the
   origin server (which are beyond being accessed, in combination with the scope of this specification).
   Likewise, other implementation aspects of
   realm value if present.  These realms allow the protected resources
   on a resource might need server to be
   deactivated or archived as partitioned into a result set of a DELETE, such as database or
   gateway connections.  In general, it protection spaces, each
   with its own authentication scheme and/or authorization database.
   The realm value is assumed that a string, generally assigned by the origin
   server will only allow DELETE on resources for server,
   that can have additional semantics specific to the authentication
   scheme.  Note that a response can have multiple challenges with the
   same auth-scheme but with different realms.

   The protection space determines the domain over which it has credentials can
   be automatically applied.  If a
   prescribed mechanism for accomplishing prior request has been authorized,
   the deletion.

   Relatively few resources allow user agent MAY reuse the DELETE method -- its primary use
   is same credentials for remote authoring environments, where all other requests
   within that protection space for a period of time determined by the
   authentication scheme, parameters, and/or user has some
   direction regarding its effect.  For example, a resource that was
   previously created using preferences (such as a PUT request, or identified via
   configurable inactivity timeout).  Unless specifically allowed by the
   Location header field after
   authentication scheme, a 201 (Created) response to single protection space cannot extend
   outside the scope of its server.

   For historical reasons, a POST
   request, sender MUST only generate the quoted-string
   syntax.  Recipients might allow a corresponding DELETE request have to undo those
   actions.  Similarly, custom user agent implementations that implement
   an authoring function, such as revision control clients using HTTP support both token and quoted-
   string syntax for remote operations, might use DELETE based on an assumption maximum interoperability with existing clients that
   the server's URI space has
   have been crafted to correspond to accepting both notations for a version
   repository.

   If long time.

8.5.3.  Authorization

   The "Authorization" header field allows a DELETE method is successfully applied, the user agent to authenticate
   itself with an origin server SHOULD
   send a 202 (Accepted) status code if the action will likely succeed -- usually, but has not yet been enacted, necessarily, after
   receiving a 204 (No Content) status code if 401 (Unauthorized) response.  Its value consists of
   credentials containing the
   action has been enacted and no further authentication information is to be supplied,
   or a 200 (OK) status code if of the action has been enacted and user
   agent for the
   response message includes a representation describing realm of the status.

   A payload within resource being requested.

     Authorization = credentials

   If a DELETE request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on is authenticated and a DELETE request might cause some existing
   implementations to reject realm specified, the request.

   Responses same
   credentials are presumed to be valid for all other requests within
   this realm (assuming that the DELETE method are authentication scheme itself does not cacheable.  If a DELETE
   request passes through a cache
   require otherwise, such as credentials that has one vary according to a
   challenge value or more stored responses
   for the effective using synchronized clocks).

   A proxy forwarding a request URI, those stored responses will be
   invalidated (see MUST NOT modify any Authorization fields
   in that request.  See Section 4.4 3.2 of [CACHING]).

4.3.6.  CONNECT

   The CONNECT method requests that the recipient establish a tunnel [Caching] for details of and
   requirements pertaining to handling of the destination origin server identified Authorization field by
   HTTP caches.

8.5.4.  Proxy-Authorization

   The "Proxy-Authorization" header field allows the request-target and,
   if successful, thereafter restrict client to identify
   itself (or its behavior user) to blind forwarding a proxy that requires authentication.  Its
   value consists of packets, in both directions, until credentials containing the tunnel is closed.  Tunnels
   are commonly used authentication
   information of the client for the proxy and/or realm of the resource
   being requested.

     Proxy-Authorization = credentials

   Unlike Authorization, the Proxy-Authorization header field applies
   only to create an end-to-end virtual connection, through
   one or more proxies, which can then be secured the next inbound proxy that demanded authentication using TLS (Transport
   Layer Security, [RFC5246]).

   CONNECT is intended only for use the
   Proxy-Authenticate field.  When multiple proxies are used in requests to a proxy.  An origin
   server chain,
   the Proxy-Authorization header field is consumed by the first inbound
   proxy that receives a CONNECT request for itself MAY respond with a
   2xx (Successful) status code was expecting to indicate that a connection is
   established.  However, most origin servers do not implement CONNECT. receive credentials.  A proxy MAY relay
   the credentials from the client sending a CONNECT request MUST send to the authority form of
   request-target (Section 5.3 of [MESSGNG]); i.e., next proxy if that is
   the request-target
   consists of only mechanism by which the host name proxies cooperatively authenticate a given
   request.

8.5.5.  Authentication Scheme Extensibility

   Aside from the general framework, this document does not specify any
   authentication schemes.  New and port number of existing authentication schemes are
   specified independently and ought to be registered within the tunnel
   destination, separated by a colon.
   "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Authentication Scheme Registry".
   For example,

     CONNECT server.example.com:80 HTTP/1.1
     Host: server.example.com:80

   The recipient proxy can establish a tunnel either the "basic" and "digest" authentication schemes are
   defined by directly
   connecting RFC 7617 and RFC 7616, respectively.

8.5.5.1.  Authentication Scheme Registry

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Authentication Scheme
   Registry" defines the namespace for the authentication schemes in
   challenges and credentials.  It is maintained at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-authschemes>.

   Registrations MUST include the following fields:

   o  Authentication Scheme Name

   o  Pointer to the request-target or, if configured specification text

   o  Notes (optional)

   Values to use another
   proxy, by forwarding the CONNECT request be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

8.5.5.2.  Considerations for New Authentication Schemes

   There are certain aspects of the next inbound proxy.

   Any 2xx (Successful) response indicates HTTP Authentication framework that the sender (and all
   inbound proxies) will switch
   put constraints on how new authentication schemes can work:

   o  HTTP authentication is presumed to tunnel mode immediately after be stateless: all of the
   blank line that concludes
      information necessary to authenticate a request MUST be provided
      in the successful response's header section;
   data received after that blank line is from request, rather than be dependent on the server identified by remembering
      prior requests.  Authentication based on, or bound to, the request-target.  Any response other than a successful response
   indicates that
      underlying connection is outside the tunnel has not yet been formed scope of this specification
      and inherently flawed unless steps are taken to ensure that the
      connection remains governed cannot be used by HTTP.

   A tunnel is closed when a tunnel intermediary detects that either
   side has closed its connection: any party other than the intermediary
      authenticated user (see Section 2.2).

   o  The authentication parameter "realm" is reserved for defining
      protection spaces as described in Section 8.5.2.  New schemes MUST attempt to send
   any outstanding data
      NOT use it in a way incompatible with that came from the closed side to the other
   side, close both connections, and then discard any remaining data
   left undelivered.

   Proxy definition.

   o  The "token68" notation was introduced for compatibility with
      existing authentication might schemes and can only be used once per
      challenge or credential.  Thus, new schemes ought to establish use the authority auth-
      param syntax instead, because otherwise future extensions will be
      impossible.

   o  The parsing of challenges and credentials is defined by this
      specification and cannot be modified by new authentication
      schemes.  When the auth-param syntax is used, all parameters ought
      to
   create a tunnel.  For example,

     CONNECT server.example.com:80 HTTP/1.1
     Host: server.example.com:80
     Proxy-Authorization: basic aGVsbG86d29ybGQ=

   There are significant risks in establishing a tunnel support both token and quoted-string syntax, and syntactical
      constraints ought to arbitrary
   servers, particularly when be defined on the destination field value after parsing
      (i.e., quoted-string processing).  This is necessary so that
      recipients can use a well-known or
   reserved TCP port generic parser that applies to all
      authentication schemes.

      Note: The fact that the value syntax for the "realm" parameter is
      restricted to quoted-string was a bad design choice not intended to be
      repeated for Web traffic.  For example, new parameters.

   o  Definitions of new schemes ought to define the treatment of
      unknown extension parameters.  In general, a CONNECT "must-ignore" rule is
      preferable to a request-target of "example.com:25" would suggest that "must-understand" rule, because otherwise it will
      be hard to introduce new parameters in the proxy connect presence of legacy
      recipients.  Furthermore, it's good to describe the reserved port policy for SMTP traffic; if allowed,
   that could trick
      defining new parameters (such as "update the proxy into relaying spam email.  Proxies that
   support CONNECT SHOULD restrict its use to a limited set of known
   ports or a configurable whitelist of safe request targets.

   A server MUST NOT send any Transfer-Encoding specification" or Content-Length header
   fields in a 2xx (Successful) response
      "use this registry").

   o  Authentication schemes need to CONNECT.  A client MUST
   ignore any Content-Length document whether they are usable in
      origin-server authentication (i.e., using WWW-Authenticate), and/
      or Transfer-Encoding header fields received proxy authentication (i.e., using Proxy-Authenticate).

   o  The credentials carried in a successful an Authorization header field are
      specific to the user agent and, therefore, have the same effect on
      HTTP caches as the "private" Cache-Control response to CONNECT.

   A payload directive
      (Section 5.2.2.6 of [Caching]), within a CONNECT request message has no defined semantics;
   sending a payload body on a CONNECT the scope of the request might cause some existing
   implementations in
      which they appear.

      Therefore, new authentication schemes that choose not to reject carry
      credentials in the request.

   Responses Authorization header field (e.g., using a newly
      defined header field) will need to explicitly disallow caching, by
      mandating the CONNECT method are not cacheable.

4.3.7.  OPTIONS use of either Cache-Control request directives
      (e.g., "no-store", Section 5.2.1.5 of [Caching]) or response
      directives (e.g., "private").

8.6.  Request Context

   The OPTIONS method requests following request header fields provide additional information
   about the communication
   options available for request context, including information about the target resource, at either user, user
   agent, and resource behind the origin
   server or request.

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in... |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | From              | Section 8.6.1 |
   | Referer           | Section 8.6.2 |
   | User-Agent        | Section 8.6.3 |
   +-------------------+---------------+

8.6.1.  From

   The "From" header field contains an intervening intermediary.  This method allows a client
   to determine the options and/or requirements associated with Internet email address for a
   resource, or
   human user who controls the capabilities requesting user agent.  The address ought
   to be machine-usable, as defined by "mailbox" in Section 3.4 of
   [RFC5322]:

     From    = mailbox

     mailbox = <mailbox, see [RFC5322], Section 3.4>

   An example is:

     From: webmaster@example.org

   The From header field is rarely sent by non-robotic user agents.  A
   user agent SHOULD NOT send a server, From header field without implying a
   resource action.

   An OPTIONS request with an asterisk ("*") as explicit
   configuration by the request-target
   (Section 5.3 of [MESSGNG]) applies to user, since that might conflict with the server in general rather
   than to a specific resource.  Since user's
   privacy interests or their site's security policy.

   A robotic user agent SHOULD send a server's communication options
   typically depend on valid From header field so that
   the resource, person responsible for running the "*" request is only useful robot can be contacted if
   problems occur on servers, such as a
   "ping" if the robot is sending excessive,
   unwanted, or "no-op" type of method; it does nothing beyond allowing invalid requests.

   A server SHOULD NOT use the
   client to test From header field for access control or
   authentication, since most recipients will assume that the capabilities of field
   value is public information.

8.6.2.  Referer

   The "Referer" [sic] header field allows the server.  For example, this can
   be used user agent to test specify a proxy
   URI reference for HTTP/1.1 conformance (or lack thereof).

   If the request-target resource from which the target URI was obtained
   (i.e., the "referrer", though the field name is not an asterisk, misspelled).  A user
   agent MUST NOT include the OPTIONS request applies
   to fragment and userinfo components of the options that are available
   URI reference [RFC3986], if any, when communicating with generating the Referer field
   value.

     Referer = absolute-URI / partial-URI

   The Referer header field allows servers to generate back-links to
   other resources for simple analytics, logging, optimized caching,
   etc.  It also allows obsolete or mistyped links to be found for
   maintenance.  Some servers use the Referer header field as a means of
   denying links from other sites (so-called "deep linking") or
   restricting cross-site request forgery (CSRF), but not all requests
   contain it.

   Example:

     Referer: http://www.example.org/hypertext/Overview.html

   If the target
   resource.

   A server generating URI was obtained from a successful response to OPTIONS SHOULD send any
   header fields source that might indicate optional features implemented by
   the server and applicable to the target resource (e.g., Allow),
   including potential extensions does not defined by this specification.
   The response payload, if any, might also describe have its
   own URI (e.g., input from the communication
   options in a machine user keyboard, or human-readable representation.  A standard
   format for such a representation is not defined by this
   specification, but might be defined by future extensions to HTTP.  A
   server an entry within the
   user's bookmarks/favorites), the user agent MUST generate a Content-Length either exclude the
   Referer field or send it with a value of "0" "about:blank".

   The Referer field has the potential to reveal information about the
   request context or browsing history of the user, which is a privacy
   concern if no
   payload body the referring resource's identifier reveals personal
   information (such as an account name) or a resource that is supposed
   to be sent in the response.

   A client MAY send confidential (such as behind a Max-Forwards header field in an OPTIONS request firewall or internal to target a specific recipient in
   secured service).  Most general-purpose user agents do not send the request chain (see
   Section 5.1.2).
   Referer header field when the referring resource is a local "file" or
   "data" URI.  A proxy user agent MUST NOT generate send a Max-Forwards Referer header field while forwarding a request unless that in an
   unsecured HTTP request if the referring page was received with a Max-Forwards field.

   A client that generates an OPTIONS request containing a payload body
   MUST send a valid Content-Type
   secure protocol.  See Section 12.8 for additional security
   considerations.

   Some intermediaries have been known to indiscriminately remove
   Referer header field describing fields from outgoing requests.  This has the
   representation media type.  Although this specification does not
   define any use for such a payload, future
   unfortunate side effect of interfering with protection against CSRF
   attacks, which can be far more harmful to their users.
   Intermediaries and user agent extensions that wish to HTTP might
   use the OPTIONS body limit
   information disclosure in Referer ought to make more detailed queries restrict their changes to
   specific edits, such as replacing internal domain names with
   pseudonyms or truncating the query and/or path components.  An
   intermediary SHOULD NOT modify or delete the Referer header field
   when the field value shares the same scheme and host as the request
   target.

8.6.3.  User-Agent

   The "User-Agent" header field contains information about the target
   resource.

   Responses user
   agent originating the request, which is often used by servers to help
   identify the OPTIONS method are not cacheable.

4.3.8.  TRACE

   The TRACE method requests a remote, application-level loop-back scope of
   the reported interoperability problems, to work
   around or tailor responses to avoid particular user agent
   limitations, and for analytics regarding browser or operating system
   use.  A user agent SHOULD send a User-Agent field in each request message.
   unless specifically configured not to do so.

     User-Agent = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

   The final recipient User-Agent field-value consists of one or more product
   identifiers, each followed by zero or more comments (Section 5 of
   [Messaging]), which together identify the request SHOULD
   reflect the message received, excluding some fields described below,
   back to user agent software and its
   significant subproducts.  By convention, the client as product identifiers are
   listed in decreasing order of their significance for identifying the message body
   user agent software.  Each product identifier consists of a 200 (OK) response with a
   Content-Type of "message/http" (Section 8.3.1 of [MESSGNG]).  The
   final recipient name and
   optional version.

     product         = token ["/" product-version]
     product-version = token

   A sender SHOULD limit generated product identifiers to what is either
   necessary to identify the origin server product; a sender MUST NOT generate
   advertising or other nonessential information within the first server to
   receive product
   identifier.  A sender SHOULD NOT generate information in product-
   version that is not a Max-Forwards value version identifier (i.e., successive versions
   of zero (0) the same product name ought to differ only in the request
   (Section 5.1.2). product-version
   portion of the product identifier).

   Example:

     User-Agent: CERN-LineMode/2.15 libwww/2.17b3

   A client MUST user agent SHOULD NOT generate header fields in a TRACE request User-Agent field containing sensitive data that might be disclosed
   needlessly fine-grained detail and SHOULD limit the addition of
   subproducts by third parties.  Overly long and detailed User-Agent
   field values increase request latency and the response.
   For example, it would be foolish for risk of a user agent being
   identified against their wishes ("fingerprinting").

   Likewise, implementations are encouraged not to send stored user
   credentials [AUTHFRM] or cookies [RFC6265] use the product
   tokens of other implementations in a TRACE request.  The
   final recipient order to declare compatibility
   with them, as this circumvents the purpose of the request SHOULD exclude any request header
   fields that are likely to contain sensitive data when field.  If a user
   agent masquerades as a different user agent, recipients can assume
   that recipient
   generates the response body.

   TRACE allows the client user intentionally desires to see what is responses tailored for
   that identified user agent, even if they might not work as well for
   the actual user agent being received at used.

9.  Response Status Codes

   The status-code element is a three-digit integer code giving the other
   end
   result of the request chain attempt to understand and use that data for testing or diagnostic
   information.  The value of satisfy the Via header field (Section 5.7.1 request.

   HTTP status codes are extensible.  HTTP clients are not required to
   understand the meaning of
   [MESSGNG]) all registered status codes, though such
   understanding is of particular interest, since it acts as obviously desirable.  However, a trace of client MUST
   understand the
   request chain.  Use class of any status code, as indicated by the Max-Forwards header field allows the
   client first
   digit, and treat an unrecognized status code as being equivalent to limit
   the length x00 status code of that class, with the request chain, which is useful for
   testing exception that a chain of proxies forwarding messages in an infinite loop.

   A client
   recipient MUST NOT send cache a message body in response with an unrecognized status code.

   For example, if an unrecognized status code of 471 is received by a TRACE request.

   Responses to
   client, the TRACE method are not cacheable.

5.  Request Header Fields

   A client sends can assume that there was something wrong with its
   request header fields to provide more information
   about and treat the response as if it had received a 400 (Bad
   Request) status code.  The response message will usually contain a
   representation that explains the status.

   The first digit of the status-code defines the class of response.
   The last two digits do not have any categorization role.  There are
   five values for the first digit:

   o  1xx (Informational): The request context, make the was received, continuing process

   o  2xx (Successful): The request conditional based on the
   target resource state, suggest preferred formats for the response,
   supply authentication credentials, or modify was successfully received,
      understood, and accepted

   o  3xx (Redirection): Further action needs to be taken in order to
      complete the expected request
   processing.  These fields act as

   o  4xx (Client Error): The request modifiers, similar contains bad syntax or cannot be
      fulfilled

   o  5xx (Server Error): The server failed to fulfill an apparently
      valid request

9.1.  Overview of Status Codes

   The status codes listed below are defined in this specification.  The
   reason phrases listed here are only recommendations -- they can be
   replaced by local equivalents without affecting the
   parameters on protocol.

   Responses with status codes that are defined as cacheable by default
   (e.g., 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301, 404, 405, 410, 414, and 501 in
   this specification) can be reused by a programming language cache with heuristic
   expiration unless otherwise indicated by the method invocation.

5.1.  Controls

   Controls definition or
   explicit cache controls [Caching]; all other status codes are request header fields that direct specific handling of
   the request.

   +-------------------+--------------------------+ not
   cacheable by default.

   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+
   | Header Field Name Value | Defined in... Description                   |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+ Reference       | Cache-Control
   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+
   | 100   | Continue                      | Section 5.2 of [CACHING] 9.2.1   |
   | Expect 101   | Switching Protocols           | Section 5.1.1 9.2.2   |
   | Host 200   | OK                            | Section 5.4 of [MESSGNG] 9.3.1   |
   | Max-Forwards 201   | Created                       | Section 9.3.2   |
   | 202   | Accepted                      | Section 9.3.3   |
   | 203   | Non-Authoritative Information | Section 9.3.4   |
   | 204   | No Content                    | Section 9.3.5   |
   | 205   | Reset Content                 | Section 9.3.6   |
   | 206   | Partial Content               | Section 9.3.7   |
   | 300   | Multiple Choices              | Section 9.4.1   |
   | 301   | Moved Permanently             | Section 9.4.2   |
   | 302   | Found                         | Section 9.4.3   |
   | 303   | See Other                     | Section 9.4.4   |
   | 304   | Not Modified                  | Section 9.4.5   |
   | 305   | Use Proxy                     | Section 9.4.6   |
   | 306   | (Unused)                      | Section 9.4.7   |
   | 307   | Temporary Redirect            | Section 9.4.8   |
   | 400   | Bad Request                   | Section 9.5.1   |
   | 401   | Unauthorized                  | Section 9.5.2   |
   | 402   | Payment Required              | Section 9.5.3   |
   | 403   | Forbidden                     | Section 9.5.4   |
   | 404   | Not Found                     | Section 9.5.5   |
   | 405   | Method Not Allowed            | Section 9.5.6   |
   | 406   | Not Acceptable                | Section 9.5.7   |
   | 407   | Proxy Authentication Required | Section 9.5.8   |
   | 408   | Request Timeout               | Section 9.5.9   |
   | 409   | Conflict                      | Section 9.5.10  |
   | 410   | Gone                          | Section 9.5.11  |
   | 411   | Length Required               | Section 9.5.12  |
   | 412   | Precondition Failed           | Section 9.5.13  |
   | 413   | Payload Too Large             | Section 9.5.14  |
   | 414   | URI Too Long                  | Section 9.5.15  |
   | 415   | Unsupported Media Type        | Section 9.5.16  |
   | 416   | Range Not Satisfiable         | Section 9.5.17  |
   | 417   | Expectation Failed            | Section 9.5.18  |
   | 426   | Upgrade Required              | Section 9.5.19  |
   | 500   | Internal Server Error         | Section 9.6.1   |
   | 501   | Not Implemented               | Section 9.6.2   |
   | 502   | Bad Gateway                   | Section 5.1.2 9.6.3   |
   | Pragma 503   | Service Unavailable           | Section 5.4 of [CACHING] 9.6.4   |
   | Range 504   | Gateway Timeout               | Section 3.1 of [RANGERQ] 9.6.5   |
   | TE 505   | HTTP Version Not Supported    | Section 4.3 of [MESSGNG] 9.6.6   |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+

5.1.1.  Expect

   The "Expect" header field in a request indicates a certain set of
   behaviors (expectations) that need to be supported by the server in
   order to properly handle this request.  The only such expectation
   defined by this specification is 100-continue.

     Expect  = "100-continue"

   The Expect field-value is case-insensitive.

   A server that receives an Expect field-value other than 100-continue
   MAY respond with a 417 (Expectation Failed) status code to indicate
   that the unexpected expectation cannot be met.

   A 100-continue expectation informs recipients that the client is
   about to send a (presumably large) message body in this request and
   wishes to receive a 100 (Continue) interim response if the request-
   line and header fields are not sufficient to cause an immediate
   success, redirect, or error response.  This allows the client to wait
   for an indication that it is worthwhile to send the message body
   before actually doing so, which can improve efficiency when the
   message body is huge or when the client anticipates that an error is
   likely (e.g., when sending a state-changing method, for the first
   time, without previously verified authentication credentials).

   For example, a request that begins with

     PUT /somewhere/fun HTTP/1.1
     Host: origin.example.com
     Content-Type: video/h264
     Content-Length: 1234567890987
     Expect: 100-continue

   allows the origin server to immediately respond with an error
   message, such as 401 (Unauthorized) or 405 (Method Not Allowed),
   before the client starts filling the pipes with an unnecessary data
   transfer.

   Requirements for clients:

   o  A client MUST NOT generate a 100-continue expectation in a request
      that does not include a message body.

   o  A client that will wait for a 100 (Continue) response before
      sending the request message body MUST send an Expect header field
      containing a 100-continue expectation.

   o  A client that sends a 100-continue expectation is not required to
      wait for any specific length of time; such a client MAY proceed to
      send the message body even if it has not yet received a response.
      Furthermore, since 100 (Continue) responses cannot be sent through
      an HTTP/1.0 intermediary, such a client SHOULD NOT wait for an
      indefinite period before sending the message body.

   o  A client that receives a 417 (Expectation Failed) status code in
      response to a request containing a 100-continue expectation SHOULD
      repeat that request without a 100-continue expectation, since the
      417 response merely indicates that the response chain does not
      support expectations (e.g., it passes through an HTTP/1.0 server).

   Requirements for servers:

   o  A server that receives a 100-continue expectation in an HTTP/1.0
      request MUST ignore that expectation.

   o  A server MAY omit sending a 100 (Continue) response if it has
      already received some or all of the message body for the
      corresponding request, or if the framing indicates that there is
      no message body.

   o  A server that sends a 100 (Continue) response MUST ultimately send
      a final status code, once the message body is received and
      processed, unless the connection is closed prematurely.

   o  A server that responds with a final
   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+
   Note that this list is not exhaustive -- it does not include
   extension status code before reading the
      entire message body SHOULD indicate codes defined in that other specifications (Section 9.7).

9.2.  Informational 1xx

   The 1xx (Informational) class of status code indicates an interim
   response whether it
      intends to close the for communicating connection status or continue reading and discarding
      the request message (see Section 6.6 of [MESSGNG]).

   An origin server MUST, upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request-
   line and a complete header section that contains a 100-continue
   expectation progress
   prior to completing the requested action and indicates a request message body will follow, either
   send an immediate response with sending a final status code, if that status
   can be determined
   response.  1xx responses are terminated by examining just the request-line and header
   fields, or send an immediate 100 (Continue) response to encourage the
   client to send first empty line after
   the request's message body.  The origin server MUST
   NOT wait for status-line (the empty line signaling the message body before sending end of the 100 (Continue)
   response.

   A proxy MUST, upon receiving an HTTP/1.1 (or later) request-line and
   a complete header section that contains a 100-continue expectation
   and indicates
   section).  Since HTTP/1.0 did not define any 1xx status codes, a request message body will follow, either
   server MUST NOT send an
   immediate response with a final status code, if that status can 1xx response to an HTTP/1.0 client.

   A client MUST be
   determined by examining just the request-line and header fields, able to parse one or
   begin forwarding the request toward the origin server by sending a
   corresponding request-line and header section more 1xx responses received
   prior to a final response, even if the next inbound
   server.  If client does not expect one.  A
   user agent MAY ignore unexpected 1xx responses.

   A proxy MUST forward 1xx responses unless the proxy believes (from configuration or past
   interaction) that itself requested
   the next inbound server only supports HTTP/1.0, generation of the 1xx response.  For example, if a proxy MAY generate adds an immediate
   "Expect: 100-continue" field when it forwards a request, then it need
   not forward the corresponding 100 (Continue) response to encourage
   the client to begin sending the message body.

      Note: response(s).

9.2.1.  100 Continue

   The Expect header field was added after the original
      publication of HTTP/1.1 [RFC2068] as both the means to request an
      interim 100 (Continue) response and the general mechanism for
      indicating must-understand extensions.  However, status code indicates that the extension
      mechanism initial part of a
   request has not been used by clients received and the must-understand
      requirements have has not yet been implemented rejected by many servers, rendering the extension mechanism useless.  This specification has removed
      the extension mechanism in order to simplify the definition and
      processing of 100-continue.

5.1.2.  Max-Forwards
   server.  The "Max-Forwards" header field provides a mechanism with the TRACE
   (Section 4.3.8) and OPTIONS (Section 4.3.7) request methods to limit
   the number of times that the request is forwarded by proxies.  This
   can be useful when the client is attempting to trace a request that
   appears server intends to be failing or looping mid-chain.

     Max-Forwards = 1*DIGIT

   The Max-Forwards value is send a decimal integer indicating final response after the remaining
   number of times this
   request message can be forwarded.

   Each intermediary that receives a TRACE or OPTIONS has been fully received and acted upon.

   When the request containing
   a Max-Forwards contains an Expect header field MUST check and update its value prior to
   forwarding the request.  If the received value is zero (0), that includes a
   100-continue expectation, the
   intermediary MUST NOT forward 100 response indicates that the request; instead, server
   wishes to receive the intermediary
   MUST respond request payload body, as described in
   Section 8.1.1.  The client ought to continue sending the final recipient.  If request and
   discard the received Max-Forwards
   value is greater than zero, 100 response.

   If the intermediary MUST generate request did not contain an updated
   Max-Forwards Expect header field in containing the forwarded message with a field-value
   100-continue expectation, the client can simply discard this interim
   response.

9.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols

   The 101 (Switching Protocols) status code indicates that
   is the lesser of a) server
   understands and is willing to comply with the received value decremented by one (1) or b) client's request, via
   the recipient's maximum supported value for Max-Forwards.

   A recipient MAY ignore a Max-Forwards Upgrade header field received with any
   other request methods.

5.2.  Conditionals

   The HTTP conditional request header fields [CONDTNL] allow a client
   to place (Section 9.7 of [Messaging]), for a precondition change
   in the application protocol being used on this connection.  The
   server MUST generate an Upgrade header field in the state of response that
   indicates which protocol(s) will be switched to immediately after the target resource, so
   empty line that terminates the action corresponding to 101 response.

   It is assumed that the method semantics server will not be applied
   if the precondition evaluates only agree to switch protocols
   when it is advantageous to do so.  For example, switching to false.  Each precondition defined by
   this specification consists of a comparison between a set of
   validators obtained from prior representations newer
   version of the target resource HTTP might be advantageous over older versions, and
   switching to the current state of validators for the selected representation
   (Section 7.2).  Hence, these preconditions evaluate whether the state
   of the target resource has changed since a given state known by the
   client. real-time, synchronous protocol might be advantageous
   when delivering resources that use such features.

9.3.  Successful 2xx

   The effect 2xx (Successful) class of such an evaluation depends on status code indicates that the method
   semantics client's
   request was successfully received, understood, and choice of conditional, as defined in Section 5 of
   [CONDTNL].

   +---------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name   | Defined in...            |
   +---------------------+--------------------------+
   | If-Match            | Section 3.1 of [CONDTNL] |
   | If-None-Match       | Section 3.2 of [CONDTNL] |
   | If-Modified-Since   | Section 3.3 of [CONDTNL] |
   | If-Unmodified-Since | Section 3.4 of [CONDTNL] |
   | If-Range            | Section 3.2 of [RANGERQ] |
   +---------------------+--------------------------+

5.3.  Content Negotiation accepted.

9.3.1.  200 OK

   The following request header fields are sent by a user agent to
   engage in proactive negotiation of 200 (OK) status code indicates that the response content, as defined
   in Section 3.4.1. request has succeeded.
   The preferences payload sent in these fields apply to any
   content in the response, including representations of a 200 response depends on the target
   resource, representations of error or processing status, and
   potentially even request method.
   For the miscellaneous text strings that might appear
   within methods defined by this specification, the protocol.

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in... |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Accept            | Section 5.3.2 |
   | Accept-Charset    | Section 5.3.3 |
   | Accept-Encoding   | Section 5.3.4 |
   | Accept-Language   | Section 5.3.5 |
   +-------------------+---------------+

5.3.1.  Quality Values

   Many intended meaning
   of the request header fields for proactive negotiation use a
   common parameter, named "q" (case-insensitive), to assign payload can be summarized as:

   GET  a relative
   "weight" to the preference for that associated kind representation of content.  This
   weight is referred to the target resource;

   HEAD  the same representation as GET, but without the representation
      data;

   POST  a "quality value" (or "qvalue") because representation of the
   same parameter name is often used within server configurations to
   assign status of, or results obtained from,
      the action;

   PUT, DELETE  a weight to representation of the relative quality status of the various
   representations that can be selected for a resource.

   The weight is normalized to action;

   OPTIONS  a real number in representation of the range 0 through 1,
   where 0.001 is communications options;

   TRACE  a representation of the least preferred and 1 is request message as received by the most preferred; end
      server.

   Aside from responses to CONNECT, a
   value 200 response always has a payload,
   though an origin server MAY generate a payload body of 0 means "not acceptable". zero length.
   If no "q" parameter payload is present, desired, an origin server ought to send 204 (No
   Content) instead.  For CONNECT, no payload is allowed because the default weight
   successful result is 1.

     weight = OWS ";" OWS "q=" qvalue
     qvalue = ( "0" [ "." 0*3DIGIT ] )
            / ( "1" [ "." 0*3("0") ] )

   A sender of qvalue MUST NOT generate more than three digits a tunnel, which begins immediately after the
   decimal point.  User configuration 200
   response header section.

   A 200 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of these values ought to be
   limited in [Caching]).

9.3.2.  201 Created

   The 201 (Created) status code indicates that the same fashion.

5.3.2.  Accept request has been
   fulfilled and has resulted in one or more new resources being
   created.  The "Accept" primary resource created by the request is identified
   by either a Location header field can be used by user agents to specify in the response media types that are acceptable.  Accept header fields can
   be used to indicate that or, if no Location
   field is received, by the effective request is specifically limited URI.

   The 201 response payload typically describes and links to the
   resource(s) created.  See Section 10.2 for a
   small set discussion of desired types, as in the case
   meaning and purpose of validator header fields, such as ETag and
   Last-Modified, in a 201 response.

9.3.3.  202 Accepted

   The 202 (Accepted) status code indicates that the request has been
   accepted for processing, but the processing has not been completed.
   The request might or might not eventually be acted upon, as it might
   be disallowed when processing actually takes place.  There is no
   facility in HTTP for re-sending a status code from an in-
   line image.

     Accept = #( media-range [ accept-params ] )

     media-range    = ( "*/*"
                      / ( type "/" "*" )
                      / ( type "/" subtype )
                      ) *( OWS ";" OWS parameter )
     accept-params  = weight *( accept-ext )
     accept-ext = OWS ";" OWS token [ "=" ( token / quoted-string ) ] asynchronous
   operation.

   The asterisk "*" character 202 response is intentionally noncommittal.  Its purpose is to
   allow a server to accept a request for some other process (perhaps a
   batch-oriented process that is used only run once per day) without
   requiring that the user agent's connection to group media types into ranges, the server persist
   until the process is completed.  The representation sent with "*/*" indicating all media types this
   response ought to describe the request's current status and "type/*" indicating all
   subtypes of point to
   (or embed) a status monitor that type.  The media-range can include media type
   parameters provide the user with an
   estimate of when the request will be fulfilled.

9.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information

   The 203 (Non-Authoritative Information) status code indicates that are applicable
   the request was successful but the enclosed payload has been modified
   from that of the origin server's 200 (OK) response by a transforming
   proxy (Section 5.6.2).  This status code allows the proxy to notify
   recipients when a transformation has been applied, since that range.

   Each media-range
   knowledge might impact later decisions regarding the content.  For
   example, future cache validation requests for the content might only
   be followed by zero or more applicable media
   type parameters (e.g., charset), an optional "q" parameter for
   indicating a relative weight (Section 5.3.1), and then zero or more
   extension parameters. along the same request path (through the same proxies).

   The "q" parameter 203 response is necessary if any
   extensions (accept-ext) are present, since it acts as a separator
   between similar to the two parameter sets.

      Note: Use Warning code of 214 Transformation
   Applied (Section 5.5 of [Caching]), which has the "q" parameter name to separate media type
      parameters from Accept extension parameters is due to historical
      practice.  Although this prevents any media type parameter named
      "q" from advantage of being used
   applicable to responses with a media range, such an event any status code.

   A 203 response is believed
      to be unlikely given cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the lack method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of any "q" parameters in [Caching]).

9.3.5.  204 No Content

   The 204 (No Content) status code indicates that the IANA
      media type registry and server has
   successfully fulfilled the rare usage of any media type
      parameters in Accept.  Future media types are discouraged from
      registering any parameter named "q".

   The example

     Accept: audio/*; q=0.2, audio/basic request and that there is interpreted as "I prefer audio/basic, but no additional
   content to send me any audio type
   if it is the best available after an 80% markdown in quality".

   A request without any Accept header field implies that the user agent
   will accept any media type response payload body.  Metadata in response.  If the
   response header field fields refer to the target resource and its selected
   representation after the requested action was applied.

   For example, if a 204 status code is
   present received in response to a PUT
   request and none of the available representations for the response have a media type that is listed as acceptable, contains an ETag header field, then the
   origin server can either honor PUT
   was successful and the header field by sending a 406 (Not
   Acceptable) response or disregard ETag field-value contains the header field by treating entity-tag for
   the new representation of that target resource.

   The 204 response as if it is not subject to content negotiation.

   A more elaborate example is

     Accept: text/plain; q=0.5, text/html,
             text/x-dvi; q=0.8, text/x-c

   Verbally, this would be interpreted as "text/html and text/x-c are allows a server to indicate that the equally preferred media types, but if they do not exist, then
   send action has been
   successfully applied to the text/x-dvi representation, and if target resource, while implying that the
   user agent does not exist, send need to traverse away from its current "document
   view" (if any).  The server assumes that the text/plain representation".

   Media ranges can be overridden by more specific media ranges or
   specific media types.  If more than one media range applies user agent will provide
   some indication of the success to a
   given type, its user, in accord with its own
   interface, and apply any new or updated metadata in the most specific reference has precedence. response to
   its active representation.

   For example,

     Accept: text/*, text/plain, text/plain;format=flowed, */*

   have the following precedence:

   1.  text/plain;format=flowed

   2.  text/plain

   3.  text/*

   4.  */*

   The media type quality factor associated with a given type 204 status code is
   determined by finding the media range commonly used with the highest precedence document editing
   interfaces corresponding to a "save" action, such that matches the type.  For example,

     Accept: text/*;q=0.3, text/html;q=0.7, text/html;level=1,
             text/html;level=2;q=0.4, */*;q=0.5

   would cause the following values document
   being saved remains available to be associated:

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Media Type        | Quality Value |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | text/html;level=1 | 1             |
   | text/html         | 0.7           |
   | text/plain        | 0.3           |
   | image/jpeg        | 0.5           |
   | text/html;level=2 | 0.4           |
   | text/html;level=3 | 0.7           |
   +-------------------+---------------+

   Note: A user agent might be provided with a default set of quality
   values for certain media ranges.  However, unless the user agent for editing.  It is a
   closed system that cannot interact also
   frequently used with other rendering agents, this
   default set ought interfaces that expect automated data transfers
   to be configurable prevalent, such as within distributed version control systems.

   A 204 response is terminated by the user.

5.3.3.  Accept-Charset

   The "Accept-Charset" first empty line after the header field can be sent by
   fields because it cannot contain a user agent to
   indicate what charsets are acceptable in textual message body.

   A 204 response content.
   This field allows user agents capable of understanding more
   comprehensive is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or special-purpose charsets to signal explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [Caching]).

9.3.6.  205 Reset Content

   The 205 (Reset Content) status code indicates that capability
   to an origin the server has
   fulfilled the request and desires that is capable of representing information in
   those charsets.

     Accept-Charset = 1#( ( charset / "*" ) [ weight ] )

   Charset names are defined in Section 3.1.1.2.  A the user agent MAY
   associate a quality value with each charset to indicate reset the user's
   relative preference for that charset,
   "document view", which caused the request to be sent, to its original
   state as defined in Section 5.3.1.
   An example received from the origin server.

   This response is

     Accept-Charset: iso-8859-5, unicode-1-1;q=0.8

   The special value "*", if present in intended to support a common data entry use case
   where the Accept-Charset field,
   matches every charset user receives content that is not mentioned elsewhere supports data entry (a form,
   notepad, canvas, etc.), enters or manipulates data in that space,
   causes the Accept-
   Charset field.  If no "*" is present entered data to be submitted in an Accept-Charset field, a request, and then
   any charsets not explicitly mentioned in the field are considered
   "not acceptable" to
   data entry mechanism is reset for the client.

   A request without any Accept-Charset header field implies next entry so that the user agent can
   easily initiate another input action.

   Since the 205 status code implies that no additional content will accept any charset be
   provided, a server MUST NOT generate a payload in a 205 response.  Most general-purpose
   user agents do not send Accept-Charset, unless specifically
   configured to do so, because  In
   other words, a detailed list server MUST do one of supported charsets
   makes it easier the following for a server to identify an individual 205
   response: a) indicate a zero-length body for the response by virtue
   including a Content-Length header field with a value of 0; b)
   indicate a zero-length payload for the user agent's request characteristics (Section 9.7).

   If an Accept-Charset response by including a
   Transfer-Encoding header field is present in with a request value of chunked and none a message
   body consisting of a single chunk of zero-length; or, c) close the available representations for
   connection immediately after sending the response has a charset blank line terminating the
   header section.

9.3.7.  206 Partial Content

   The 206 (Partial Content) status code indicates that is
   listed as acceptable, the origin server can either honor the header
   field, by sending is
   successfully fulfilling a 406 (Not Acceptable) response, or disregard range request for the
   header field target resource by treating
   transferring one or more parts of the resource as if it is not subject selected representation that
   correspond to
   content negotiation.

5.3.4.  Accept-Encoding

   The "Accept-Encoding" the satisfiable ranges found in the request's Range
   header field can be used by user agents to
   indicate what response content-codings (Section 3.1.2.1) are
   acceptable in the response.  An "identity" token is used as 8.3).

   When a synonym
   for "no encoding" in order to communicate when no encoding 206 response is
   preferred.

     Accept-Encoding  = #( codings [ weight ] )
     codings          = content-coding / "identity" / "*"

   Each codings value MAY be given an associated quality value
   representing generated, the preference for that encoding, as defined in
   Section 5.3.1.  The asterisk "*" symbol in an Accept-Encoding field
   matches any available content-coding not explicitly listed in server MUST generate the
   following header field.

   For example,

     Accept-Encoding: compress, gzip
     Accept-Encoding:
     Accept-Encoding: *
     Accept-Encoding: compress;q=0.5, gzip;q=1.0
     Accept-Encoding: gzip;q=1.0, identity; q=0.5, *;q=0

   A request without an Accept-Encoding header field implies that fields, in addition to those required in the
   user agent has no preferences regarding content-codings.  Although
   this allows
   subsections below, if the server to use any content-coding field would have been sent in a response, it
   does not imply that the user agent will be able 200 (OK)
   response to correctly process
   all encodings.

   A server tests whether a content-coding for a given representation is
   acceptable using these rules:

   1. the same request: Date, Cache-Control, ETag, Expires,
   Content-Location, and Vary.

   If no Accept-Encoding field a 206 is generated in response to a request with an If-Range
   header field, the request, any content-coding
       is considered acceptable by the user agent.

   2.  If the sender SHOULD NOT generate other representation has no content-coding, then it is
       acceptable by default unless specifically excluded by
   header fields beyond those required, because the Accept-
       Encoding field stating either "identity;q=0" or "*;q=0" without client is understood
   to already have a
       more specific entry for "identity".

   3.  If prior response containing those header fields.
   Otherwise, the representation's content-coding is one sender MUST generate all of the content-
       codings listed representation header
   fields that would have been sent in a 200 (OK) response to the Accept-Encoding field, then it same
   request.

   A 206 response is
       acceptable cacheable by default; i.e., unless it is accompanied otherwise
   indicated by explicit cache controls (see Section 4.2.2 of
   [Caching]).

9.3.7.1.  Single Part

   If a qvalue single part is being transferred, the server generating the 206
   response MUST generate a Content-Range header field, describing what
   range of 0.  (As
       defined in Section 5.3.1, the selected representation is enclosed, and a qvalue payload
   consisting of 0 means "not acceptable".)

   4. the range.  For example:

     HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
     Date: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
     Last-Modified: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 04:58:08 GMT
     Content-Range: bytes 21010-47021/47022
     Content-Length: 26012
     Content-Type: image/gif

     ... 26012 bytes of partial image data ...

9.3.7.2.  Multiple Parts

   If multiple content-codings parts are acceptable, then being transferred, the acceptable
       content-coding with server generating the highest non-zero qvalue is preferred.

   An Accept-Encoding
   206 response MUST generate a "multipart/byteranges" payload, as
   defined in Section 6.3.4, and a Content-Type header field containing
   the multipart/byteranges media type and its required boundary
   parameter.  To avoid confusion with single-part responses, a combined field-value that is
   empty implies that the user agent does not want any content-coding in
   response.  If an Accept-Encoding server
   MUST NOT generate a Content-Range header field is present in the HTTP header
   section of a request
   and none multiple part response (this field will be sent in each
   part instead).

   Within the header area of each body part in the available representations for multipart payload,
   the response have server MUST generate a
   content-coding Content-Range header field corresponding
   to the range being enclosed in that is listed as acceptable, body part.  If the selected
   representation would have had a Content-Type header field in a 200
   (OK) response, the origin server SHOULD
   send generate that same Content-Type
   field in the header area of each body part.  For example:

     HTTP/1.1 206 Partial Content
     Date: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 06:25:24 GMT
     Last-Modified: Wed, 15 Nov 1995 04:58:08 GMT
     Content-Length: 1741
     Content-Type: multipart/byteranges; boundary=THIS_STRING_SEPARATES

     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
     Content-Type: application/pdf
     Content-Range: bytes 500-999/8000

     ...the first range...
     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES
     Content-Type: application/pdf
     Content-Range: bytes 7000-7999/8000

     ...the second range
     --THIS_STRING_SEPARATES--

   When multiple ranges are requested, a response without server MAY coalesce any content-coding.

      Note: Most HTTP/1.0 applications do not recognize of the
   ranges that overlap, or obey qvalues
      associated with content-codings.  This means that qvalues might
      not work and are not permitted with x-gzip or x-compress.

5.3.5.  Accept-Language

   The "Accept-Language" header field can be used separated by user agents to
   indicate a gap that is smaller
   than the set overhead of natural languages that are preferred sending multiple parts, regardless of the order
   in which the
   response.  Language tags are defined corresponding byte-range-spec appeared in Section 3.1.3.1.

     Accept-Language = 1#( language-range [ weight ] )
     language-range  =
               <language-range, see [RFC4647], Section 2.1>

   Each language-range the received
   Range header field.  Since the typical overhead between parts of a
   multipart/byteranges payload is around 80 bytes, depending on the
   selected representation's media type and the chosen boundary
   parameter length, it can be given an associated quality value
   representing an estimate of less efficient to transfer many small
   disjoint parts than it is to transfer the user's preference entire selected
   representation.

   A server MUST NOT generate a multipart response to a request for the languages
   specified by that a
   single range, as defined in Section 5.3.1.  For example,

     Accept-Language: da, en-gb;q=0.8, en;q=0.7

   would mean: "I prefer Danish, but will accept British English and
   other types of English".

   A since a client that does not request without any Accept-Language header field implies multiple parts
   might not support multipart responses.  However, a server MAY
   generate a multipart/byteranges payload with only a single body part
   if multiple ranges were requested and only one range was found to be
   satisfiable or only one range remained after coalescing.  A client
   that the
   user agent will accept any language in response.  If the header field
   is present in cannot process a multipart/byteranges response MUST NOT generate
   a request and none of the available representations that asks for
   the response have multiple ranges.

   When a matching language tag, multipart response payload is generated, the origin server can
   either disregard SHOULD
   send the header field by treating parts in the response as if it
   is not subject to content negotiation or honor same order that the header field by
   sending a 406 (Not Acceptable) response.  However, corresponding byte-range-
   spec appeared in the latter is not
   encouraged, as doing so can prevent users from accessing content received Range header field, excluding those
   ranges that
   they might be able to use (with translation software, for example).

   Note were deemed unsatisfiable or that some recipients treat the order in which language tags are
   listed as an indication of descending priority, particularly for tags were coalesced into
   other ranges.  A client that are assigned equal quality values (no value is receives a multipart response MUST
   inspect the same as q=1).
   However, this behavior cannot be relied upon.  For consistency and to
   maximize interoperability, many user agents assign Content-Range header field present in each language tag
   a unique quality value while also listing them body part in
   order of decreasing
   quality.  Additional discussion of language priority lists can be
   found to determine which range is contained in Section 2.3 of [RFC4647].

   For matching, Section 3 of [RFC4647] defines several matching
   schemes.  Implementations can offer that body part; a
   client cannot rely on receiving the most appropriate matching
   scheme for their requirements.  The "Basic Filtering" scheme
   ([RFC4647], Section 3.3.1) is identical to same ranges that it requested,
   nor the matching scheme same order that
   was previously defined for HTTP in Section 14.4 of [RFC2616].

   It it requested.

9.3.7.3.  Combining Parts

   A response might be contrary to the privacy expectations transfer only a subrange of a representation if the user to send
   an Accept-Language header field with
   connection closed prematurely or if the complete linguistic
   preferences request used one or more
   Range specifications.  After several such transfers, a client might
   have received several ranges of the user same representation.  These
   ranges can only be safely combined if they all have in every request (Section 9.7).

   Since intelligibility is highly dependent on the individual user,
   user agents need to allow user control over the linguistic preference
   (either through configuration of common the user agent itself or by
   defaulting to a user controllable system setting).
   same strong validator (Section 10.2.1).

   A user agent client that
   does not provide such control has received multiple partial responses to GET requests
   on a target resource MAY combine those responses into a larger
   continuous range if they share the user MUST NOT send same strong validator.

   If the most recent response is an Accept-
   Language header field.

      Note: User agents ought to provide guidance to users when setting
      a preference, since users are rarely familiar with incomplete 200 (OK) response, then
   the details header fields of
      language matching as described above.  For example, users might
      assume that on selecting "en-gb", they will be served response are used for any kind combined response
   and replace those of
      English document if British English the matching stored responses.

   If the most recent response is not available.  A user
      agent might suggest, in such a case, to add "en" to 206 (Partial Content) response and
   at least one of the list for
      better matching behavior.

5.4.  Authentication Credentials

   Two stored responses is a 200 (OK), then the
   combined response header fields consist of the most recent 200
   response's header fields.  If all of the matching stored responses
   are 206 responses, then the stored response with the most recent
   header fields is used for carrying authentication credentials, as defined in [AUTHFRM].  Note that various custom mechanisms for
   user authentication use the Cookie source of header field fields for this purpose, as
   defined the combined
   response, except that the client MUST use other header fields
   provided in [RFC6265].

   +---------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name   | Defined in...            |
   +---------------------+--------------------------+
   | Authorization       | Section 4.2 of [AUTHFRM] |
   | Proxy-Authorization | Section 4.4 the new response, aside from Content-Range, to replace
   all instances of [AUTHFRM] |
   +---------------------+--------------------------+

5.5.  Request Context

   The following request the corresponding header fields provide additional information
   about in the request context, including information about stored
   response.

   The combined response message body consists of the user, user
   agent, union of partial
   content ranges in the new response and resource behind each of the request.

   +-------------------+---------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in... |
   +-------------------+---------------+
   | From              | Section 5.5.1 |
   | Referer           | Section 5.5.2 |
   | User-Agent        | Section 5.5.3 |
   +-------------------+---------------+

5.5.1.  From

   The "From" header field contains an Internet email address for a
   human user who controls selected
   responses.  If the requesting user agent.  The address ought
   to be machine-usable, as defined by "mailbox" in Section 3.4 union consists of
   [RFC5322]:

     From    = mailbox

     mailbox = <mailbox, see [RFC5322], Section 3.4>

   An example is:

     From: webmaster@example.org

   The From header field is rarely sent by non-robotic user agents.  A
   user agent SHOULD NOT send a From header field without explicit
   configuration by the user, since that might conflict with entire range of the user's
   privacy interests or their site's security policy.

   A robotic user agent SHOULD send
   representation, then the client MUST process the combined response as
   if it were a valid From complete 200 (OK) response, including a Content-Length
   header field so that reflects the person responsible for running complete length.  Otherwise, the robot can be contacted if
   problems occur on servers, such
   client MUST process the set of continuous ranges as one of the
   following: an incomplete 200 (OK) response if the robot combined response
   is sending excessive,
   unwanted, or invalid requests.

   A server SHOULD NOT use a prefix of the From header field for access control representation, a single 206 (Partial Content)
   response containing a multipart/byteranges body, or
   authentication, since most recipients will assume multiple 206
   (Partial Content) responses, each with one continuous range that the field
   value is public information.

5.5.2.  Referer

   The "Referer" [sic]
   indicated by a Content-Range header field allows field.

9.4.  Redirection 3xx

   The 3xx (Redirection) class of status code indicates that further
   action needs to be taken by the user agent in order to specify a
   URI reference for the resource from which the target URI was obtained
   (i.e., the "referrer", though fulfill the
   request.  If a Location header field name (Section 10.1.2) is misspelled).  A provided,
   the user agent MUST NOT include the fragment and userinfo components of MAY automatically redirect its request to the URI reference [RFC3986], if any, when generating
   referenced by the Referer field
   value.

     Referer = absolute-URI / partial-URI

   The Referer header Location field allows servers to generate back-links value, even if the specific status
   code is not understood.  Automatic redirection needs to
   other resources done with
   care for simple analytics, logging, optimized caching,
   etc.  It also allows obsolete or mistyped links methods not known to be found for
   maintenance.  Some servers use safe, as defined in Section 7.2.1,
   since the Referer header field user might not wish to redirect an unsafe request.

   There are several types of redirects:

   1.  Redirects that indicate the resource might be available at a
       different URI, as provided by the Location field, as in the
       status codes 301 (Moved Permanently), 302 (Found), and 307
       (Temporary Redirect).

   2.  Redirection that offers a means choice of
   denying links from other sites (so-called "deep linking") or
   restricting cross-site matching resources, each
       capable of representing the original request forgery (CSRF), but not all requests
   contain it.

   Example:

     Referer: http://www.example.org/hypertext/Overview.html

   If target, as in the target URI was obtained from
       300 (Multiple Choices) status code.

   3.  Redirection to a source that does not have its
   own URI (e.g., input from different resource, identified by the user keyboard, or Location
       field, that can represent an entry within the
   user's bookmarks/favorites), indirect response to the user agent MUST either exclude request, as
       in the
   Referer field or send it with 303 (See Other) status code.

   4.  Redirection to a value of "about:blank".

   The Referer field has previously cached result, as in the potential to reveal information about 304 (Not
       Modified) status code.

      Note: In HTTP/1.0, the
   request context or browsing history status codes 301 (Moved Permanently) and
      302 (Found) were defined for the first type of redirect
      ([RFC1945], Section 9.3).  Early user agents split on whether the user, which is a privacy
   concern if
      method applied to the referring resource's identifier reveals personal
   information (such redirect target would be the same as an account name) the
      original request or a resource that is supposed
   to would be confidential (such rewritten as behind a firewall or internal GET.  Although HTTP
      originally defined the former semantics for 301 and 302 (to match
      its original implementation at CERN), and defined 303 (See Other)
      to a
   secured service).  Most general-purpose match the latter semantics, prevailing practice gradually
      converged on the latter semantics for 301 and 302 as well.  The
      first revision of HTTP/1.1 added 307 (Temporary Redirect) to
      indicate the former semantics without being impacted by divergent
      practice.  Over 10 years later, most user agents still do not send the
   Referer header field method
      rewriting for 301 and 302; therefore, this specification makes
      that behavior conformant when the referring resource original request is a local "file" or
   "data" URI. POST.

   A user agent MUST NOT send a Referer header field client SHOULD detect and intervene in an
   unsecured HTTP request if the referring page was received with cyclical redirections (i.e.,
   "infinite" redirection loops).

      Note: An earlier version of this specification recommended a
   secure protocol.  See
      maximum of five redirections ([RFC2068], Section 9.4 for additional security
   considerations.

   Some intermediaries have been known 10.3).  Content
      developers need to indiscriminately remove
   Referer header fields from outgoing requests.  This has be aware that some clients might implement such
      a fixed limitation.

9.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices

   The 300 (Multiple Choices) status code indicates that the
   unfortunate side effect of interfering target
   resource has more than one representation, each with protection against CSRF
   attacks, which its own more
   specific identifier, and information about the alternatives is being
   provided so that the user (or user agent) can be far more harmful select a preferred
   representation by redirecting its request to their users.
   Intermediaries and one or more of those
   identifiers.  In other words, the server desires that the user agent extensions that wish to limit
   information disclosure
   engage in Referer ought to restrict their changes reactive negotiation to
   specific edits, such as replacing internal domain names with
   pseudonyms or truncating select the query and/or path components.  An
   intermediary SHOULD NOT modify or delete most appropriate
   representation(s) for its needs (Section 6.4).

   If the Referer server has a preferred choice, the server SHOULD generate a
   Location header field
   when containing a preferred choice's URI reference.

   The user agent MAY use the Location field value shares for automatic
   redirection.

   For request methods other than HEAD, the same scheme server SHOULD generate a
   payload in the 300 response containing a list of representation
   metadata and host as URI reference(s) from which the request
   target.

5.5.3.  User-Agent

   The "User-Agent" header field contains information about user or user agent can
   choose the one most preferred.  The user agent originating MAY make a selection
   from that list automatically if it understands the request, which provided media
   type.  A specific format for automatic selection is often used not defined by servers
   this specification because HTTP tries to remain orthogonal to help
   identify the scope
   definition of reported interoperability problems, its payloads.  In practice, the representation is
   provided in some easily parsed format believed to work
   around or tailor responses be acceptable to avoid particular
   the user agent
   limitations, and for analytics regarding browser agent, as determined by shared design or content
   negotiation, or operating system
   use.  A user agent SHOULD send a User-Agent field in each request some commonly accepted hypertext format.

   A 300 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless specifically configured not to do so.

     User-Agent = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

   The User-Agent field-value consists of one or more product
   identifiers, each followed otherwise
   indicated by zero the method definition or more comments (Section 3.2 explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of
   [MESSGNG]), which together identify [Caching]).

      Note: The original proposal for the user agent software and its
   significant subproducts.  By convention, 300 status code defined the product identifiers are
   listed in decreasing order
      URI header field as providing a list of their significance alternative
      representations, such that it would be usable for identifying 200, 300, and
      406 responses and be transferred in responses to the
   user agent software.  Each product identifier consists HEAD method.
      However, lack of a name deployment and
   optional version.

     product         = token ["/" product-version]
     product-version = token

   A sender SHOULD limit generated product identifiers disagreement over syntax led to what
      both URI and Alternates (a subsequent proposal) being dropped from
      this specification.  It is
   necessary possible to identify communicate the product; list using
      a sender MUST NOT generate
   advertising or other nonessential information within the product
   identifier.  A sender SHOULD NOT generate information in product-
   version that set of Link header fields [RFC5988], each with a relationship of
      "alternate", though deployment is not a version identifier (i.e., successive versions chicken-and-egg problem.

9.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently

   The 301 (Moved Permanently) status code indicates that the target
   resource has been assigned a new permanent URI and any future
   references to this resource ought to use one of the same product name enclosed URIs.
   Clients with link-editing capabilities ought to differ only in automatically re-link
   references to the product-version
   portion effective request URI to one or more of the product identifier).

   Example:

     User-Agent: CERN-LineMode/2.15 libwww/2.17b3

   A user agent new
   references sent by the server, where possible.

   The server SHOULD NOT generate a User-Agent field containing
   needlessly fine-grained detail and SHOULD limit the addition of
   subproducts by third parties.  Overly long and detailed User-Agent Location header field values increase request latency and in the risk of response
   containing a preferred URI reference for the new permanent URI.  The
   user being
   identified against their wishes ("fingerprinting").

   Likewise, implementations are encouraged not to agent MAY use the product
   tokens of other implementations in order to declare compatibility
   with them, as this circumvents the purpose of the field.  If Location field value for automatic
   redirection.  The server's response payload usually contains a user
   agent masquerades as short
   hypertext note with a different user agent, recipients can assume
   that the user intentionally desires hyperlink to see responses tailored for
   that identified user agent, even if they might not work as well for the actual new URI(s).

      Note: For historical reasons, a user agent being used.

6.  Response Status Codes

   The status-code element is a three-digit integer code giving the
   result of MAY change the attempt request
      method from POST to understand and satisfy GET for the subsequent request.

   HTTP status codes are extensible.  HTTP clients are not required to
   understand the meaning of all registered status codes, though such
   understanding  If this
      behavior is obviously desirable.  However, a client MUST
   understand undesired, the class of any 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code, as code
      can be used instead.

   A 301 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the first
   digit, and treat an unrecognized status code as being equivalent to
   the x00 method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [Caching]).

9.4.3.  302 Found

   The 302 (Found) status code of indicates that class, with the exception that a
   recipient MUST NOT cache a response with an unrecognized status code.

   For example, if an unrecognized status code of 471 is received by target resource
   resides temporarily under a
   client, different URI.  Since the redirection
   might be altered on occasion, the client can assume that there was something wrong with its
   request and treat ought to continue to use the response as if it had received a 400 (Bad
   Request) status code.
   effective request URI for future requests.

   The response message will usually contain server SHOULD generate a
   representation that explains the status.

   The first digit of the status-code defines Location header field in the class of response.
   The last two digits do not have any categorization role.  There are
   five values response
   containing a URI reference for the first digit:

   o  1xx (Informational): The request was received, continuing process

   o  2xx (Successful): different URI.  The request was successfully received,
      understood, and accepted

   o  3xx (Redirection): Further action needs to be taken in order to
      complete user agent MAY
   use the request

   o  4xx (Client Error): Location field value for automatic redirection.  The request server's
   response payload usually contains bad syntax or cannot be
      fulfilled

   o  5xx (Server Error): The server failed a short hypertext note with a
   hyperlink to fulfill an apparently
      valid the different URI(s).

      Note: For historical reasons, a user agent MAY change the request

6.1.  Overview of Status Codes

   The status codes listed below are defined in
      method from POST to GET for the subsequent request.  If this specification,
   Section 4 of [CONDTNL], Section 4 of [RANGERQ], and Section 3 of
   [AUTHFRM].  The reason phrases listed here are only recommendations
   -- they
      behavior is undesired, the 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code
      can be replaced by local equivalents without affecting the
   protocol.

   Responses with used instead.

9.4.4.  303 See Other

   The 303 (See Other) status codes code indicates that are defined the server is
   redirecting the user agent to a different resource, as cacheable indicated by default
   (e.g., 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301, 404, 405, 410, 414, and 501 a
   URI in
   this specification) the Location header field, which is intended to provide an
   indirect response to the original request.  A user agent can be reused by perform
   a cache with heuristic
   expiration unless otherwise indicated by the method definition or
   explicit cache controls [CACHING]; all other status codes are not
   cacheable by default.

   +------+-------------------------------+--------------------------+
   | Code | Reason-Phrase                 | Defined in...            |
   +------+-------------------------------+--------------------------+
   | 100  | Continue                      | Section 6.2.1            |
   | 101  | Switching Protocols           | Section 6.2.2            |
   | 200  | OK                            | Section 6.3.1            |
   | 201  | Created                       | Section 6.3.2            |
   | 202  | Accepted                      | Section 6.3.3            |
   | 203  | Non-Authoritative Information | Section 6.3.4            |
   | 204  | No Content                    | Section 6.3.5            |
   | 205  | Reset Content                 | Section 6.3.6            |
   | 206  | Partial Content               | Section 4.1 of [RANGERQ] |
   | 300  | Multiple Choices              | Section 6.4.1            |
   | 301  | Moved Permanently             | Section 6.4.2            |
   | 302  | Found                         | Section 6.4.3            |
   | 303  | See Other                     | Section 6.4.4            |
   | 304  | Not Modified                  | Section 4.1 of [CONDTNL] |
   | 305  | Use Proxy                     | Section 6.4.5            |
   | 307  | Temporary Redirect            | Section 6.4.7            |
   | 400  | Bad Request                   | Section 6.5.1            |
   | 401  | Unauthorized                  | Section 3.1 of [AUTHFRM] |
   | 402  | Payment Required              | Section 6.5.2            |
   | 403  | Forbidden                     | Section 6.5.3            |
   | 404  | Not Found                     | Section 6.5.4            |
   | 405  | Method Not Allowed            | Section 6.5.5            |
   | 406  | Not Acceptable                | Section 6.5.6            |
   | 407  | Proxy Authentication Required | Section 3.2 of [AUTHFRM] |
   | 408  | Request Timeout               | Section 6.5.7            |
   | 409  | Conflict                      | Section 6.5.8            |
   | 410  | Gone                          | Section 6.5.9            |
   | 411  | Length Required               | Section 6.5.10           |
   | 412  | Precondition Failed           | Section 4.2 of [CONDTNL] |
   | 413  | Payload Too Large             | Section 6.5.11           |
   | 414  | retrieval request targeting that URI Too Long                  | Section 6.5.12           |
   | 415  | Unsupported Media Type        | Section 6.5.13           |
   | 416  | Range Not Satisfiable         | Section 4.4 of [RANGERQ] |
   | 417  | Expectation Failed            | Section 6.5.14           |
   | 426  | Upgrade Required              | Section 6.5.15           |
   | 500  | Internal Server Error         | Section 6.6.1            |
   | 501  | Not Implemented               | Section 6.6.2            |
   | 502  | Bad Gateway                   | Section 6.6.3            |
   | 503  | Service Unavailable           | Section 6.6.4            |
   | 504  | Gateway Timeout               | Section 6.6.5            |
   | 505  | HTTP Version Not Supported    | Section 6.6.6            |
   +------+-------------------------------+--------------------------+ (a GET or HEAD request if
   using HTTP), which might also be redirected, and present the eventual
   result as an answer to the original request.  Note that this list the new URI
   in the Location header field is not exhaustive -- it does not include
   extension considered equivalent to the
   effective request URI.

   This status codes defined code is applicable to any HTTP method.  It is primarily
   used to allow the output of a POST action to redirect the user agent
   to a selected resource, since doing so provides the information
   corresponding to the POST response in other specifications.  The complete
   list a form that can be separately
   identified, bookmarked, and cached, independent of status codes is maintained the original
   request.

   A 303 response to a GET request indicates that the origin server does
   not have a representation of the target resource that can be
   transferred by IANA.  See Section 8.2 the server over HTTP.  However, the Location field
   value refers to a resource that is descriptive of the target
   resource, such that making a retrieval request on that other resource
   might result in a representation that is useful to recipients without
   implying that it represents the original target resource.  Note that
   answers to the questions of what can be represented, what
   representations are adequate, and what might be a useful description
   are outside the scope of HTTP.

   Except for
   details.

6.2.  Informational 1xx

   The 1xx (Informational) class responses to a HEAD request, the representation of a 303
   response ought to contain a short hypertext note with a hyperlink to
   the same URI reference provided in the Location header field.

9.4.5.  304 Not Modified

   The 304 (Not Modified) status code indicates an interim
   response for communicating connection status that a conditional GET
   or HEAD request progress
   prior has been received and would have resulted in a 200
   (OK) response if it were not for the fact that the condition
   evaluated to completing false.  In other words, there is no need for the requested action and sending server
   to transfer a final
   response.  1xx responses are terminated by representation of the first empty line after target resource because the status-line (the empty line signaling
   request indicates that the end client, which made the request
   conditional, already has a valid representation; the server is
   therefore redirecting the client to make use of that stored
   representation as if it were the header
   section).  Since HTTP/1.0 did not define any 1xx status codes, payload of a 200 (OK) response.

   The server generating a 304 response MUST NOT send generate any of the
   following header fields that would have been sent in a 1xx 200 (OK)
   response to an HTTP/1.0 client.

   A client MUST be able the same request: Cache-Control, Content-Location, Date,
   ETag, Expires, and Vary.

   Since the goal of a 304 response is to parse minimize information transfer
   when the recipient already has one or more 1xx responses received
   prior to cached representations, a final response, even
   sender SHOULD NOT generate representation metadata other than the
   above listed fields unless said metadata exists for the purpose of
   guiding cache updates (e.g., Last-Modified might be useful if the client
   response does not expect one.  A have an ETag field).

   Requirements on a cache that receives a 304 response are defined in
   Section 4.3.4 of [Caching].  If the conditional request originated
   with an outbound client, such as a user agent MAY ignore unexpected 1xx responses.

   A with its own cache
   sending a conditional GET to a shared proxy, then the proxy MUST SHOULD
   forward 1xx responses unless the proxy itself requested 304 response to that client.

   A 304 response cannot contain a message-body; it is always terminated
   by the generation of first empty line after the 1xx response.  For example, if header fields.

9.4.6.  305 Use Proxy

   The 305 (Use Proxy) status code was defined in a proxy adds an
   "Expect: 100-continue" field when it forwards previous version of
   this specification and is now deprecated (Appendix B of [RFC7231]).

9.4.7.  306 (Unused)

   The 306 status code was defined in a request, then it need
   not forward previous version of this
   specification, is no longer used, and the corresponding 100 (Continue) response(s).

6.2.1.  100 Continue code is reserved.

9.4.8.  307 Temporary Redirect

   The 100 (Continue) 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code indicates that the initial part of target
   resource resides temporarily under a
   request has been received different URI and has not yet been rejected by the
   server.  The server intends to send a final response after the
   request has been fully received and acted upon.

   When user agent
   MUST NOT change the request contains method if it performs an Expect header field that includes a
   100-continue expectation, the 100 response indicates automatic
   redirection to that URI.  Since the server
   wishes to receive redirection can change over time,
   the request payload body, as described in
   Section 5.1.1.  The client ought to continue sending the request and
   discard the 100 response.

   If using the original effective request did not contain an Expect header field containing the
   100-continue expectation, the client can simply discard this interim
   response.

6.2.2.  101 Switching Protocols

   The 101 (Switching Protocols) status code indicates that the server
   understands and is willing to comply with the client's request, via
   the Upgrade header field (Section 6.7 of [MESSGNG]), URI
   for a change in
   the application protocol being used on this connection. future requests.

   The server
   MUST SHOULD generate an Upgrade a Location header field in the response that indicates
   which protocol(s) will be switched to immediately after the empty
   line that terminates
   containing a URI reference for the 101 response.

   It is assumed that different URI.  The user agent MAY
   use the server will only agree to switch protocols
   when it is advantageous to do so.  For example, switching to Location field value for automatic redirection.  The server's
   response payload usually contains a newer
   version of HTTP might be advantageous over older versions, and
   switching to short hypertext note with a real-time, synchronous protocol might be advantageous
   when delivering resources that use such features.

6.3.  Successful 2xx

   The 2xx (Successful) class of
   hyperlink to the different URI(s).

      Note: This status code indicates is similar to 302 (Found), except that it
      does not allow changing the client's request was successfully received, understood, and accepted.

6.3.1.  200 OK method from POST to GET.  This
      specification defines no equivalent counterpart for 301 (Moved
      Permanently) ([RFC7238], however, defines the status code 308
      (Permanent Redirect) for this purpose).

9.5.  Client Error 4xx

   The 200 (OK) 4xx (Client Error) class of status code indicates that the request has succeeded.
   The payload sent in a 200 response depends on the request method.
   For the methods defined by this specification, the intended meaning
   of the payload can be summarized as:

   GET client
   seems to have erred.  Except when responding to a representation of the target resource; HEAD request, the same representation as GET, but without the representation
      data;

   POST
   server SHOULD send a representation containing an explanation of the status of, or results obtained from,
      the action;

   PUT, DELETE
   error situation, and whether it is a temporary or permanent
   condition.  These status codes are applicable to any request method.
   User agents SHOULD display any included representation of to the user.

9.5.1.  400 Bad Request

   The 400 (Bad Request) status of the action;

   OPTIONS  a representation of code indicates that the communications options;

   TRACE  a representation of server cannot or
   will not process the request message as received by the end
      server.

   Aside from responses due to CONNECT, a 200 response always has a payload,
   though an origin server MAY generate a payload body of zero length.
   If no payload something that is desired, an origin server ought perceived to send 204 (No
   Content) instead.  For CONNECT, no payload is allowed because the
   successful result is be
   a tunnel, which begins immediately after the 200
   response header section.

   A 200 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition client error (e.g., malformed request syntax, invalid request
   message framing, or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

6.3.2.  201 Created deceptive request routing).

9.5.2.  401 Unauthorized

   The 201 (Created) 401 (Unauthorized) status code indicates that the request has not
   been
   fulfilled and has resulted in applied because it lacks valid authentication credentials for
   the target resource.  The server generating a 401 response MUST send
   a WWW-Authenticate header field (Section 10.3.1) containing at least
   one or more new resources being
   created. challenge applicable to the target resource.

   If the request included authentication credentials, then the 401
   response indicates that authorization has been refused for those
   credentials.  The primary resource created by user agent MAY repeat the request is identified
   by either with a Location new or
   replaced Authorization header field in (Section 8.5.3).  If the 401
   response or, if no Location
   field is received, by contains the effective request URI.

   The 201 response payload typically describes same challenge as the prior response, and links the
   user agent has already attempted authentication at least once, then
   the user agent SHOULD present the enclosed representation to the
   resource(s) created.  See Section 7.2
   user, since it usually contains relevant diagnostic information.

9.5.3.  402 Payment Required

   The 402 (Payment Required) status code is reserved for a discussion of the meaning
   and purpose of validator header fields, such as ETag and Last-
   Modified, in a 201 response.

6.3.3.  202 Accepted future use.

9.5.4.  403 Forbidden

   The 202 (Accepted) 403 (Forbidden) status code indicates that the server understood
   the request has been
   accepted for processing, but refuses to authorize it.  A server that wishes to
   make public why the processing request has not been completed.
   The request might or might not eventually be acted upon, as it might
   be disallowed when processing actually takes place.  There is no
   facility forbidden can describe that
   reason in HTTP for re-sending a status code from an asynchronous
   operation.

   The 202 the response is intentionally noncommittal.  Its purpose is to
   allow a payload (if any).

   If authentication credentials were provided in the request, the
   server considers them insufficient to accept grant access.  The client
   SHOULD NOT automatically repeat the request with the same
   credentials.  The client MAY repeat the request with new or different
   credentials.  However, a request might be forbidden for some other process (perhaps a
   batch-oriented process that is only run once per day) without
   requiring that the user agent's connection reasons
   unrelated to the credentials.

   An origin server persist
   until the process is completed.  The representation sent with this
   response ought that wishes to describe "hide" the request's current status and point to
   (or embed) existence of a status monitor that can provide the user
   forbidden target resource MAY instead respond with an
   estimate a status code of when the request will be fulfilled.

6.3.4.  203 Non-Authoritative Information
   404 (Not Found).

9.5.5.  404 Not Found

   The 203 (Non-Authoritative Information) 404 (Not Found) status code indicates that the request was successful but origin server did
   not find a current representation for the enclosed payload has been modified
   from target resource or is not
   willing to disclose that one exists.  A 404 status code does not
   indicate whether this lack of representation is temporary or
   permanent; the 410 (Gone) status code is preferred over 404 if the
   origin server's 200 (OK) server knows, presumably through some configurable means, that
   the condition is likely to be permanent.

   A 404 response is cacheable by a transforming
   proxy (Section 5.7.2 default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [MESSGNG]).  This [Caching]).

9.5.6.  405 Method Not Allowed

   The 405 (Method Not Allowed) status code allows the
   proxy to notify recipients when a transformation has been applied,
   since indicates that knowledge might impact later decisions regarding the
   content.  For example, future cache validation requests for method
   received in the
   content might only be applicable along request-line is known by the same request path (through origin server but not
   supported by the same proxies). target resource.  The 203 origin server MUST generate an
   Allow header field in a 405 response is similar to the Warning code of 214 Transformation
   Applied (Section 5.5 containing a list of [CACHING]), which has the advantage of being
   applicable to responses with any status code. target
   resource's currently supported methods.

   A 203 405 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

6.3.5.  204 No Content [Caching]).

9.5.7.  406 Not Acceptable

   The 204 (No Content) 406 (Not Acceptable) status code indicates that the server has
   successfully fulfilled target
   resource does not have a current representation that would be
   acceptable to the user agent, according to the proactive negotiation
   header fields received in the request (Section 8.4), and that there the server
   is no additional
   content unwilling to send in the response supply a default representation.

   The server SHOULD generate a payload body.  Metadata containing a list of available
   representation characteristics and corresponding resource identifiers
   from which the user or user agent can choose the one most
   appropriate.  A user agent MAY automatically select the most
   appropriate choice from that list.  However, this specification does
   not define any standard for such automatic selection, as described in
   Section 9.4.1.

9.5.8.  407 Proxy Authentication Required

   The 407 (Proxy Authentication Required) status code is similar to 401
   (Unauthorized), but it indicates that the
   response client needs to
   authenticate itself in order to use a proxy.  The proxy MUST send a
   Proxy-Authenticate header fields refer field (Section 10.3.2) containing a
   challenge applicable to that proxy for the target resource and its selected
   representation after resource.  The
   client MAY repeat the requested action was applied.

   For example, if request with a 204 new or replaced Proxy-
   Authorization header field (Section 8.5.4).

9.5.9.  408 Request Timeout

   The 408 (Request Timeout) status code is received in response to indicates that the server did
   not receive a PUT complete request and message within the response contains an ETag header field, then time that it was
   prepared to wait.  A server SHOULD send the "close" connection option
   (Section 9.1 of [Messaging]) in the PUT
   was successful and response, since 408 implies that
   the ETag field-value contains server has decided to close the entity-tag for connection rather than continue
   waiting.  If the new representation of client has an outstanding request in transit, the
   client MAY repeat that target resource.

   The 204 response allows request on a server to indicate new connection.

9.5.10.  409 Conflict

   The 409 (Conflict) status code indicates that the action has been
   successfully applied request could not
   be completed due to a conflict with the current state of the target resource, while implying that
   resource.  This code is used in situations where the user agent does not need might be
   able to traverse away from its current "document
   view" (if any). resolve the conflict and resubmit the request.  The server assumes
   SHOULD generate a payload that the includes enough information for a user agent will provide
   some indication
   to recognize the source of the success conflict.

   Conflicts are most likely to its user, in accord with its own
   interface, and apply any new or updated metadata occur in the response to
   its active representation. a PUT request.  For
   example, a 204 status code is commonly if versioning were being used with document editing
   interfaces corresponding and the representation being
   PUT included changes to a "save" action, such resource that conflict with those made by
   an earlier (third-party) request, the document
   being saved remains available origin server might use a 409
   response to the user for editing.  It is also
   frequently used with interfaces indicate that expect automated data transfers
   to be prevalent, such as within distributed version control systems.

   A 204 response is terminated by it can't complete the first empty line after request.  In this
   case, the header
   fields because it cannot contain a message body.

   A 204 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by representation would likely contain information
   useful for merging the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

6.3.6.  205 Reset Content differences based on the revision history.

9.5.11.  410 Gone

   The 205 (Reset Content) 410 (Gone) status code indicates that access to the server has
   fulfilled target
   resource is no longer available at the request origin server and desires that this
   condition is likely to be permanent.  If the user agent reset origin server does not
   know, or has no facility to determine, whether or not the
   "document view", which caused condition
   is permanent, the request status code 404 (Not Found) ought to be sent, to its original
   state as received from the origin server.

   This used
   instead.

   The 410 response is primarily intended to support a common data entry use case
   where assist the user receives content task of web
   maintenance by notifying the recipient that supports data entry (a form,
   notepad, canvas, etc.), enters or manipulates data in the resource is
   intentionally unavailable and that space,
   causes the entered data server owners desire that
   remote links to that resource be submitted in a request, removed.  Such an event is common
   for limited-time, promotional services and then for resources belonging to
   individuals no longer associated with the
   data entry mechanism origin server's site.  It
   is reset for not necessary to mark all permanently unavailable resources as
   "gone" or to keep the next entry so mark for any length of time -- that is left to
   the user can
   easily initiate another input action.

   Since discretion of the server owner.

   A 410 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the 205 method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [Caching]).

9.5.12.  411 Length Required

   The 411 (Length Required) status code implies indicates that no additional content will be
   provided, a server MUST NOT generate a payload in a 205 response.  In
   other words, a the server MUST do one of
   refuses to accept the following for a 205
   response: a) indicate request without a zero-length body for defined Content-Length
   (Section 6.2.4).  The client MAY repeat the response by
   including request if it adds a
   valid Content-Length header field with a value of 0; b)
   indicate a zero-length payload for containing the response by including a
   Transfer-Encoding header field with a value length of chunked and a the
   message body consisting of a single chunk of zero-length; or, c) close the
   connection immediately after sending in the blank line terminating request message.

9.5.13.  412 Precondition Failed

   The 412 (Precondition Failed) status code indicates that one or more
   conditions given in the request header section.

6.4.  Redirection 3xx fields evaluated to false when
   tested on the server.  This response code allows the client to place
   preconditions on the current resource state (its current
   representations and metadata) and, thus, prevent the request method
   from being applied if the target resource is in an unexpected state.

9.5.14.  413 Payload Too Large

   The 3xx (Redirection) class of 413 (Payload Too Large) status code indicates that further
   action needs the server is
   refusing to be taken by process a request because the user agent in order request payload is larger
   than the server is willing or able to fulfill process.  The server MAY close
   the connection to prevent the client from continuing the request.

   If the condition is temporary, the server SHOULD generate a Location Retry-
   After header field (Section 7.1.2) to indicate that it is provided, temporary and after what
   time the
   user agent client MAY automatically redirect its request try again.

9.5.15.  414 URI Too Long

   The 414 (URI Too Long) status code indicates that the server is
   refusing to service the URI
   referenced by request because the Location field value, even if request-target
   (Section 3.2 of [Messaging]) is longer than the specific status
   code server is not understood.  Automatic redirection needs willing to done with
   care for methods not known
   interpret.  This rare condition is only likely to be safe, as defined in Section 4.2.1,
   since the user might not wish occur when a client
   has improperly converted a POST request to redirect an unsafe request.

   There are several types a GET request with long
   query information, when the client has descended into a "black hole"
   of redirects:

   1.  Redirects redirection (e.g., a redirected URI prefix that indicate points to a suffix
   of itself) or when the resource might be available at server is under attack by a
       different URI, as provided client attempting
   to exploit potential security holes.

   A 414 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the Location field, as in the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [Caching]).

9.5.16.  415 Unsupported Media Type

   The 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status codes 301 (Moved Permanently), 302 (Found), and 307
       (Temporary Redirect).

   2.  Redirection code indicates that offers a choice of matching resources, each
       capable of representing the original
   origin server is refusing to service the request target, as because the payload
   is in a format not supported by this method on the
       300 (Multiple Choices) status code.

   3.  Redirection target resource.
   The format problem might be due to the request's indicated Content-
   Type or Content-Encoding, or as a different resource, identified by result of inspecting the Location
       field, data
   directly.

9.5.17.  416 Range Not Satisfiable

   The 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) status code indicates that can represent an indirect response to none of
   the request, as ranges in the 303 (See Other) status code.

   4.  Redirection to a previously cached result, as in request's Range header field (Section 8.3) overlap
   the 304 (Not
       Modified) status code.

      Note: In HTTP/1.0, current extent of the status codes 301 (Moved Permanently) and
      302 (Found) were defined for selected resource or that the first type set of redirect
      ([RFC1945], Section 9.3).  Early user agents split on whether the
      method applied ranges
   requested has been rejected due to invalid ranges or an excessive
   request of small or overlapping ranges.

   For byte ranges, failing to overlap the redirect target would be current extent means that the same as
   first-byte-pos of all of the
      original request or would be rewritten as GET.  Although HTTP
      originally defined byte-range-spec values were greater than
   the former semantics for 301 and 302 (to match
      its original implementation at CERN), and defined 303 (See Other) current length of the selected representation.  When this status
   code is generated in response to match a byte-range request, the latter semantics, prevailing practice gradually
      converged on sender
   SHOULD generate a Content-Range header field specifying the latter semantics for 301 and 302 as well.  The
      first revision current
   length of the selected representation (Section 6.3.3).

   For example:

     HTTP/1.1 added 307 (Temporary Redirect) 416 Range Not Satisfiable
     Date: Fri, 20 Jan 2012 15:41:54 GMT
     Content-Range: bytes */47022

      Note: Because servers are free to
      indicate the former semantics without being impacted by divergent
      practice.  Over 10 years later, most user agents still do method
      rewriting for 301 and 302; therefore, this specification makes
      that behavior conformant when ignore Range, many
      implementations will simply respond with the original request is POST.

   A client SHOULD detect and intervene entire selected
      representation in cyclical redirections (i.e.,
   "infinite" redirection loops).

      Note: An earlier version of this specification recommended a
      maximum of five redirections ([RFC2068], Section 10.3).  Content
      developers need 200 (OK) response.  That is partly because
      most clients are prepared to be aware that some receive a 200 (OK) to complete the
      task (albeit less efficiently) and partly because clients might implement such
      not stop making an invalid partial request until they have
      received a fixed limitation.

6.4.1.  300 Multiple Choices complete representation.  Thus, clients cannot depend
      on receiving a 416 (Range Not Satisfiable) response even when it
      is most appropriate.

9.5.18.  417 Expectation Failed

   The 300 (Multiple Choices) 417 (Expectation Failed) status code indicates that the target
   resource has more than
   expectation given in the request's Expect header field
   (Section 8.1.1) could not be met by at least one representation, each with its own more
   specific identifier, and information about of the alternatives is being
   provided so inbound
   servers.

9.5.19.  426 Upgrade Required

   The 426 (Upgrade Required) status code indicates that the user (or user agent) can select a preferred
   representation by redirecting its server
   refuses to perform the request using the current protocol but might
   be willing to one or more do so after the client upgrades to a different
   protocol.  The server MUST send an Upgrade header field in a 426
   response to indicate the required protocol(s) (Section 9.7 of
   [Messaging]).

   Example:

     HTTP/1.1 426 Upgrade Required
     Upgrade: HTTP/3.0
     Connection: Upgrade
     Content-Length: 53
     Content-Type: text/plain

     This service requires use of the HTTP/3.0 protocol.

9.6.  Server Error 5xx

   The 5xx (Server Error) class of those
   identifiers.  In other words, status code indicates that the server desires
   is aware that it has erred or is incapable of performing the user agent
   engage in reactive negotiation
   requested method.  Except when responding to select the most appropriate
   representation(s) for its needs (Section 3.4).

   If the server has a preferred choice, HEAD request, the
   server SHOULD generate send a
   Location header field representation containing an explanation of the
   error situation, and whether it is a preferred choice's URI reference.
   The temporary or permanent
   condition.  A user agent MAY use SHOULD display any included representation
   to the Location field value for automatic
   redirection.

   For user.  These response codes are applicable to any request methods other than HEAD,
   method.

9.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error

   The 500 (Internal Server Error) status code indicates that the server SHOULD generate a
   payload in the 300 response containing a list of representation
   metadata and URI reference(s)
   encountered an unexpected condition that prevented it from which the user or user agent can
   choose fulfilling
   the one most preferred. request.

9.6.2.  501 Not Implemented

   The user agent MAY make a selection
   from 501 (Not Implemented) status code indicates that list automatically if it understands the provided media
   type.  A specific format for automatic selection is server does
   not defined by
   this specification because HTTP tries to remain orthogonal to support the
   definition of its payloads.  In practice, functionality required to fulfill the representation request.  This
   is
   provided in some easily parsed format believed to be acceptable to the user agent, as determined by shared design or content
   negotiation, or in some commonly accepted hypertext format. appropriate response when the server does not recognize the
   request method and is not capable of supporting it for any resource.

   A 300 501 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

      Note: [Caching]).

9.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway

   The original proposal for the 300 502 (Bad Gateway) status code defined indicates that the
      URI header field server, while
   acting as providing a list of alternative
      representations, such that gateway or proxy, received an invalid response from an
   inbound server it would be usable for 200, 300, and
      406 responses and be transferred in responses accessed while attempting to fulfill the HEAD method.
      However, lack of deployment and disagreement over syntax led to
      both URI and Alternates (a subsequent proposal) being dropped from
      this specification.  It request.

9.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable

   The 503 (Service Unavailable) status code indicates that the server
   is possible currently unable to communicate handle the list using request due to a set of Link header fields [RFC5988], each with temporary overload
   or scheduled maintenance, which will likely be alleviated after some
   delay.  The server MAY send a relationship Retry-After header field
   (Section 10.1.3) to suggest an appropriate amount of
      "alternate", though deployment is time for the
   client to wait before retrying the request.

      Note: The existence of the 503 status code does not imply that a chicken-and-egg problem.

6.4.2.  301 Moved Permanently
      server has to use it when becoming overloaded.  Some servers might
      simply refuse the connection.

9.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout

   The 301 (Moved Permanently) 504 (Gateway Timeout) status code indicates that the server,
   while acting as a gateway or proxy, did not receive a timely response
   from an upstream server it needed to access in order to complete the
   request.

9.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported

   The 505 (HTTP Version Not Supported) status code indicates that the target
   resource has been assigned a new permanent URI and any future
   references to this resource ought
   server does not support, or refuses to use one support, the major version of
   HTTP that was used in the enclosed URIs.
   Clients with link-editing capabilities ought to automatically re-link
   references request message.  The server is indicating
   that it is unable or unwilling to complete the effective request URI to one or more of using the new
   references sent by same
   major version as the server, where possible. client, as described in Section 3.5, other than
   with this error message.  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in the response
   containing a preferred URI reference representation
   for the new permanent URI.  The
   user agent MAY use 505 response that describes why that version is not supported
   and what other protocols are supported by that server.

9.7.  Status Code Extensibility

   Additional status codes, outside the Location field value scope of this specification,
   have been specified for automatic
   redirection.  The server's response payload usually contains a short
   hypertext note with a hyperlink use in HTTP.  All such status codes ought to
   be registered within the new URI(s).

      Note: For historical reasons, a user agent MAY change "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status
   Code Registry".

9.7.1.  Status Code Registry

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status Code Registry",
   maintained by IANA at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-status-
   codes>, registers status-code numbers.

   A registration MUST include the request
      method from POST following fields:

   o  Status Code (3 digits)
   o  Short Description

   o  Pointer to specification text

   Values to be added to GET for the subsequent request.  If this
      behavior HTTP status code namespace require IETF
   Review (see [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

9.7.2.  Considerations for New Status Codes

   When it is undesired, the 307 (Temporary Redirect) necessary to express semantics for a response that are not
   defined by current status codes, a new status code can be used instead.

   A 301 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition registered.
   Status codes are generic; they are potentially applicable to any
   resource, not just one particular media type, kind of resource, or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2
   application of [CACHING]).

6.4.3.  302 Found

   The 302 (Found) status code indicates HTTP.  As such, it is preferred that the target resource
   resides temporarily under a different URI.  Since the redirection
   might new status codes
   be altered on occasion, the client ought registered in a document that isn't specific to continue a single
   application.

   New status codes are required to use fall under one of the
   effective request URI for future requests.

   The server SHOULD generate a Location header field categories
   defined in Section 9.  To allow existing parsers to process the
   response
   containing a URI reference for the different URI.  The user agent MAY
   use the Location field value for automatic redirection.  The server's
   response payload usually contains message, new status codes cannot disallow a short hypertext note with payload,
   although they can mandate a
   hyperlink zero-length payload body.

   Proposals for new status codes that are not yet widely deployed ought
   to the different URI(s).

      Note: For historical reasons, avoid allocating a user agent MAY change the request
      method from POST to GET specific number for the subsequent request.  If this
      behavior is undesired, the 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code
      can be used instead.

6.4.4.  303 See Other

   The 303 (See Other) status code indicates until there is
   clear consensus that it will be registered; instead, early drafts can
   use a notation such as "4NN", or "3N0" .. "3N9", to indicate the server is
   redirecting
   class of the user agent to proposed status code(s) without consuming a different resource, as indicated by number
   prematurely.

   The definition of a
   URI in the Location header field, which is intended to provide an
   indirect response new status code ought to explain the original request.  A user agent can perform
   a retrieval request targeting
   conditions that URI (a GET or HEAD would cause a response containing that status code
   (e.g., combinations of request if
   using HTTP), which might also be redirected, header fields and/or method(s)) along
   with any dependencies on response header fields (e.g., what fields
   are required, what fields can modify the semantics, and present what header
   field semantics are further refined when used with the eventual
   result as an answer new status
   code).

   The definition of a new status code ought to the original request. specify whether or not
   it is cacheable.  Note that all status codes can be cached if the new URI
   response they occur in the Location header field is not considered equivalent has explicit freshness information; however,
   status codes that are defined as being cacheable are allowed to be
   cached without explicit freshness information.  Likewise, the
   effective request URI.

   This
   definition of a status code is applicable to any HTTP method.  It is primarily
   used to allow can place constraints upon cache
   behavior.  See [Caching] for more information.

   Finally, the output definition of a POST action new status code ought to redirect indicate
   whether the user agent payload has any implied association with an identified
   resource (Section 6.3.2).

10.  Response Header Fields

   The response header fields allow the server to a selected resource, since doing so provides pass additional
   information about the response beyond what is placed in the status-
   line.  These header fields give information
   corresponding about the server, about
   further access to the POST target resource, or about related resources.

   Although each response in header field has a form that can defined meaning, in
   general, the precise semantics might be separately
   identified, bookmarked, and cached, independent further refined by the
   semantics of the original
   request.

   A 303 response to a GET request indicates method and/or response status code.

10.1.  Control Data

   Response header fields can supply control data that supplements the origin server does
   not have
   status code, directs caching, or instructs the client where to go
   next.

   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...            |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | Age               | Section 5.1 of [Caching] |
   | Cache-Control     | Section 5.2 of [Caching] |
   | Expires           | Section 5.3 of [Caching] |
   | Date              | Section 10.1.1.2         |
   | Location          | Section 10.1.2           |
   | Retry-After       | Section 10.1.3           |
   | Vary              | Section 10.1.4           |
   | Warning           | Section 5.5 of [Caching] |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+

10.1.1.  Origination Date

10.1.1.1.  Date/Time Formats

   Prior to 1995, there were three different formats commonly used by
   servers to communicate timestamps.  For compatibility with old
   implementations, all three are defined here.  The preferred format is
   a representation fixed-length and single-zone subset of the target resource that can be
   transferred date and time
   specification used by the server over HTTP.  However, Internet Message Format [RFC5322].

     HTTP-date    = IMF-fixdate / obs-date

   An example of the Location field
   value refers to a resource that preferred format is descriptive

     Sun, 06 Nov 1994 08:49:37 GMT    ; IMF-fixdate

   Examples of the target
   resource, such two obsolete formats are

     Sunday, 06-Nov-94 08:49:37 GMT   ; obsolete RFC 850 format
     Sun Nov  6 08:49:37 1994         ; ANSI C's asctime() format

   A recipient that making parses a retrieval request on that other resource
   might result timestamp value in an HTTP header field
   MUST accept all three HTTP-date formats.  When a representation that is useful to recipients without
   implying sender generates a
   header field that it represents contains one or more timestamps defined as HTTP-
   date, the original target resource.  Note that
   answers to sender MUST generate those timestamps in the questions IMF-fixdate
   format.

   An HTTP-date value represents time as an instance of what can be represented, what
   representations are adequate, and what might be a useful description
   are outside Coordinated
   Universal Time (UTC).  The first two formats indicate UTC by the scope of HTTP.

   Except
   three-letter abbreviation for responses to Greenwich Mean Time, "GMT", a HEAD request, the representation
   predecessor of a 303
   response ought to contain a short hypertext note with a hyperlink to the same URI reference provided UTC name; values in the Location header field.

6.4.5.  305 Use Proxy

   The 305 (Use Proxy) status code was defined in a previous version of
   this specification and is now deprecated (Appendix B of [RFC7231]).

6.4.6.  306 (Unused)

   The 306 status code was defined asctime format are assumed
   to be in a previous version of this
   specification, is no longer used, and the code is reserved.

6.4.7.  307 Temporary Redirect

   The 307 (Temporary Redirect) status code indicates UTC.  A sender that the target
   resource resides temporarily under generates HTTP-date values from a different URI and local
   clock ought to use NTP ([RFC5905]) or some similar protocol to
   synchronize its clock to UTC.

   Preferred format:

     IMF-fixdate  = day-name "," SP date1 SP time-of-day SP GMT
     ; fixed length/zone/capitalization subset of the user agent format
     ; see Section 3.3 of [RFC5322]

     day-name     = %x4D.6F.6E ; "Mon", case-sensitive
                  / %x54.75.65 ; "Tue", case-sensitive
                  / %x57.65.64 ; "Wed", case-sensitive
                  / %x54.68.75 ; "Thu", case-sensitive
                  / %x46.72.69 ; "Fri", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.61.74 ; "Sat", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.75.6E ; "Sun", case-sensitive

     date1        = day SP month SP year
                  ; e.g., 02 Jun 1982

     day          = 2DIGIT
     month        = %x4A.61.6E ; "Jan", case-sensitive
                  / %x46.65.62 ; "Feb", case-sensitive
                  / %x4D.61.72 ; "Mar", case-sensitive
                  / %x41.70.72 ; "Apr", case-sensitive
                  / %x4D.61.79 ; "May", case-sensitive
                  / %x4A.75.6E ; "Jun", case-sensitive
                  / %x4A.75.6C ; "Jul", case-sensitive
                  / %x41.75.67 ; "Aug", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.65.70 ; "Sep", case-sensitive
                  / %x4F.63.74 ; "Oct", case-sensitive
                  / %x4E.6F.76 ; "Nov", case-sensitive
                  / %x44.65.63 ; "Dec", case-sensitive
     year         = 4DIGIT

     GMT          = %x47.4D.54 ; "GMT", case-sensitive

     time-of-day  = hour ":" minute ":" second
                  ; 00:00:00 - 23:59:60 (leap second)

     hour         = 2DIGIT
     minute       = 2DIGIT
     second       = 2DIGIT

   Obsolete formats:

     obs-date     = rfc850-date / asctime-date
     rfc850-date  = day-name-l "," SP date2 SP time-of-day SP GMT
     date2        = day "-" month "-" 2DIGIT
                  ; e.g., 02-Jun-82

     day-name-l   = %x4D.6F.6E.64.61.79    ; "Monday", case-sensitive
            / %x54.75.65.73.64.61.79       ; "Tuesday", case-sensitive
            / %x57.65.64.6E.65.73.64.61.79 ; "Wednesday", case-sensitive
            / %x54.68.75.72.73.64.61.79    ; "Thursday", case-sensitive
            / %x46.72.69.64.61.79          ; "Friday", case-sensitive
            / %x53.61.74.75.72.64.61.79    ; "Saturday", case-sensitive
            / %x53.75.6E.64.61.79          ; "Sunday", case-sensitive

     asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
     date3        = month SP ( 2DIGIT / ( SP 1DIGIT ))
                  ; e.g., Jun  2

   HTTP-date is case sensitive.  A sender MUST NOT change the request method if it performs generate additional
   whitespace in an automatic
   redirection to HTTP-date beyond that URI.  Since the redirection can change over time,
   the client ought to continue using specifically included as SP in
   the original effective request URI
   for future requests. grammar.  The server SHOULD generate a Location header field in semantics of day-name, day, month, year, and time-
   of-day are the response
   containing a URI reference same as those defined for the different URI.  The user agent MAY
   use Internet Message Format
   constructs with the Location field corresponding name ([RFC5322], Section 3.3).

   Recipients of a timestamp value for automatic redirection.  The server's
   response payload usually contains in rfc850-date format, which uses a short hypertext note with
   two-digit year, MUST interpret a
   hyperlink timestamp that appears to be more
   than 50 years in the different URI(s).

      Note: This status code is similar to 302 (Found), except that it
      does not allow changing future as representing the request method from POST to GET.  This
      specification defines no equivalent counterpart for 301 (Moved
      Permanently) ([RFC7238], however, defines most recent year in
   the status code 308
      (Permanent Redirect) for this purpose).

6.5.  Client Error 4xx

   The 4xx (Client Error) class of status code indicates past that had the client
   seems to have erred.  Except when responding same last two digits.

   Recipients of timestamp values are encouraged to a HEAD request, be robust in parsing
   timestamps unless otherwise restricted by the
   server SHOULD send field definition.  For
   example, messages are occasionally forwarded over HTTP from a representation containing an explanation non-
   HTTP source that might generate any of the
   error situation, date and whether it is a temporary or permanent
   condition.  These status codes are applicable to any request method.
   User agents SHOULD display any included representation to the user.

6.5.1.  400 Bad Request

   The 400 (Bad Request) status code indicates that time
   specifications defined by the server cannot or
   will not process Internet Message Format.

      Note: HTTP requirements for the request due date/time stamp format apply only
      to something that is perceived their usage within the protocol stream.  Implementations are
      not required to be
   a client error (e.g., malformed request syntax, invalid request
   message framing, or deceptive request routing).

6.5.2.  402 Payment Required

   The 402 (Payment Required) status code is reserved use these formats for future use.

6.5.3.  403 Forbidden user presentation, request
      logging, etc.

10.1.1.2.  Date

   The 403 (Forbidden) status code indicates that "Date" header field represents the server understood date and time at which the request but refuses to authorize it.  A server that wishes to
   make public why
   message was originated, having the request has been forbidden can describe that
   reason in same semantics as the response payload (if any).

   If authentication credentials were provided Origination
   Date Field (orig-date) defined in the request, the
   server considers them insufficient to grant access. Section 3.6.1 of [RFC5322].  The client
   field value is an HTTP-date, as defined in Section 10.1.1.1.

     Date = HTTP-date

   An example is
     Date: Tue, 15 Nov 1994 08:12:31 GMT

   When a Date header field is generated, the sender SHOULD NOT automatically repeat generate its
   field value as the best available approximation of the date and time
   of message generation.  In theory, the request with date ought to represent the same
   credentials.  The client MAY repeat
   moment just before the request with new or different
   credentials.  However, a request might be forbidden for reasons
   unrelated to payload is generated.  In practice, the credentials. date
   can be generated at any time during message origination.

   An origin server that wishes to "hide" the current existence of MUST NOT send a
   forbidden target resource MAY instead respond with Date header field if it does not
   have a status code clock capable of
   404 (Not Found).

6.5.4.  404 Not Found

   The 404 (Not Found) status code indicates that the origin server did
   not find providing a current representation for the target resource or is not
   willing to disclose that one exists.  A 404 status code does not
   indicate whether this lack reasonable approximation of representation is temporary or
   permanent; the 410 (Gone) status code is preferred over 404 if the
   current instance in Coordinated Universal Time.  An origin server knows, presumably through some configurable means, that MAY
   send a Date header field if the condition is likely to be permanent.

   A 404 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by in the method definition 1xx
   (Informational) or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 5xx (Server Error) class of [CACHING]).

6.5.5.  405 Method Not Allowed

   The 405 (Method Not Allowed) status code indicates that the method
   received in the request-line is known by the origin server but not
   supported by the target resource.  The codes.  An
   origin server MUST generate an
   Allow send a Date header field in all other cases.

   A recipient with a 405 response containing clock that receives a list of the target
   resource's currently supported methods.

   A 405 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

6.5.6.  406 Not Acceptable

   The 406 (Not Acceptable) status code indicates that message without a
   Date header field MUST record the target
   resource does not have time it was received and append a current representation that would be
   acceptable
   corresponding Date header field to the message's header section if it
   is cached or forwarded downstream.

   A user agent, according to the proactive negotiation agent MAY send a Date header fields received field in a request, though
   generally will not do so unless it is believed to convey useful
   information to the request (Section 5.3), and server.  For example, custom applications of HTTP
   might convey a Date if the server is unwilling expected to supply a default representation.

   The server SHOULD generate a payload containing a list adjust its
   interpretation of available
   representation characteristics and corresponding resource identifiers
   from which the user or user agent can choose user's request based on differences between the one most
   appropriate.  A
   user agent MAY automatically select the most
   appropriate choice from that list.  However, this specification does
   not define any standard for such automatic selection, as described and server clocks.

10.1.2.  Location

   The "Location" header field is used in
   Section 6.4.1.

6.5.7.  408 Request Timeout some responses to refer to a
   specific resource in relation to the response.  The 408 (Request Timeout) type of
   relationship is defined by the combination of request method and
   status code indicates that semantics.

     Location = URI-reference

   The field value consists of a single URI-reference.  When it has the
   form of a relative reference ([RFC3986], Section 4.2), the final
   value is computed by resolving it against the server did
   not receive a complete effective request message within URI
   ([RFC3986], Section 5).

   For 201 (Created) responses, the time that it was
   prepared Location value refers to wait.  A server SHOULD send the "close" connection option
   (Section 6.1 of [MESSGNG]) in primary
   resource created by the response, since 408 implies that request.  For 3xx (Redirection) responses,
   the server has decided Location value refers to close the connection rather than continue
   waiting. preferred target resource for
   automatically redirecting the request.

   If the client has an outstanding request Location value provided in transit, the
   client MAY repeat that request on a new connection.

6.5.8.  409 Conflict

   The 409 (Conflict) status code indicates that the request could 3xx (Redirection) response does
   not
   be completed due to have a conflict with fragment component, a user agent MUST process the current state
   redirection as if the value inherits the fragment component of the target
   resource.  This code is
   URI reference used in situations where the user might be
   able to resolve generate the conflict and resubmit request target (i.e., the request.  The server
   SHOULD generate
   redirection inherits the original reference's fragment, if any).

   For example, a payload that includes enough information GET request generated for the URI reference
   "http://www.example.org/~tim" might result in a user
   to recognize 303 (See Other)
   response containing the source of header field:

     Location: /People.html#tim

   which suggests that the conflict.

   Conflicts are most likely user agent redirect to occur
   "http://www.example.org/People.html#tim"

   Likewise, a GET request generated for the URI reference
   "http://www.example.org/index.html#larry" might result in a 301
   (Moved Permanently) response containing the header field:

     Location: http://www.example.net/index.html

   which suggests that the user agent redirect to
   "http://www.example.net/index.html#larry", preserving the original
   fragment identifier.

   There are circumstances in which a PUT request. fragment identifier in a Location
   value would not be appropriate.  For example, if versioning were being used and the representation being
   PUT included changes Location header
   field in a 201 (Created) response is supposed to provide a resource URI that conflict with those made by
   an earlier (third-party) request,
   is specific to the origin server might use a 409
   response created resource.

      Note: Some recipients attempt to indicate recover from Location fields that
      are not valid URI references.  This specification does not mandate
      or define such processing, but does allow it can't complete the request.  In this
   case, the response representation would likely contain information
   useful for merging the differences based on the revision history.

6.5.9.  410 Gone sake of
      robustness.

      Note: The 410 (Gone) status code indicates Content-Location header field (Section 6.2.5) differs
      from Location in that access to the target
   resource is no longer available at the origin server and that this
   condition is likely Content-Location refers to be permanent.  If the origin server does not
   know, or has no facility most
      specific resource corresponding to determine, whether or not the condition enclosed representation.
      It is permanent, the status code 404 (Not Found) ought to be used
   instead.

   The 410 therefore possible for a response is primarily intended to assist the task of web
   maintenance by notifying the recipient that contain both the resource is
   intentionally unavailable
      Location and that Content-Location header fields.

10.1.3.  Retry-After

   Servers send the server owners desire that
   remote links "Retry-After" header field to that resource be removed.  Such an event is common
   for limited-time, promotional services and for resources belonging indicate how long the
   user agent ought to
   individuals no longer associated wait before making a follow-up request.  When
   sent with a 503 (Service Unavailable) response, Retry-After indicates
   how long the origin server's site.  It service is not necessary expected to mark all permanently be unavailable resources as
   "gone" or to keep the mark for client.
   When sent with any length of 3xx (Redirection) response, Retry-After indicates
   the minimum time -- that the user agent is left asked to wait before issuing
   the discretion redirected request.

   The value of this field can be either an HTTP-date or a number of
   seconds to delay after the server owner.

   A 410 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 received.

     Retry-After = HTTP-date / delay-seconds

   A delay-seconds value is a non-negative decimal integer, representing
   time in seconds.

     delay-seconds  = 1*DIGIT

   Two examples of [CACHING]).

6.5.10.  411 Length Required

   The 411 (Length Required) status code indicates that its use are

     Retry-After: Fri, 31 Dec 1999 23:59:59 GMT
     Retry-After: 120

   In the server
   refuses to accept latter example, the request without delay is 2 minutes.

10.1.4.  Vary

   The "Vary" header field in a defined Content-Length
   (Section 3.3.2 response describes what parts of [MESSGNG]).  The client MAY repeat a
   request message, aside from the method, Host header field, and
   request if
   it adds target, might influence the origin server's process for
   selecting and representing this response.  The value consists of
   either a valid Content-Length single asterisk ("*") or a list of header field containing the length names (case-
   insensitive).

     Vary = "*" / 1#field-name

   A Vary field value of "*" signals that anything about the message body request
   might play a role in selecting the request message.

6.5.11.  413 Payload Too Large

   The 413 (Payload Too Large) status code indicates that response representation, possibly
   including elements outside the server is
   refusing message syntax (e.g., the client's
   network address).  A recipient will not be able to process determine whether
   this response is appropriate for a later request because without forwarding
   the request payload is larger
   than the server is willing or able to process.  The server MAY close
   the connection to prevent the client from continuing the request.

   If the condition is temporary, the server SHOULD origin server.  A proxy MUST NOT generate a Retry-
   After header Vary
   field to indicate with a "*" value.

   A Vary field value consisting of a comma-separated list of names
   indicates that it is temporary and after what
   time the client MAY try again.

6.5.12.  414 URI Too Long named request header fields, known as the
   selecting header fields, might have a role in selecting the
   representation.  The 414 (URI Too Long) status code potential selecting header fields are not
   limited to those defined by this specification.

   For example, a response that contains

     Vary: accept-encoding, accept-language

   indicates that the origin server is
   refusing to service the request because might have used the request-target
   (Section 5.3 of [MESSGNG]) is longer than request's
   Accept-Encoding and Accept-Language fields (or lack thereof) as
   determining factors while choosing the content for this response.

   An origin server is willing to
   interpret.  This rare condition is only likely might send Vary with a list of fields for two
   purposes:

   1.  To inform cache recipients that they MUST NOT use this response
       to occur when satisfy a client later request unless the later request has improperly converted a POST the same
       values for the listed fields as the original request (Section 4.1
       of [Caching]).  In other words, Vary expands the cache key
       required to match a GET new request with long
   query information, when to the client has descended into a "black hole"
   of redirection (e.g., a redirected URI prefix stored cache entry.

   2.  To inform user agent recipients that points this response is subject to
       content negotiation (Section 8.4) and that a suffix
   of itself) or when different
       representation might be sent in a subsequent request if
       additional parameters are provided in the listed header fields
       (proactive negotiation).

   An origin server is under attack by SHOULD send a client attempting
   to exploit potential security holes.

   A 414 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by Vary header field when its algorithm
   for selecting a representation varies based on aspects of the request
   message other than the method definition and request target, unless the variance
   cannot be crossed or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 of [CACHING]).

6.5.13.  415 Unsupported Media Type

   The 415 (Unsupported Media Type) status code indicates that the origin server has been deliberately
   configured to prevent cache transparency.  For example, there is refusing no
   need to service send the request Authorization field name in Vary because the payload reuse
   across users is in a format not supported constrained by this method on the target resource.
   The format problem field definition (Section 8.5.3).
   Likewise, an origin server might be due to the request's indicated Content-
   Type or Content-Encoding, or as a result use Cache-Control directives
   (Section 5.2 of inspecting the data
   directly.

6.5.14.  417 Expectation Failed

   The 417 (Expectation Failed) status code indicates that [Caching]) to supplant Vary if it considers the
   expectation given in
   variance less significant than the request's Expect performance cost of Vary's impact
   on caching.

10.2.  Validators

   Validator header field fields convey metadata about the selected
   representation (Section 5.1.1) could not be met 6).  In responses to safe requests, validator
   fields describe the selected representation chosen by at least one of the inbound
   servers.

6.5.15.  426 Upgrade Required

   The 426 (Upgrade Required) origin
   server while handling the response.  Note that, depending on the
   status code indicates that semantics, the server
   refuses to perform selected representation for a given
   response is not necessarily the request using same as the current protocol but might
   be willing representation enclosed
   as response payload.

   In a successful response to do so after a state-changing request, validator
   fields describe the client upgrades to new representation that has replaced the prior
   selected representation as a different
   protocol.  The server MUST send result of processing the request.

   For example, an Upgrade ETag header field in a 426 201 (Created) response to indicate
   communicates the required protocol(s) (Section 6.7 of
   [MESSGNG]).

   Example:

     HTTP/1.1 426 Upgrade Required
     Upgrade: HTTP/3.0
     Connection: Upgrade
     Content-Length: 53
     Content-Type: text/plain

     This service requires use entity-tag of the HTTP/3.0 protocol.

6.6.  Server Error 5xx

   The 5xx (Server Error) class of status code indicates newly created resource's
   representation, so that it can be used in later conditional requests
   to prevent the server
   is aware "lost update" problem Section 8.2.

   +-------------------+----------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...  |
   +-------------------+----------------+
   | ETag              | Section 10.2.3 |
   | Last-Modified     | Section 10.2.2 |
   +-------------------+----------------+

   This specification defines two forms of metadata that it are commonly
   used to observe resource state and test for preconditions:
   modification dates (Section 10.2.2) and opaque entity tags
   (Section 10.2.3).  Additional metadata that reflects resource state
   has erred or been defined by various extensions of HTTP, such as Web
   Distributed Authoring and Versioning (WebDAV, [RFC4918]), that are
   beyond the scope of this specification.  A resource metadata value is incapable of performing the
   requested method.  Except when responding
   referred to as a HEAD request, the
   server SHOULD send a representation containing an explanation of the
   error situation, and whether "validator" when it is used within a temporary precondition.

10.2.1.  Weak versus Strong

   Validators come in two flavors: strong or permanent
   condition.  A user agent SHOULD display any included representation weak.  Weak validators are
   easy to the user.  These response codes generate but are applicable far less useful for comparisons.  Strong
   validators are ideal for comparisons but can be very difficult (and
   occasionally impossible) to any request
   method.

6.6.1.  500 Internal Server Error

   The 500 (Internal Server Error) status code indicates generate efficiently.  Rather than impose
   that all forms of resource adhere to the server
   encountered an unexpected condition that prevented it from fulfilling same strength of validator,
   HTTP exposes the request.

6.6.2.  501 Not Implemented

   The 501 (Not Implemented) status code indicates type of validator in use and imposes restrictions on
   when weak validators can be used as preconditions.

   A "strong validator" is representation metadata that the server does
   not support the functionality required changes value
   whenever a change occurs to fulfill the request.  This
   is representation data that would be
   observable in the appropriate payload body of a 200 (OK) response when to GET.

   A strong validator might change for reasons other than a change to
   the server does not recognize representation data, such as when a semantically significant part
   of the
   request method and representation metadata is not capable of supporting changed (e.g., Content-Type), but
   it for any resource.

   A 501 response is cacheable by default; i.e., unless otherwise
   indicated by in the method definition or explicit cache controls (see
   Section 4.2.2 best interests of [CACHING]).

6.6.3.  502 Bad Gateway

   The 502 (Bad Gateway) status code indicates that the server, while
   acting as a gateway or proxy, received an invalid response from an
   inbound origin server it accessed while attempting to fulfill the request.

6.6.4.  503 Service Unavailable

   The 503 (Service Unavailable) status code indicates that only change the server
   value when it is currently unable necessary to handle invalidate the request due to a temporary overload
   or scheduled maintenance, which will likely be alleviated after some
   delay.  The server MAY send stored responses held by
   remote caches and authoring tools.

   Cache entries might persist for arbitrarily long periods, regardless
   of expiration times.  Thus, a Retry-After header field
   (Section 7.1.3) cache might attempt to suggest validate an appropriate amount of time for
   entry using a validator that it obtained in the
   client to wait before retrying distant past.  A
   strong validator is unique across all versions of all representations
   associated with a particular resource over time.  However, there is
   no implication of uniqueness across representations of different
   resources (i.e., the request.

      Note: The existence same strong validator might be in use for
   representations of multiple resources at the 503 status code same time and does not
   imply that those representations are equivalent).

   There are a
      server has to use it when becoming overloaded.  Some servers might
      simply refuse the connection.

6.6.5.  504 Gateway Timeout variety of strong validators used in practice.  The 504 (Gateway Timeout) status code indicates that the server,
   while acting as best
   are based on strict revision control, wherein each change to a gateway or proxy, did not receive
   representation always results in a timely response
   from an upstream server it needed unique node name and revision
   identifier being assigned before the representation is made
   accessible to access in order GET.  A collision-resistant hash function applied to complete
   the
   request.

6.6.6.  505 HTTP Version Not Supported

   The 505 (HTTP Version Not Supported) status code indicates that representation data is also sufficient if the data is available
   prior to the
   server response header fields being sent and the digest does
   not support, or refuses need to support, the major version of
   HTTP be recalculated every time a validation request is
   received.  However, if a resource has distinct representations that was used
   differ only in their metadata, such as might occur with content
   negotiation over media types that happen to share the request message.  The same data
   format, then the origin server needs to incorporate additional
   information in the validator to distinguish those representations.

   In contrast, a "weak validator" is indicating representation metadata that it is unable or unwilling might
   not change for every change to complete the request using representation data.  This
   weakness might be due to limitations in how the same
   major version value is calculated,
   such as clock resolution, an inability to ensure uniqueness for all
   possible representations of the client, as described in Section 2.6 resource, or a desire of
   [MESSGNG], other the resource
   owner to group representations by some self-determined set of
   equivalency rather than with this error message.  The unique sequences of data.  An origin server
   SHOULD
   generate change a representation weak entity-tag whenever it considers prior
   representations to be unacceptable as a substitute for the 505 response that describes why
   that version is not supported and what current
   representation.  In other protocols are supported
   by that server.

7.  Response Header Fields

   The response header fields allow words, a weak entity-tag ought to change
   whenever the origin server wants caches to pass additional
   information about invalidate old responses.

   For example, the response beyond what is placed representation of a weather report that changes in
   content every second, based on dynamic measurements, might be grouped
   into sets of equivalent representations (from the status-
   line.  These header fields give information about origin server's
   perspective) with the server, about
   further access same weak validator in order to the target resource, allow cached
   representations to be valid for a reasonable period of time (perhaps
   adjusted dynamically based on server load or about related resources.

   Although each response header field has weather quality).
   Likewise, a representation's modification time, if defined meaning, in
   general, the precise semantics with only
   one-second resolution, might be further refined by a weak validator if it is possible
   for the
   semantics representation to be modified twice during a single second
   and retrieved between those modifications.

   Likewise, a validator is weak if it is shared by two or more
   representations of a given resource at the request method and/or response status code.

7.1.  Control Data

   Response header fields can supply control data same time, unless those
   representations have identical representation data.  For example, if
   the origin server sends the same validator for a representation with
   a gzip content coding applied as it does for a representation with no
   content coding, then that supplements validator is weak.  However, two
   simultaneous representations might share the
   status code, directs caching, or instructs same strong validator if
   they differ only in the client where to go
   next.

   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...            |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | Age               | Section 5.1 of [CACHING] |
   | Cache-Control     | Section 5.2 of [CACHING] |
   | Expires           | Section 5.3 of [CACHING] |
   | Date              | Section 7.1.1.2          |
   | Location          | Section 7.1.2            |
   | Retry-After       | Section 7.1.3            |
   | Vary              | Section 7.1.4            |
   | Warning           | Section 5.5 of [CACHING] |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+

7.1.1.  Origination Date

7.1.1.1.  Date/Time Formats

   Prior to 1995, there were three representation metadata, such as when two
   different formats commonly used by
   servers to communicate timestamps.  For compatibility with old
   implementations, media types are available for the same representation data.

   Strong validators are usable for all three conditional requests, including
   cache validation, partial content ranges, and "lost update"
   avoidance.  Weak validators are defined here. only usable when the client does not
   require exact equality with previously obtained representation data,
   such as when validating a cache entry or limiting a web traversal to
   recent changes.

10.2.2.  Last-Modified

   The preferred format is "Last-Modified" header field in a fixed-length and single-zone subset of response provides a timestamp
   indicating the date and time
   specification used by at which the Internet Message Format [RFC5322].

     HTTP-date origin server believes the
   selected representation was last modified, as determined at the
   conclusion of handling the request.

     Last-Modified = IMF-fixdate / obs-date HTTP-date

   An example of the preferred format its use is

     Sun, 06

     Last-Modified: Tue, 15 Nov 1994 08:49:37 GMT    ; IMF-fixdate

   Examples of the two obsolete formats are

     Sunday, 06-Nov-94 08:49:37 12:45:26 GMT   ; obsolete RFC 850 format
     Sun Nov  6 08:49:37 1994         ; ANSI C's asctime() format

   A recipient that parses a timestamp value in an HTTP header field
   MUST accept all three HTTP-date formats.  When a sender generates a
   header field that contains one or more timestamps defined as HTTP-
   date, the sender MUST generate those timestamps in the IMF-fixdate
   format.

10.2.2.1.  Generation

   An HTTP-date value represents time as an instance of Coordinated
   Universal Time (UTC).  The first two formats indicate UTC by the
   three-letter abbreviation origin server SHOULD send Last-Modified for Greenwich Mean Time, "GMT", any selected
   representation for which a
   predecessor of the UTC name; values in the asctime format are assumed
   to last modification date can be in UTC.  A sender that generates HTTP-date values from a local
   clock ought to use NTP ([RFC5905]) or some similar protocol to
   synchronize reasonably
   and consistently determined, since its clock to UTC.

   Preferred format:

     IMF-fixdate  = day-name "," SP date1 SP time-of-day SP GMT
     ; fixed length/zone/capitalization subset of the format
     ; see Section 3.3 of [RFC5322]

     day-name     = %x4D.6F.6E ; "Mon", case-sensitive
                  / %x54.75.65 ; "Tue", case-sensitive
                  / %x57.65.64 ; "Wed", case-sensitive
                  / %x54.68.75 ; "Thu", case-sensitive
                  / %x46.72.69 ; "Fri", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.61.74 ; "Sat", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.75.6E ; "Sun", case-sensitive

     date1        = day SP month SP year
                  ; e.g., 02 Jun 1982

     day          = 2DIGIT
     month        = %x4A.61.6E ; "Jan", case-sensitive
                  / %x46.65.62 ; "Feb", case-sensitive
                  / %x4D.61.72 ; "Mar", case-sensitive
                  / %x41.70.72 ; "Apr", case-sensitive
                  / %x4D.61.79 ; "May", case-sensitive
                  / %x4A.75.6E ; "Jun", case-sensitive
                  / %x4A.75.6C ; "Jul", case-sensitive
                  / %x41.75.67 ; "Aug", case-sensitive
                  / %x53.65.70 ; "Sep", case-sensitive
                  / %x4F.63.74 ; "Oct", case-sensitive
                  / %x4E.6F.76 ; "Nov", case-sensitive
                  / %x44.65.63 ; "Dec", case-sensitive
     year         = 4DIGIT

     GMT          = %x47.4D.54 ; "GMT", case-sensitive

     time-of-day  = hour ":" minute ":" second
                  ; 00:00:00 - 23:59:60 (leap second)

     hour         = 2DIGIT
     minute       = 2DIGIT
     second       = 2DIGIT

   Obsolete formats:

     obs-date     = rfc850-date / asctime-date
     rfc850-date  = day-name-l "," SP date2 SP time-of-day SP GMT
     date2        = day "-" month "-" 2DIGIT
                  ; e.g., 02-Jun-82

     day-name-l   = %x4D.6F.6E.64.61.79    ; "Monday", case-sensitive
            / %x54.75.65.73.64.61.79       ; "Tuesday", case-sensitive
            / %x57.65.64.6E.65.73.64.61.79 ; "Wednesday", case-sensitive
            / %x54.68.75.72.73.64.61.79    ; "Thursday", case-sensitive
            / %x46.72.69.64.61.79          ; "Friday", case-sensitive
            / %x53.61.74.75.72.64.61.79    ; "Saturday", case-sensitive
            / %x53.75.6E.64.61.79          ; "Sunday", case-sensitive

     asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
     date3        = month SP ( 2DIGIT / ( SP 1DIGIT ))
                  ; e.g., Jun  2

   HTTP-date is case sensitive.  A sender MUST NOT generate additional
   whitespace use in an HTTP-date beyond that specifically included as SP conditional requests
   and evaluating cache freshness ([Caching]) results in
   the grammar.  The semantics a substantial
   reduction of day-name, day, month, year, HTTP traffic on the Internet and time-
   of-day are can be a significant
   factor in improving service scalability and reliability.

   A representation is typically the same as sum of many parts behind the
   resource interface.  The last-modified time would usually be the most
   recent time that any of those defined parts were changed.  How that value is
   determined for any given resource is an implementation detail beyond
   the Internet Message Format
   constructs with scope of this specification.  What matters to HTTP is how
   recipients of the corresponding name ([RFC5322], Section 3.3).

   Recipients Last-Modified header field can use its value to
   make conditional requests and test the validity of a timestamp locally cached
   responses.

   An origin server SHOULD obtain the Last-Modified value in rfc850-date format, which uses of the
   representation as close as possible to the time that it generates the
   Date field value for its response.  This allows a
   two-digit year, recipient to make
   an accurate assessment of the representation's modification time,
   especially if the representation changes near the time that the
   response is generated.

   An origin server with a clock MUST interpret NOT send a timestamp Last-Modified date that appears to be more
   is later than 50 years in the future as representing server's time of message origination (Date).  If
   the most recent year last modification time is derived from implementation-specific
   metadata that evaluates to some time in the past future, according to the
   origin server's clock, then the origin server MUST replace that had value
   with the same last two digits.

   Recipients of timestamp message origination date.  This prevents a future
   modification date from having an adverse impact on cache validation.

   An origin server without a clock MUST NOT assign Last-Modified values are encouraged
   to be robust in parsing
   timestamps a response unless otherwise restricted by these values were associated with the field definition.  For
   example, messages are occasionally forwarded over HTTP from resource
   by some other system or user with a non-
   HTTP source reliable clock.

10.2.2.2.  Comparison

   A Last-Modified time, when used as a validator in a request, is
   implicitly weak unless it is possible to deduce that might generate any of it is strong,
   using the date and time
   specifications defined following rules:

   o  The validator is being compared by an origin server to the Internet Message Format.

      Note: HTTP requirements actual
      current validator for the date/time stamp format apply only
      to their usage within representation and,

   o  That origin server reliably knows that the protocol stream.  Implementations are associated
      representation did not required to use these formats for user presentation, request
      logging, etc.

7.1.1.2.  Date change twice during the second covered by
      the presented validator.

   or

   o  The "Date" validator is about to be used by a client in an If-Modified-
      Since, If-Unmodified-Since, or If-Range header field represents field, because the date
      client has a cache entry for the associated representation, and time at

   o  That cache entry includes a Date value, which gives the
   message was originated, having time when
      the same semantics as origin server sent the original response, and

   o  The presented Last-Modified time is at least 60 seconds before the Origination
      Date Field (orig-date) defined in Section 3.6.1 of [RFC5322]. value.

   or

   o  The
   field value validator is being compared by an HTTP-date, as defined intermediate cache to the
      validator stored in Section 7.1.1.1.

     Date = HTTP-date

   An example is
     Date: Tue, 15 Nov 1994 08:12:31 GMT

   When its cache entry for the representation, and

   o  That cache entry includes a Date header field is generated, value, which gives the sender SHOULD generate its
   field value as time when
      the best available approximation of origin server sent the date original response, and

   o  The presented Last-Modified time
   of message generation.  In theory, the date ought to represent the
   moment just before the payload is generated.  In practice, the date
   can be generated at any time during message origination.

   An origin server MUST NOT send a least 60 seconds before the
      Date header field value.

   This method relies on the fact that if it does not
   have a clock capable of providing a reasonable approximation of two different responses were
   sent by the
   current instance in Coordinated Universal Time.  An origin server MAY
   send a Date header field if during the response is in same second, but both had the 1xx
   (Informational) or 5xx (Server Error) class
   same Last-Modified time, then at least one of status codes.  An
   origin server MUST send those responses would
   have a Date header field in all other cases.

   A recipient with a clock value equal to its Last-Modified time.  The arbitrary
   60-second limit guards against the possibility that receives a response message without a
   Date header field MUST record the time it was received and append a
   corresponding Date header field to and
   Last-Modified values are generated from different clocks or at
   somewhat different times during the message's header section preparation of the response.  An
   implementation MAY use a value larger than 60 seconds, if it is cached or forwarded downstream.

   A user agent MAY send a Date
   believed that 60 seconds is too short.

10.2.3.  ETag

   The "ETag" header field in a request, though
   generally will not do so unless it is believed to convey useful
   information to response provides the server.  For example, custom applications of HTTP
   might convey a Date if current entity-tag
   for the server is expected to adjust its
   interpretation selected representation, as determined at the conclusion of
   handling the user's request based on differences request.  An entity-tag is an opaque validator for
   differentiating between multiple representations of the
   user agent and server clocks.

7.1.2.  Location

   The "Location" header field is used in some responses to refer same
   resource, regardless of whether those multiple representations are
   due to a
   specific resource state changes over time, content negotiation
   resulting in relation to the response.  The type of
   relationship is defined by multiple representations being valid at the combination of request method and
   status code semantics.

     Location = URI-reference

   The field value same time,
   or both.  An entity-tag consists of an opaque quoted string, possibly
   prefixed by a single URI-reference.  When it has the
   form of weakness indicator.

     ETag       = entity-tag

     entity-tag = [ weak ] opaque-tag
     weak       = %x57.2F ; "W/", case-sensitive
     opaque-tag = DQUOTE *etagc DQUOTE
     etagc      = %x21 / %x23-7E / obs-text
                ; VCHAR except double quotes, plus obs-text

      Note: Previously, opaque-tag was defined to be a relative reference ([RFC3986], Section 4.2), the final
   value is computed by resolving it against the effective request URI
   ([RFC3986], quoted-string
      ([RFC2616], Section 5).

   For 201 (Created) responses, the Location value refers to the primary
   resource created by the request.  For 3xx (Redirection) responses,
   the Location value refers 3.11); thus, some recipients might perform
      backslash unescaping.  Servers therefore ought to the preferred target resource avoid backslash
      characters in entity tags.

   An entity-tag can be more reliable for
   automatically redirecting validation than a modification
   date in situations where it is inconvenient to store modification
   dates, where the request.

   If one-second resolution of HTTP date values is not
   sufficient, or where modification dates are not consistently
   maintained.

   Examples:

     ETag: "xyzzy"
     ETag: W/"xyzzy"
     ETag: ""

   An entity-tag can be either a weak or strong validator, with strong
   being the Location value provided in default.  If an origin server provides an entity-tag for a 3xx (Redirection) response
   representation and the generation of that entity-tag does not have a fragment component, satisfy
   all of the characteristics of a user agent strong validator (Section 10.2.1),
   then the origin server MUST process mark the
   redirection entity-tag as if the weak by prefixing
   its opaque value inherits with "W/" (case-sensitive).

10.2.3.1.  Generation

   The principle behind entity-tags is that only the fragment component of service author
   knows the
   URI reference used implementation of a resource well enough to generate select the request target (i.e., most
   accurate and efficient validation mechanism for that resource, and
   that any such mechanism can be mapped to a simple sequence of octets
   for easy comparison.  Since the
   redirection inherits value is opaque, there is no need for
   the original reference's fragment, if any). client to be aware of how each entity-tag is constructed.

   For example, a GET request generated for the URI reference
   "http://www.example.org/~tim" resource that has implementation-specific versioning
   applied to all changes might result in use an internal revision number, perhaps
   combined with a 303 (See Other)
   response containing the header field:

     Location: /People.html#tim

   which suggests that the user agent redirect variance identifier for content negotiation, to
   "http://www.example.org/People.html#tim"

   Likewise,
   accurately differentiate between representations.  Other
   implementations might use a GET request generated collision-resistant hash of
   representation content, a combination of various file attributes, or
   a modification timestamp that has sub-second resolution.

   An origin server SHOULD send an ETag for any selected representation
   for which detection of changes can be reasonably and consistently
   determined, since the URI reference
   "http://www.example.org/index.html#larry" might entity-tag's use in conditional requests and
   evaluating cache freshness ([Caching]) can result in a 301
   (Moved Permanently) response containing the header field:

     Location: http://www.example.net/index.html

   which suggests that substantial
   reduction of HTTP network traffic and can be a significant factor in
   improving service scalability and reliability.

10.2.3.2.  Comparison

   There are two entity-tag comparison functions, depending on whether
   or not the user agent redirect to
   "http://www.example.net/index.html#larry", preserving comparison context allows the original
   fragment identifier.

   There use of weak validators:

   o  Strong comparison: two entity-tags are equivalent if both are circumstances in which a fragment identifier in a Location
   value would not be appropriate.  For example,
      weak and their opaque-tags match character-by-character.

   o  Weak comparison: two entity-tags are equivalent if their opaque-
      tags match character-by-character, regardless of either or both
      being tagged as "weak".

   The example below shows the Location header
   field in results for a 201 (Created) response is supposed to provide set of entity-tag pairs and
   both the weak and strong comparison function results:

   +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+
   | ETag 1 | ETag 2 | Strong Comparison | Weak Comparison |
   +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+
   | W/"1"  | W/"1"  | no match          | match           |
   | W/"1"  | W/"2"  | no match          | no match        |
   | W/"1"  | "1"    | no match          | match           |
   | "1"    | "1"    | match             | match           |
   +--------+--------+-------------------+-----------------+

10.2.3.3.  Example: Entity-Tags Varying on Content-Negotiated Resources

   Consider a URI resource that is specific subject to content negotiation
   (Section 6.4), and where the created resource.

      Note: Some recipients attempt representations sent in response to recover from Location fields that
      are a
   GET request vary based on the Accept-Encoding request header field
   (Section 8.4.4):

   >> Request:

     GET /index HTTP/1.1
     Host: www.example.com
     Accept-Encoding: gzip

   In this case, the response might or might not valid URI references.  This specification use the gzip content
   coding.  If it does not mandate
      or define such processing, but not, the response might look like:

   >> Response:

     HTTP/1.1 200 OK
     Date: Fri, 26 Mar 2010 00:05:00 GMT
     ETag: "123-a"
     Content-Length: 70
     Vary: Accept-Encoding
     Content-Type: text/plain

     Hello World!
     Hello World!
     Hello World!
     Hello World!
     Hello World!

   An alternative representation that does allow it use gzip content coding would
   be:

   >> Response:

     HTTP/1.1 200 OK
     Date: Fri, 26 Mar 2010 00:05:00 GMT
     ETag: "123-b"
     Content-Length: 43
     Vary: Accept-Encoding
     Content-Type: text/plain
     Content-Encoding: gzip

     ...binary data...

      Note: Content codings are a property of the representation data,
      so a strong entity-tag for a content-encoded representation has to
      be distinct from the sake entity tag of
      robustness.

      Note: The Content-Location header field an unencoded representation to
      prevent potential conflicts during cache updates and range
      requests.  In contrast, transfer codings (Section 3.1.4.2) differs
      from Location 7 of
      [Messaging]) apply only during message transfer and do not result
      in that the Content-Location refers distinct entity-tags.

10.2.4.  When to the most
      specific resource corresponding Use Entity-Tags and Last-Modified Dates

   In 200 (OK) responses to the enclosed representation.
      It GET or HEAD, an origin server:

   o  SHOULD send an entity-tag validator unless it is therefore possible for a response not feasible to contain both the
      Location and Content-Location header fields.

7.1.3.  Retry-After

   Servers
      generate one.

   o  MAY send the "Retry-After" header field to indicate how long the
   user agent ought to wait before making a follow-up request.  When
   sent with weak entity-tag instead of a 503 (Service Unavailable) response, Retry-After indicates
   how long strong entity-tag, if
      performance considerations support the service use of weak entity-tags, or
      if it is expected to be unavailable unfeasible to the client.
   When sent with any 3xx (Redirection) response, Retry-After indicates
   the minimum time that the user agent send a strong entity-tag.

   o  SHOULD send a Last-Modified value if it is asked feasible to wait before issuing send one.

   In other words, the redirected request.

   The value of this field can be either preferred behavior for an HTTP-date or a number of
   seconds to delay after the response origin server is received.

     Retry-After = HTTP-date / delay-seconds

   A delay-seconds to
   send both a strong entity-tag and a Last-Modified value is in successful
   responses to a non-negative decimal integer, representing
   time retrieval request.

   A client:

   o  MUST send that entity-tag in seconds.

     delay-seconds  = 1*DIGIT

   Two examples of its use are

     Retry-After: Fri, 31 Dec 1999 23:59:59 GMT
     Retry-After: 120

   In any cache validation request (using
      If-Match or If-None-Match) if an entity-tag has been provided by
      the latter example, origin server.

   o  SHOULD send the delay is 2 minutes.

7.1.4.  Vary

   The "Vary" header field Last-Modified value in non-subrange cache
      validation requests (using If-Modified-Since) if only a response describes what parts of a
   request message, aside from the method, Host header field, and
   request target, might influence Last-
      Modified value has been provided by the origin server's process for
   selecting and representing this response.  The server.

   o  MAY send the Last-Modified value consists of
   either a single asterisk ("*") or in subrange cache validation
      requests (using If-Unmodified-Since) if only a list of header field names (case-
   insensitive).

     Vary = "*" / 1#field-name

   A Vary field Last-Modified value of "*" signals that anything about the request
   might play
      has been provided by an HTTP/1.0 origin server.  The user agent
      SHOULD provide a role way to disable this, in selecting the response representation, possibly
   including elements outside the message syntax (e.g., case of difficulty.

   o  SHOULD send both validators in cache validation requests if both
      an entity-tag and a Last-Modified value have been provided by the client's
   network address).  A recipient will not be able
      origin server.  This allows both HTTP/1.0 and HTTP/1.1 caches to determine whether
   this response is appropriate
      respond appropriately.

10.3.  Authentication Challenges

   Authentication challenges indicate what mechanisms are available for a later request without forwarding
   the request client to provide authentication credentials in future requests.

   +--------------------+----------------+
   | Header Field Name  | Defined in...  |
   +--------------------+----------------+
   | WWW-Authenticate   | Section 10.3.1 |
   | Proxy-Authenticate | Section 10.3.2 |
   +--------------------+----------------+

10.3.1.  WWW-Authenticate

   The "WWW-Authenticate" header field indicates the authentication
   scheme(s) and parameters applicable to the origin server. target resource.

     WWW-Authenticate = 1#challenge

   A proxy server generating a 401 (Unauthorized) response MUST NOT generate send a Vary WWW-
   Authenticate header field with a "*" value. containing at least one challenge.  A Vary field value consisting of
   server MAY generate a comma-separated list of names
   indicates that the named request header fields, known as the
   selecting WWW-Authenticate header fields, might have a role field in selecting the
   representation.  The potential selecting header fields are not
   limited other response
   messages to those defined by this specification.

   For example, indicate that supplying credentials (or different
   credentials) might affect the response.

   A proxy forwarding a response MUST NOT modify any WWW-Authenticate
   fields in that contains

     Vary: accept-encoding, accept-language

   indicates that response.

   User agents are advised to take special care in parsing the origin server field
   value, as it might have used the request's
   Accept-Encoding contain more than one challenge, and Accept-Language fields (or lack thereof) as
   determining factors while choosing each
   challenge can contain a comma-separated list of authentication
   parameters.  Furthermore, the content header field itself can occur multiple
   times.

   For instance:

     WWW-Authenticate: Newauth realm="apps", type=1,
                       title="Login to \"apps\"", Basic realm="simple"

   This header field contains two challenges; one for this response.

   An origin server might send Vary the "Newauth"
   scheme with a list realm value of fields for "apps", and two
   purposes:

   1.  To inform cache recipients that they MUST NOT use this response
       to satisfy a later request unless the later request has the same
       values additional parameters
   "type" and "title", and another one for the listed fields as the original request (Section 4.1 "Basic" scheme with a
   realm value of [CACHING]).  In other words, Vary expands "simple".

      Note: The challenge grammar production uses the cache key
       required to match list syntax as
      well.  Therefore, a new request sequence of comma, whitespace, and comma can
      be considered either as applying to the stored cache entry.

   2.  To inform user agent recipients that this response is subject preceding challenge, or to
       content negotiation (Section 5.3) and that a different
       representation might
      be sent in a subsequent request if
       additional parameters are provided an empty entry in the listed list of challenges.  In practice, this
      ambiguity does not affect the semantics of the header fields
       (proactive negotiation).

   An origin server SHOULD send a Vary field value
      and thus is harmless.

10.3.2.  Proxy-Authenticate

   The "Proxy-Authenticate" header field when its algorithm
   for selecting a representation varies based on aspects consists of at least one
   challenge that indicates the request
   message other than the method authentication scheme(s) and request target, unless the variance
   cannot be crossed or the origin server has been deliberately
   configured to prevent cache transparency.  For example, there is no
   need parameters
   applicable to send the Authorization proxy for this effective request URI (Section 5.3).
   A proxy MUST send at least one Proxy-Authenticate header field name in Vary because reuse
   across users is constrained by the field definition (Section 4.2 of
   [AUTHFRM]).  Likewise, an origin server might use Cache-Control
   directives (Section 5.2 of [CACHING]) to supplant Vary if
   each 407 (Proxy Authentication Required) response that it
   considers the variance less significant than generates.

     Proxy-Authenticate = 1#challenge

   Unlike WWW-Authenticate, the performance cost of
   Vary's impact on caching.

7.2.  Validator Header Fields

   Validator Proxy-Authenticate header fields convey metadata about the selected
   representation (Section 3).  In responses field applies
   only to safe requests, validator
   fields describe the selected representation chosen by the origin
   server while handling the response.  Note that, depending next outbound client on the
   status code semantics, the selected representation for a given response chain.  This is not necessarily the same as
   because only the representation enclosed
   as response payload.

   In a successful response to client that chose a state-changing request, validator
   fields describe given proxy is likely to have
   the new representation that has replaced credentials necessary for authentication.  However, when multiple
   proxies are used within the prior
   selected representation same administrative domain, such as
   office and regional caching proxies within a result of processing large corporate network,
   it is common for credentials to be generated by the request.

   For example, an ETag header field user agent and
   passed through the hierarchy until consumed.  Hence, in such a 201 (Created) response
   communicates the entity-tag of
   configuration, it will appear as if Proxy-Authenticate is being
   forwarded because each proxy will send the newly created resource's
   representation, so same challenge set.

   Note that it can be used in later conditional requests
   to prevent the "lost update" problem [CONDTNL].

   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...            |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   | ETag              | Section 2.3 of [CONDTNL] |
   | Last-Modified     | Section 2.2 of [CONDTNL] |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+

7.3.  Authentication Challenges

   Authentication challenges indicate what mechanisms are available parsing considerations for
   the client to provide authentication credentials in future requests.

   +--------------------+--------------------------+
   | Header Field Name  | Defined in...            |
   +--------------------+--------------------------+
   | WWW-Authenticate   | Section 4.1 of [AUTHFRM] |
   | Proxy-Authenticate | apply to
   this header field as well; see Section 4.3 of [AUTHFRM] |
   +--------------------+--------------------------+

7.4. 10.3.1 for details.

10.4.  Response Context

   The remaining response header fields provide more information about
   the target resource for potential use in later requests.

   +-------------------+--------------------------+

   +-------------------+----------------+
   | Header Field Name | Defined in...  |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+
   +-------------------+----------------+
   | Accept-Ranges     | Section 2.3 of [RANGERQ] 10.4.1 |
   | Allow             | Section 7.4.1 10.4.2 |
   | Server            | Section 7.4.2 10.4.3 |
   +-------------------+--------------------------+

7.4.1.
   +-------------------+----------------+

10.4.1.  Accept-Ranges

   The "Accept-Ranges" header field allows a server to indicate that it
   supports range requests for the target resource.

     Accept-Ranges     = acceptable-ranges
     acceptable-ranges = 1#range-unit / "none"

   An origin server that supports byte-range requests for a given target
   resource MAY send

     Accept-Ranges: bytes

   to indicate what range units are supported.  A client MAY generate
   range requests without having received this header field for the
   resource involved.  Range units are defined in Section 6.1.4.

   A server that does not support any kind of range request for the
   target resource MAY send

     Accept-Ranges: none

   to advise the client not to attempt a range request.

10.4.2.  Allow

   The "Allow" header field lists the set of methods advertised as
   supported by the target resource.  The purpose of this field is
   strictly to inform the recipient of valid request methods associated
   with the resource.

     Allow = #method

   Example of use:

     Allow: GET, HEAD, PUT

   The actual set of allowed methods is defined by the origin server at
   the time of each request.  An origin server MUST generate an Allow
   field in a 405 (Method Not Allowed) response and MAY do so in any
   other response.  An empty Allow field value indicates that the
   resource allows no methods, which might occur in a 405 response if
   the resource has been temporarily disabled by configuration.

   A proxy MUST NOT modify the Allow header field -- it does not need to
   understand all of the indicated methods in order to handle them
   according to the generic message handling rules.

7.4.2.

10.4.3.  Server

   The "Server" header field contains information about the software
   used by the origin server to handle the request, which is often used
   by clients to help identify the scope of reported interoperability
   problems, to work around or tailor requests to avoid particular
   server limitations, and for analytics regarding server or operating
   system use.  An origin server MAY generate a Server field in its
   responses.

     Server = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

   The Server field-value consists of one or more product identifiers,
   each followed by zero or more comments (Section 3.2 5 of [MESSGNG]), [Messaging]),
   which together identify the origin server software and its
   significant subproducts.  By convention, the product identifiers are
   listed in decreasing order of their significance for identifying the
   origin server software.  Each product identifier consists of a name
   and optional version, as defined in Section 5.5.3. 8.6.3.

   Example:

     Server: CERN/3.0 libwww/2.17

   An origin server SHOULD NOT generate a Server field containing
   needlessly fine-grained detail and SHOULD limit the addition of
   subproducts by third parties.  Overly long and detailed Server field
   values increase response latency and potentially reveal internal
   implementation details that might make it (slightly) easier for
   attackers to find and exploit known security holes.

8.  IANA Considerations

8.1.  Method Registry

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method Registry" defines the
   namespace for the request method token (Section 4).  The method
   registry has been created and is now maintained at
   <http://www.iana.org/assignments/http-methods>.

8.1.1.  Procedure

   HTTP method registrations MUST include the following fields:

   o  Method Name (see Section 4)

   o  Safe ("yes" or "no", see Section 4.2.1)

   o  Idempotent ("yes" or "no", see Section 4.2.2)

   o  Pointer to specification text

   Values to be added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

8.1.2.  Considerations for New Methods

   Standardized methods are generic; that is, they are potentially
   applicable to any resource, not just one particular media type, kind
   of resource, or application.  As such, it is preferred that new
   methods be registered in a document that isn't specific to a single
   application or data format, since orthogonal technologies deserve
   orthogonal specification.

   Since message parsing (Section 3.3 of [MESSGNG]) needs to be
   independent of method semantics (aside from responses to HEAD),
   definitions of new methods cannot change the parsing algorithm or
   prohibit the presence of a message body on either the request or the
   response message.  Definitions of new methods can specify that only a
   zero-length message body is allowed by requiring a Content-Length
   header field with a value of "0".

   A new method definition needs to indicate whether detailed Server field
   values increase response latency and potentially reveal internal
   implementation details that might make it is safe
   (Section 4.2.1), idempotent (Section 4.2.2), cacheable
   (Section 4.2.3), what semantics are (slightly) easier for
   attackers to find and exploit known security holes.

11.  ABNF List Extension: #rule

   A #rule extension to be associated with the payload
   body if any ABNF rules of [RFC5234] is present used to improve
   readability in the request and what refinements the method
   makes to definitions of some header field or status code semantics.  If the new method values.

   A construct "#" is
   cacheable, its definition ought defined, similar to describe how, "*", for defining comma-
   delimited lists of elements.  The full form is "<n>#<m>element"
   indicating at least <n> and under what
   conditions, a cache can store at most <m> elements, each separated by a response
   single comma (",") and use it to satisfy optional whitespace (OWS).

   In any production that uses the list construct, a
   subsequent request.  The new method ought to describe whether it can
   be made conditional (Section 5.2) and, if so, how sender MUST NOT
   generate empty list elements.  In other words, a server responds
   when the condition is false.  Likewise, if sender MUST generate
   lists that satisfy the new method might have
   some use following syntax:

     1#element => element *( OWS "," OWS element )

   and:

     #element => [ 1#element ]

   and for partial response semantics ([RANGERQ]), it ought to
   document this, too.

      Note: Avoid defining n >= 1 and m > 1:

     <n>#<m>element => element <n-1>*<m-1>( OWS "," OWS element )

   For compatibility with legacy list rules, a method name recipient MUST parse and
   ignore a reasonable number of empty list elements: enough to handle
   common mistakes by senders that starts with "M-", since merge values, but not so much that prefix might
   they could be misinterpreted used as having a denial-of-service mechanism.  In other words,
   a recipient MUST accept lists that satisfy the semantics
      assigned following syntax:

     #element => [ ( "," / element ) *( OWS "," [ OWS element ] ) ]

     1#element => *( "," OWS ) element *( OWS "," [ OWS element ] )

   Empty elements do not contribute to it by [RFC2774].

8.1.3.  Registrations

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method Registry" has been
   populated with the registrations below:

   +---------+------+------------+----------------+
   | Method  | Safe | Idempotent | Reference      |
   +---------+------+------------+----------------+
   | CONNECT | no   | no         | Section 4.3.6  |
   | DELETE  | no   | yes        | Section 4.3.5  |
   | GET     | yes  | yes        | Section 4.3.1  |
   | HEAD    | yes  | yes        | Section 4.3.2  |
   | OPTIONS | yes  | yes        | Section 4.3.7  |
   | POST    | no   | no         | Section 4.3.3  |
   | PUT     | no   | yes        | Section 4.3.4  |
   | TRACE   | yes  | yes        | count of elements present.
   For example, given these ABNF productions:

     example-list      = 1#example-list-elmt
     example-list-elmt = token ; see Section 4.3.8  |
   +---------+------+------------+----------------+

8.2.  Status Code Registry

   The "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status Code Registry" defines 4.2.3

   Then the namespace following are valid values for example-list (not including
   the response status-code token (Section 6).  The
   status code registry is maintained at
   <http://www.iana.org/assignments/http-status-codes>.

   This section replaces the registration procedure double quotes, which are present for HTTP Status
   Codes previously defined in Section 7.1 of [RFC2817].

8.2.1.  Procedure

   A registration MUST include delimitation only):

     "foo,bar"
     "foo ,bar,"
     "foo , ,bar,charlie   "

   In contrast, the following fields:

   o  Status Code (3 digits)

   o  Short Description

   o  Pointer to specification text
   Values to values would be added to invalid, since at least
   one non-empty element is required by the HTTP status code namespace require IETF
   Review (see [RFC5226], Section 4.1).

8.2.2. example-list production:

     ""
     ","
     ",   ,"

   Appendix A shows the collected ABNF for recipients after the list
   constructs have been expanded.

12.  Security Considerations for New Status Codes

   When it

   This section is necessary meant to express inform developers, information providers,
   and users of known security concerns relevant to HTTP semantics and
   its use for a response that are not
   defined by current status codes, a new status code can be registered.
   Status codes are generic; they are potentially applicable transferring information over the Internet.
   Considerations related to any
   resource, not just one particular media type, kind message syntax, parsing, and routing are
   discussed in Section 11 of resource, or
   application [Messaging].

   The list of HTTP.  As such, it considerations below is preferred that new status codes
   be registered in a document that isn't specific not exhaustive.  Most security
   concerns related to a single
   application.

   New status codes HTTP semantics are required to fall under one about securing server-side
   applications (code behind the HTTP interface), securing user agent
   processing of payloads received via HTTP, or secure use of the categories
   defined
   Internet in Section 6.  To allow existing parsers general, rather than security of the protocol.  Various
   organizations maintain topical information and links to process current
   research on Web application security (e.g., [OWASP]).

12.1.  Establishing Authority

   HTTP relies on the
   response message, new status codes cannot disallow a payload,
   although they can mandate notion of an authoritative response: a zero-length payload body.

   Proposals for new status codes response
   that are not yet widely deployed ought has been determined by (or at the direction of) the authority
   identified within the target URI to avoid allocating a specific number for be the code until there is
   clear consensus most appropriate response
   for that it will be registered; instead, early drafts can
   use a notation such as "4NN", or "3N0" .. "3N9", to indicate request given the
   class state of the proposed status code(s) without consuming a number
   prematurely.

   The definition target resource at the time
   of response message origination.  Providing a new status code ought response from a non-
   authoritative source, such as a shared cache, is often useful to
   improve performance and availability, but only to explain the request
   conditions extent that would cause a the
   source can be trusted or the distrusted response containing that status code
   (e.g., combinations of request header fields and/or method(s)) along
   with any dependencies can be safely used.

   Unfortunately, establishing authority can be difficult.  For example,
   phishing is an attack on response header fields (e.g., what fields
   are required, what fields the user's perception of authority, where
   that perception can modify be misled by presenting similar branding in
   hypertext, possibly aided by userinfo obfuscating the semantics, and what header
   field semantics are further refined when used with authority
   component (see Section 2.5.1).  User agents can reduce the new status
   code).

   The definition impact of
   phishing attacks by enabling users to easily inspect a new status code ought target URI
   prior to specify whether or making an action, by prominently distinguishing (or
   rejecting) userinfo when present, and by not
   it is cacheable.  Note that all status codes can be cached if sending stored
   credentials and cookies when the
   response they occur referring document is from an
   unknown or untrusted source.

   When a registered name is used in has explicit freshness information; however,
   status codes that are defined as being cacheable are allowed the authority component, the "http"
   URI scheme (Section 2.5.1) relies on the user's local name resolution
   service to be
   cached without explicit freshness information. determine where it can find authoritative responses.  This
   means that any attack on a user's network host table, cached names,
   or name resolution libraries becomes an avenue for attack on
   establishing authority.  Likewise, the
   definition user's choice of a status code can place constraints upon cache
   behavior.  See [CACHING] server for more information.

   Finally,
   Domain Name Service (DNS), and the definition hierarchy of a new status code ought to indicate
   whether servers from which it
   obtains resolution results, could impact the payload has any implied association with authenticity of address
   mappings; DNS Security Extensions (DNSSEC, [RFC4033]) are one way to
   improve authenticity.

   Furthermore, after an identified
   resource (Section 3.1.4.1).

8.2.3.  Registrations IP address is obtained, establishing authority
   for an "http" URI is vulnerable to attacks on Internet Protocol
   routing.

   The status code registry has been updated with "https" scheme (Section 2.5.2) is intended to prevent (or at
   least reveal) many of these potential attacks on establishing
   authority, provided that the registrations
   below:

   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+
   | Value | Description                   | Reference       |
   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+
   | 100   | Continue                      | Section 6.2.1   |
   | 101   | Switching Protocols           | Section 6.2.2   |
   | 200   | OK                            | Section 6.3.1   |
   | 201   | Created                       | Section 6.3.2   |
   | 202   | Accepted                      | Section 6.3.3   |
   | 203   | Non-Authoritative Information | Section 6.3.4   |
   | 204   | No Content                    | Section 6.3.5   |
   | 205   | Reset Content                 | Section 6.3.6   |
   | 300   | Multiple Choices              | Section 6.4.1   |
   | 301   | Moved Permanently             | Section 6.4.2   |
   | 302   | Found                         | Section 6.4.3   |
   | 303   | See Other                     | Section 6.4.4   |
   | 305   | Use Proxy                     | Section 6.4.5   |
   | 306   | (Unused)                      | Section 6.4.6   |
   | 307   | Temporary Redirect            | Section 6.4.7   |
   | 400   | Bad Request                   | Section 6.5.1   |
   | 402   | Payment Required              | Section 6.5.2   |
   | 403   | Forbidden                     | Section 6.5.3   |
   | 404   | Not Found                     | Section 6.5.4   |
   | 405   | Method Not Allowed            | Section 6.5.5   |
   | 406   | Not Acceptable                | Section 6.5.6   |
   | 408   | Request Timeout               | Section 6.5.7   |
   | 409   | Conflict                      | Section 6.5.8   |
   | 410   | Gone                          | Section 6.5.9   |
   | 411   | Length Required               | Section 6.5.10  |
   | 413   | Payload Too Large             | Section 6.5.11  |
   | 414   | URI Too Long                  | Section 6.5.12  |
   | 415   | Unsupported Media Type        | Section 6.5.13  |
   | 417   | Expectation Failed            | Section 6.5.14  |
   | 426   | Upgrade Required              | Section 6.5.15  |
   | 500   | Internal Server Error         | Section 6.6.1   |
   | 501   | Not Implemented               | Section 6.6.2   |
   | 502   | Bad Gateway                   | Section 6.6.3   |
   | 503   | Service Unavailable           | Section 6.6.4   |
   | 504   | Gateway Timeout               | Section 6.6.5   |
   | 505   | HTTP Version Not Supported    | Section 6.6.6   |
   +-------+-------------------------------+-----------------+

8.3.  Header Field Registry negotiated TLS connection is secured and
   the client properly verifies that the communicating server's identity
   matches the target URI's authority component (see [RFC2818]).
   Correctly implementing such verification can be difficult (see
   [Georgiev]).

12.2.  Risks of Intermediaries

   By their very nature, HTTP header fields intermediaries are registered within the "Message Headers"
   registry located at <http://www.iana.org/assignments/message-
   headers>, as defined by [BCP90].

8.3.1.  Considerations men-in-the-middle and,
   thus, represent an opportunity for New Header Fields

   Header fields are key:value pairs that man-in-the-middle attacks.
   Compromise of the systems on which the intermediaries run can result
   in serious security and privacy problems.  Intermediaries might have
   access to security-related information, personal information about
   individual users and organizations, and proprietary information
   belonging to users and content providers.  A compromised
   intermediary, or an intermediary implemented or configured without
   regard to security and privacy considerations, might be used to communicate
   data about the message, its payload, the target resource, or in the
   connection (i.e., control data).  See Section 3.2
   commission of [MESSGNG] for a
   general definition wide range of header field syntax in HTTP messages.

   The requirements for header field names potential attacks.

   Intermediaries that contain a shared cache are defined especially vulnerable
   to cache poisoning attacks, as described in [BCP90].

   Authors Section 7 of specifications defining new fields are advised [Caching].

   Implementers need to keep consider the
   name as short as practical privacy and not to prefix security implications
   of their design and coding decisions, and of the name with "X-"
   unless configuration
   options they provide to operators (especially the header field will never default
   configuration).

   Users need to be used aware that intermediaries are no more trustworthy
   than the people who run them; HTTP itself cannot solve this problem.

12.3.  Attacks Based on File and Path Names

   Origin servers frequently make use of their local file system to
   manage the Internet.  (The
   "X-" prefix idiom has been extensively misused in practice; it was
   intended mapping from effective request URI to only be used as a mechanism for avoiding name collisions
   inside proprietary software resource
   representations.  Most file systems are not designed to protect
   against malicious file or intranet processing, since the prefix
   would ensure that private path names.  Therefore, an origin server
   needs to avoid accessing names never collide with a newly registered
   Internet name; see [BCP178] for further information).

   New header field values typically that have their syntax defined using
   ABNF ([RFC5234]), using the extension defined in Section 7 of
   [MESSGNG] as necessary, and are usually constrained a special significance to
   the range of
   US-ASCII characters.  Header fields needing a greater range of
   characters can system when mapping the request target to files, folders, or
   directories.

   For example, UNIX, Microsoft Windows, and other operating systems use an encoding such
   ".." as a path component to indicate a directory level above the one defined in [RFC5987].

   Leading
   current one, and trailing whitespace in raw field values is removed upon
   field parsing (Section 3.2.4 of [MESSGNG]).  Field definitions where
   leading they use specially named paths or trailing whitespace in values is significant will file names to send
   data to system devices.  Similar naming conventions might exist
   within other types of storage systems.  Likewise, local storage
   systems have an annoying tendency to
   use a container syntax prefer user-friendliness over
   security when handling invalid or unexpected characters,
   recomposition of decomposed characters, and case-normalization of
   case-insensitive names.

   Attacks based on such as quoted-string (Section 3.2.6 special names tend to focus on either denial-
   of-service (e.g., telling the server to read from a COM port) or
   disclosure of
   [MESSGNG]).

   Because commas (",") configuration and source files that are used as a generic delimiter between field-
   values, they need not meant to be treated with care if they are allowed
   served.

12.4.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection

   Origin servers often use parameters within the URI as a means of
   identifying system services, selecting database entries, or choosing
   a data source.  However, data received in a request cannot be
   trusted.  An attacker could construct any of the
   field-value.  Typically, components request data
   elements (method, request-target, header fields, or body) to contain
   data that might contain be misinterpreted as a comma are
   protected with double-quotes using the quoted-string ABNF production. command, code, or query when
   passed through a command invocation, language interpreter, or
   database interface.

   For example, SQL injection is a textual date and a URI (either common attack wherein additional
   query language is inserted within some part of which might contain
   a comma) could be safely carried in field-values like these:

     Example-URI-Field: "http://example.com/a.html,foo",
                        "http://without-a-comma.example.com/"
     Example-Date-Field: "Sat, 04 May 1996", "Wed, 14 Sep 2005"

   Note that double-quote delimiters almost always are used with the
   quoted-string production; using a different syntax inside double-
   quotes will likely cause unnecessary confusion.

   Many request-target or
   header fields use (e.g., Host, Referer, etc.).  If the received data is
   used directly within a format including (case-insensitively) named
   parameters (for instance, Content-Type, defined in Section 3.1.1.5).
   Allowing both unquoted (token) and quoted (quoted-string) syntax for SELECT statement, the parameter value enables recipients query language might be
   interpreted as a database command instead of a simple string value.
   This type of implementation vulnerability is extremely common, in
   spite of being easy to prevent.

   In general, resource implementations ought to avoid use existing parser
   components.  When allowing both forms, the meaning of a parameter
   value request
   data in contexts that are processed or interpreted as instructions.
   Parameters ought to be independent compared to fixed strings and acted upon as a
   result of the syntax used that comparison, rather than passed through an interface
   that is not prepared for untrusted data.  Received data that isn't
   based on fixed parameters ought to be carefully filtered or encoded
   to avoid being misinterpreted.

   Similar considerations apply to request data when it (for an
   example, see the notes is stored and
   later processed, such as within log files, monitoring tools, or when
   included within a data format that allows embedded scripts.

12.5.  Attacks via Protocol Element Length

   Because HTTP uses mostly textual, character-delimited fields, parsers
   are often vulnerable to attacks based on parameter handling sending very long (or very
   slow) streams of data, particularly where an implementation is
   expecting a protocol element with no predefined length (Section 3.3).

   To promote interoperability, specific recommendations are made for media types in
   Section 3.1.1.1).

   Authors
   minimum size limits on request-line (Section 3 of specifications defining new [Messaging]) and
   header fields (Section 5 of [Messaging]).  These are advised minimum
   recommendations, chosen to
   consider documenting:

   o  Whether the field is a single value or whether it can be a list
      (delimited supportable even by commas; see Section 3.2 of [MESSGNG]).

      If implementations
   with limited resources; it does not use the list syntax, document how to treat messages
      where the field occurs multiple times (a sensible default would be
      to ignore the field, but this might not always be the right
      choice).

      Note is expected that intermediaries and software libraries might combine
      multiple header field instances into a single one, despite the
      field's definition not allowing the list syntax. most implementations will
   choose substantially higher limits.

   A robust format
      enables recipients to discover these situations (good example:
      "Content-Type", as the comma server can only appear inside quoted
      strings; bad example: "Location", as reject a comma can occur inside message that has a
      URI).

   o  Under what conditions the header field can be used; e.g., only in
      responses request-target that is too
   long (Section 9.5.15) or requests, in all messages, only on responses to a
      particular request method, etc.

   o  Whether the field should be stored by origin servers payload that
      understand it upon a PUT request.

   o  Whether the field semantics are further refined is too large
   (Section 9.5.14).  Additional status codes related to capacity limits
   have been defined by extensions to HTTP [RFC6585].

   Recipients ought to carefully limit the context,
      such as by existing extent to which they process
   other protocol elements, including (but not limited to) request methods or
   methods, response status codes.

   o  Whether it is appropriate phrases, header field-names, numeric values,
   and body chunks.  Failure to list the field-name limit such processing can result in the Connection
      header field (i.e., if the header field is
   buffer overflows, arithmetic overflows, or increased vulnerability to be hop-by-hop; see
      Section 6.1
   denial-of-service attacks.

12.6.  Disclosure of [MESSGNG]).

   o  Under what conditions intermediaries Personal Information

   Clients are allowed often privy to insert,
      delete, or modify large amounts of personal information,
   including both information provided by the field's value.

   o  Whether it is appropriate user to list the field-name in a Vary
      response header field interact with
   resources (e.g., when the request header field is used
      by an origin server's content selection algorithm; see
      Section 7.1.4).

   o  Whether user's name, location, mail address, passwords,
   encryption keys, etc.) and information about the header field user's browsing
   activity over time (e.g., history, bookmarks, etc.).  Implementations
   need to prevent unintentional disclosure of personal information.

12.7.  Privacy of Server Log Information

   A server is useful or allowable in trailers (see
      Section 4.1 of [MESSGNG]).

   o  Whether the header field ought position to be preserved save personal data about a user's
   requests over time, which might identify their reading patterns or
   subjects of interest.  In particular, log information gathered at an
   intermediary often contains a history of user agent interaction,
   across redirects.

   o  Whether it introduces any additional security considerations, such
      as disclosure a multitude of privacy-related data.

8.3.2.  Registrations

   The "Message Headers" registry has been updated with the following
   permanent registrations:

   +-------------------+----------+----------+------------------+
   | Header Field Name | Protocol | Status   | Reference        |
   +-------------------+----------+----------+------------------+
   | Accept            | http     | standard | Section 5.3.2    |
   | Accept-Charset    | http     | standard | Section 5.3.3    |
   | Accept-Encoding   | http     | standard | Section 5.3.4    |
   | Accept-Language   | http     | standard | Section 5.3.5    |
   | Allow             | http     | standard | Section 7.4.1    |
   | Content-Encoding  | http     | standard | Section 3.1.2.2  |
   | Content-Language  | http     | standard | Section 3.1.3.2  |
   | Content-Location  | http     | standard | Section 3.1.4.2  |
   | Content-Type      | http     | standard | Section 3.1.1.5  |
   | Date              | http     | standard | Section 7.1.1.2  |
   | Expect            | http     | standard | Section 5.1.1    |
   | From              | http     | standard | Section 5.5.1    |
   | Location          | http     | standard | Section 7.1.2    |
   | Max-Forwards      | http     | standard | Section 5.1.2    |
   | MIME-Version      | http     | standard | Appendix A.1     |
   | Referer           | http     | standard | Section 5.5.2    |
   | Retry-After       | http     | standard | Section 7.1.3    |
   | Server            | http     | standard | Section 7.4.2    |
   | User-Agent        | http     | standard | Section 5.5.3    |
   | Vary              | http     | standard | Section 7.1.4    |
   +-------------------+----------+----------+------------------+

   The change controller sites, that can be traced to individual users.

   HTTP log information is confidential in nature; its handling is often
   constrained by laws and regulations.  Log information needs to be
   securely stored and appropriate guidelines followed for its analysis.
   Anonymization of personal information within individual entries
   helps, but it is generally not sufficient to prevent real log traces
   from being re-identified based on correlation with other access
   characteristics.  As such, access traces that are keyed to a specific
   client are unsafe to publish even if the above registrations is: "IETF
   (iesg@ietf.org) - Internet Engineering Task Force".

8.4.  Content Coding Registry

   The "HTTP Content Coding Registry" defines the namespace for content
   coding names (Section 4.2 of [MESSGNG]).  The content coding registry key is maintained at <http://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters>.

8.4.1.  Procedure

   Content coding registrations MUST include pseudonymous.

   To minimize the following fields:

   o  Name

   o  Description

   o  Pointer to specification text

   Names of content codings MUST NOT overlap with names risk of transfer
   codings (Section 4 theft or accidental publication, log
   information ought to be purged of [MESSGNG]), unless the encoding transformation
   is identical (as personally identifiable
   information, including user identifiers, IP addresses, and user-
   provided query parameters, as soon as that information is the case no longer
   necessary to support operational needs for the compression codings defined in
   Section 4.2 security, auditing, or
   fraud control.

12.8.  Disclosure of [MESSGNG]).

   Values Sensitive Information in URIs

   URIs are intended to be shared, not secured, even when they identify
   secure resources.  URIs are often shown on displays, added to this namespace require IETF Review (see
   Section 4.1 of [RFC5226])
   templates when a page is printed, and MUST conform stored in a variety of
   unprotected bookmark lists.  It is therefore unwise to include
   information within a URI that is sensitive, personally identifiable,
   or a risk to disclose.

   Authors of services ought to avoid GET-based forms for the purpose submission
   of content
   coding defined sensitive data because that data will be placed in this section.

8.4.2.  Registrations

   The "HTTP Content Coding Registry" has been updated with the
   registrations below:

   +----------+------------------------------------------+-------------+
   | Name     | Description                              | Reference   |
   +----------+------------------------------------------+-------------+
   | identity | Reserved (synonym for "no encoding" request-
   target.  Many existing servers, proxies, and user agents log or
   display the request-target in   | Section 5.3 |
   |          | Accept-Encoding)                         | .4          |
   +----------+------------------------------------------+-------------+

9.  Security Considerations

   This section is meant places where it might be visible to inform developers, information providers,
   and users of known security concerns relevant
   third parties.  Such services ought to HTTP semantics and
   its use for transferring information over POST-based form submission
   instead.

   Since the Internet.
   Considerations related Referer header field tells a target site about the context
   that resulted in a request, it has the potential to message syntax, parsing, reveal
   information about the user's immediate browsing history and routing any
   personal information that might be found in the referring resource's
   URI.  Limitations on the Referer header field are
   discussed described in
   Section 9 8.6.2 to address some of [MESSGNG].

   The list its security considerations.

12.9.  Disclosure of considerations below is Fragment after Redirects

   Although fragment identifiers used within URI references are not exhaustive.  Most security
   concerns related sent
   in requests, implementers ought to be aware that they will be visible
   to HTTP semantics are about securing server-side
   applications (code behind the HTTP interface), securing user agent
   processing of payloads received via HTTP, and any extensions or secure use of the
   Internet in general, rather than security scripts running as a result
   of the protocol.  Various
   organizations maintain topical information and links to current
   research on Web application security (e.g., [OWASP]).

9.1.  Attacks Based on File response.  In particular, when a redirect occurs and Path Names

   Origin servers frequently make use of their local file system to
   manage the mapping from effective request URI to resource
   representations.  Most file systems are not designed to protect
   against malicious file or path names.  Therefore, an origin server
   needs to avoid accessing names that
   original request's fragment identifier is inherited by the new
   reference in Location (Section 10.1.2), this might have a special significance the effect of
   disclosing one site's fragment to another site.  If the system when mapping the request target first site
   uses personal information in fragments, it ought to ensure that
   redirects to files, folders, or
   directories.

   For example, UNIX, Microsoft Windows, and other operating systems use
   ".." as sites include a path (possibly empty) fragment
   component in order to indicate a directory level above the
   current one, and they use specially named paths or file names to send
   data to system devices.  Similar naming conventions might exist
   within other types block that inheritance.

12.10.  Disclosure of storage Product Information

   The User-Agent (Section 8.6.3), Via (Section 5.6.1), and Server
   (Section 10.4.3) header fields often reveal information about the
   respective sender's software systems.  Likewise, local storage
   systems have  In theory, this can make it
   easier for an annoying tendency attacker to prefer user-friendliness over exploit known security when handling invalid or unexpected characters,
   recomposition of decomposed characters, and case-normalization of
   case-insensitive names.

   Attacks based on such special names holes; in practice,
   attackers tend to focus on either denial-
   of-service (e.g., telling try all potential holes regardless of the server apparent
   software versions being used.

   Proxies that serve as a portal through a network firewall ought to read from
   take special precautions regarding the transfer of header information
   that might identify hosts behind the firewall.  The Via header field
   allows intermediaries to replace sensitive machine names with
   pseudonyms.

12.11.  Browser Fingerprinting

   Browser fingerprinting is a COM port) or
   disclosure set of configuration techniques for identifying a
   specific user agent over time through its unique set of
   characteristics.  These characteristics might include information
   related to its TCP behavior, feature capabilities, and source files scripting
   environment, though of particular interest here is the set of unique
   characteristics that are not meant to might be
   served.

9.2.  Attacks Based on Command, Code, or Query Injection

   Origin servers often use parameters within the URI as communicated via HTTP.  Fingerprinting
   is considered a means privacy concern because it enables tracking of
   identifying system services, selecting database entries, or choosing a user
   agent's behavior over time without the corresponding controls that
   the user might have over other forms of data source.  However, data received in collection (e.g.,
   cookies).  Many general-purpose user agents (i.e., Web browsers) have
   taken steps to reduce their fingerprints.

   There are a request cannot be
   trusted.  An attacker could construct any number of the request data
   elements (method, request-target, header fields, or body) to contain
   data fields that might reveal
   information to servers that is sufficiently unique to enable
   fingerprinting.  The From header field is the most obvious, though it
   is expected that From will only be misinterpreted as a command, code, or query sent when
   passed through self-identification is
   desired by the user.  Likewise, Cookie header fields are deliberately
   designed to enable re-identification, so fingerprinting concerns only
   apply to situations where cookies are disabled or restricted by the
   user agent's configuration.

   The User-Agent header field might contain enough information to
   uniquely identify a command invocation, language interpreter, specific device, usually when combined with other
   characteristics, particularly if the user agent sends excessive
   details about the user's system or
   database interface.

   For example, SQL injection extensions.  However, the source
   of unique information that is a common attack wherein additional
   query language least expected by users is inserted within some part proactive
   negotiation (Section 8.4), including the Accept, Accept-Charset,
   Accept-Encoding, and Accept-Language header fields.

   In addition to the fingerprinting concern, detailed use of the request-target or
   Accept-Language header fields (e.g., Host, Referer, etc.).  If field can reveal information the received data is
   used directly within user might
   consider to be of a SELECT statement, the query private nature.  For example, understanding a
   given language set might be
   interpreted as strongly correlated to membership in a database command instead
   particular ethnic group.  An approach that limits such loss of
   privacy would be for a simple string value.
   This type of implementation vulnerability is extremely common, in
   spite of being easy to prevent.

   In general, resource implementations ought user agent to avoid use omit the sending of request
   data in contexts Accept-
   Language except for sites that have been whitelisted, perhaps via
   interaction after detecting a Vary header field that indicates
   language negotiation might be useful.

   In environments where proxies are processed or interpreted as instructions.
   Parameters used to enhance privacy, user
   agents ought to be compared to fixed strings and acted upon as conservative in sending proactive negotiation
   header fields.  General-purpose user agents that provide a
   result high
   degree of header field configurability ought to inform users about
   the loss of privacy that comparison, rather than passed through an interface
   that might result if too much detail is provided.
   As an extreme privacy measure, proxies could filter the proactive
   negotiation header fields in relayed requests.

12.12.  Validator Retention

   The validators defined by this specification are not prepared for untrusted data.  Received data that isn't
   based on fixed parameters ought intended to be carefully filtered
   ensure the validity of a representation, guard against malicious
   changes, or encoded
   to avoid being misinterpreted.

   Similar considerations apply to request data when it is stored detect man-in-the-middle attacks.  At best, they enable
   more efficient cache updates and
   later processed, such as within log files, monitoring tools, or optimistic concurrent writes when
   included within a data format that allows embedded scripts.

9.3.  Disclosure of Personal Information

   Clients
   all participants are often privy to large amounts of personal information,
   including both information provided by the user to interact with
   resources (e.g., behaving nicely.  At worst, the user's name, location, mail address, passwords,
   encryption keys, etc.) conditions will
   fail and information about the user's browsing
   activity over time (e.g., history, bookmarks, etc.).  Implementations
   need to prevent unintentional disclosure of personal information.

9.4.  Disclosure of Sensitive Information in URIs

   URIs are intended to client will receive a response that is no more harmful
   than an HTTP exchange without conditional requests.

   An entity-tag can be shared, not secured, even when they identify
   secure resources.  URIs are often shown on displays, added to
   templates when abused in ways that create privacy risks.  For
   example, a page site might deliberately construct a semantically invalid
   entity-tag that is printed, unique to the user or user agent, send it in a
   cacheable response with a long freshness time, and stored then read that
   entity-tag in later conditional requests as a variety means of
   unprotected bookmark lists.  It is therefore unwise to include
   information within re-identifying
   that user or user agent.  Such an identifying tag would become a URI
   persistent identifier for as long as the user agent retained the
   original cache entry.  User agents that cache representations ought
   to ensure that the cache is sensitive, personally identifiable, cleared or a risk replaced whenever the user
   performs privacy-maintaining actions, such as clearing stored cookies
   or changing to disclose.

   Authors of services ought a private browsing mode.

12.13.  Denial-of-Service Attacks Using Range

   Unconstrained multiple range requests are susceptible to avoid GET-based forms for denial-of-
   service attacks because the submission effort required to request many
   overlapping ranges of sensitive data because that the same data will be placed in is tiny compared to the request-
   target.  Many existing servers, proxies, time,
   memory, and user agents log or
   display bandwidth consumed by attempting to serve the request-target requested
   data in places where it might be visible to
   third parties.  Such services many parts.  Servers ought to use POST-based form submission
   instead.

   Since the Referer header field tells ignore, coalesce, or reject
   egregious range requests, such as requests for more than two
   overlapping ranges or for many small ranges in a target site single set,
   particularly when the ranges are requested out of order for no
   apparent reason.  Multipart range requests are not designed to
   support random access.

12.14.  Authentication Considerations

   Everything about the context
   that resulted in topic of HTTP authentication is a request, security
   consideration, so the list of considerations below is not exhaustive.
   Furthermore, it has is limited to security considerations regarding the
   authentication framework, in general, rather than discussing all of
   the potential considerations for specific authentication schemes
   (which ought to reveal
   information about be documented in the user's immediate browsing history and any
   personal information specifications that might be define those
   schemes).  Various organizations maintain topical information and
   links to current research on Web application security (e.g.,
   [OWASP]), including common pitfalls for implementing and using the
   authentication schemes found in practice.

12.14.1.  Confidentiality of Credentials

   The HTTP authentication framework does not define a single mechanism
   for maintaining the referring resource's
   URI.  Limitations on confidentiality of credentials; instead, each
   authentication scheme defines how the Referer header field credentials are described in
   Section 5.5.2 encoded prior
   to address some transmission.  While this provides flexibility for the development
   of its security considerations.

9.5.  Disclosure future authentication schemes, it is inadequate for the protection
   of Fragment after Redirects

   Although fragment identifiers used within URI references are existing schemes that provide no confidentiality on their own, or
   that do not sent
   in requests, implementers ought to be aware sufficiently protect against replay attacks.
   Furthermore, if the server expects credentials that they will be visible are specific to
   each individual user, the exchange of those credentials will have the
   effect of identifying that user agent and any extensions or scripts running as a result even if the content within
   credentials remains confidential.

   HTTP depends on the security properties of the response. underlying transport-
   or session-level connection to provide confidential transmission of
   header fields.  In particular, when other words, if a redirect occurs and server limits access to
   authenticated users using this framework, the
   original request's fragment identifier is inherited by server needs to ensure
   that the new
   reference connection is properly secured in Location (Section 7.1.2), this might have accordance with the effect nature
   of
   disclosing one site's fragment to another site.  If the first site
   uses personal information in fragments, it ought to ensure authentication scheme used.  For example, services that
   redirects to other sites include depend
   on individual user authentication often require a (possibly empty) fragment
   component in order connection to block that inheritance.

9.6.  Disclosure of Product Information

   The User-Agent (Section 5.5.3), Via (Section 5.7.1 of [MESSGNG]), be
   secured with TLS ("Transport Layer Security", [RFC5246]) prior to
   exchanging any credentials.

12.14.2.  Credentials and
   Server (Section 7.4.2) header fields often reveal Idle Clients

   Existing HTTP clients and user agents typically retain authentication
   information about indefinitely.  HTTP does not provide a mechanism for the respective sender's software systems.  In theory, this
   origin server to direct clients to discard these cached credentials,
   since the protocol has no awareness of how credentials are obtained
   or managed by the user agent.  The mechanisms for expiring or
   revoking credentials can be specified as part of an authentication
   scheme definition.

   Circumstances under which credential caching can make
   it easier interfere with the
   application's security model include but are not limited to:

   o  Clients that have been idle for an attacker extended period, following
      which the server might wish to exploit known security holes; in
   practice, attackers tend cause the client to try all potential holes regardless of re-prompt the
   apparent software versions being used.

   Proxies
      user for credentials.

   o  Applications that serve include a session termination indication (such
      as a portal through "logout" or "commit" button on a network firewall ought to
   take special precautions regarding page) after which the transfer server
      side of header information
   that might identify hosts behind the firewall.  The Via header field
   allows intermediaries to replace sensitive machine names with
   pseudonyms.

9.7.  Browser Fingerprinting

   Browser fingerprinting application "knows" that there is a set of techniques no further reason
      for identifying a
   specific user agent over time through its unique set of
   characteristics.  These characteristics might include information
   related the client to its TCP behavior, feature capabilities, and scripting
   environment, though of particular interest here is retain the set of unique
   characteristics credentials.

   User agents that might be communicated via HTTP.  Fingerprinting
   is considered a privacy concern because it enables tracking of cache credentials are encouraged to provide a
   readily accessible mechanism for discarding cached credentials under
   user
   agent's behavior over time without the corresponding controls control.

12.14.3.  Protection Spaces

   Authentication schemes that solely rely on the user might have over other forms of data collection (e.g.,
   cookies).  Many general-purpose user agents (i.e., Web browsers) have
   taken steps to reduce their fingerprints.

   There are "realm" mechanism for
   establishing a number of request header fields that might reveal
   information protection space will expose credentials to servers all
   resources on an origin server.  Clients that is sufficiently unique to enable
   fingerprinting.  The From header field is have successfully made
   authenticated requests with a resource can use the most obvious, though same
   authentication credentials for other resources on the same origin
   server.  This makes it possible for a different resource to harvest
   authentication credentials for other resources.

   This is expected that From will only be sent of particular concern when self-identification is
   desired by an origin server hosts resources
   for multiple parties under the user.  Likewise, Cookie header fields are deliberately
   designed to enable re-identification, so fingerprinting concerns only
   apply same canonical root URI
   (Section 8.5.2).  Possible mitigation strategies include restricting
   direct access to situations where cookies are disabled or restricted by authentication credentials (i.e., not making the
   user agent's configuration.

   The User-Agent
   content of the Authorization request header field might contain enough information to
   uniquely identify available), and
   separating protection spaces by using a specific device, usually when combined different host name (or port
   number) for each party.

13.  IANA Considerations

   This section is to be removed before publishing as an RFC.

   The change controller for the following registrations is: "IETF
   (iesg@ietf.org) - Internet Engineering Task Force".

13.1.  URI Scheme Registration

   Please update the registry of URI Schemes [BCP115] at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/uri-schemes/> with the permanent
   schemes listed in the first table of Section 2.5.

13.2.  Method Registration

   Please update the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Method
   Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-methods> with the
   registration procedure of Section 7.4.1 and the method names
   summarized in the table of Section 7.2.

13.3.  Status Code Registration

   Please update the "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Status Code
   Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-status-codes>
   with the registration procedure of Section 9.7.1 and the status code
   values summarized in the table of Section 9.1.

13.4.  Header Field Registration

   Please update the "Message Headers" registry of "Permanent Message
   Header Field Names" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/message-
   headers> with other
   characteristics, particularly if the user agent sends excessive
   details about the user's system or extensions.  However, header field names listed in the source table of unique information that is least expected by users is proactive
   negotiation (Section 5.3), including
   Section 4.1.

13.5.  Authentication Scheme Registration

   Please update the Accept, Accept-Charset,
   Accept-Encoding, and Accept-Language header fields.

   In addition to "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Authentication
   Scheme Registry" at <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-
   authschemes> with the fingerprinting concern, detailed use registration procedure of Section 8.5.5.1.  No
   authentication schemes are defined in this document.

13.6.  Content Coding Registration

   Please update the
   Accept-Language header field can reveal information "HTTP Content Coding Registry" at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/> with the user might
   consider to be
   registration procedure of a private nature.  For example, understanding a
   given language set might be strongly correlated to membership Section 6.1.2.4.1 and the content coding
   names summarized in a
   particular ethnic group.  An approach that limits such loss the table of
   privacy would be for a user agent to omit Section 6.1.2.

13.7.  Range Unit Registration

   Please update the sending "HTTP Range Unit Registry" at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/> with the
   registration procedure of Accept-
   Language except for sites that have been whitelisted, perhaps via
   interaction after detecting a Vary header field that indicates
   language negotiation might be useful.

   In environments where proxies are used to enhance privacy, user
   agents ought to be conservative Section 6.1.4.3 and the range unit names
   summarized in sending proactive negotiation
   header fields.  General-purpose user agents that provide a high
   degree of header field configurability ought to inform users about the loss table of privacy that might result if too much detail is provided.
   As an extreme privacy measure, proxies could filter Section 6.1.4.

13.8.  Media Type Registration

   Please update the proactive
   negotiation header fields "Media Types" registry at
   <https://www.iana.org/assignments/media-types> with the registration
   information in relayed requests.

10. Section 6.3.4 for the media type "multipart/
   byteranges".

14.  References

10.1.

14.1.  Normative References

   [AUTHFRM]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
              Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP): Authentication",
              draft-ietf-httpbis-auth-00 (work in progress), April 2018.

   [CACHING]

   [Caching]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
              Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP): "HTTP Caching", draft-
              ietf-httpbis-cache-00 draft-ietf-httpbis-cache-01 (work in
              progress), April May 2018.

   [CONDTNL]

   [Messaging]
              Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
              Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP): Conditional
              Requests", draft-ietf-httpbis-conditional-00 "HTTP/1.1 Messaging", draft-ietf-httpbis-messaging-01
              (work in progress), April May 2018.

   [MESSGNG]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, M., Ed., and J. Reschke,
              Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Message
              Syntax

   [RFC0793]  Postel, J., "Transmission Control Protocol", STD 7,
              RFC 793, DOI 10.17487/RFC0793, September 1981,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc793>.

   [RFC1950]  Deutsch, L. and Routing", draft-ietf-httpbis-messaging-00 (work
              in progress), April 2018.

   [RANGERQ]  Fielding, R., Ed., Nottingham, J-L. Gailly, "ZLIB Compressed Data Format
              Specification version 3.3", RFC 1950,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC1950, May 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1950>.

   [RFC1951]  Deutsch, P., "DEFLATE Compressed Data Format Specification
              version 1.3", RFC 1951, DOI 10.17487/RFC1951, May 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1951>.

   [RFC1952]  Deutsch, P., Gailly, J-L., Adler, M., Ed., Deutsch, L., and J. Reschke,
              Ed., "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP): Range Requests",
              draft-ietf-httpbis-range-00 (work in progress), April
              2018. G.
              Randers-Pehrson, "GZIP file format specification version
              4.3", RFC 1952, DOI 10.17487/RFC1952, May 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1952>.

   [RFC2045]  Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail
              Extensions (MIME) Part One: Format of Internet Message
              Bodies", RFC 2045, DOI 10.17487/RFC2045, November 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2045>.

   [RFC2046]  Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail
              Extensions (MIME) Part Two: Media Types", RFC 2046,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC2046, November 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2046>.

   [RFC2119]  Bradner, S., "Key words for use in RFCs to Indicate
              Requirement Levels", BCP 14, RFC 2119,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC2119, March 1997,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2119>.

   [RFC3986]  Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R., and L. Masinter, "Uniform
              Resource Identifier (URI): Generic Syntax", STD 66,
              RFC 3986, DOI 10.17487/RFC3986, January 2005,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3986>.

   [RFC4647]  Phillips, A., Ed. and M. Davis, Ed., "Matching of Language
              Tags", BCP 47, RFC 4647, DOI 10.17487/RFC4647, September
              2006, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4647>.

   [RFC4648]  Josefsson, S., "The Base16, Base32, and Base64 Data
              Encodings", RFC 4648, DOI 10.17487/RFC4648, October 2006,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4648>.

   [RFC5234]  Crocker, D., Ed. and P. Overell, "Augmented BNF for Syntax
              Specifications: ABNF", STD 68, RFC 5234,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5234, January 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5234>.

   [RFC5646]  Phillips, A., Ed. and M. Davis, Ed., "Tags for Identifying
              Languages", BCP 47, RFC 5646, DOI 10.17487/RFC5646,
              September 2009, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5646>.

   [RFC6365]  Hoffman, P. and J. Klensin, "Terminology Used in
              Internationalization in the IETF", BCP 166, RFC 6365,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC6365, September 2011,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6365>.

10.2.

   [USASCII]  American National Standards Institute, "Coded Character
              Set -- 7-bit American Standard Code for Information
              Interchange", ANSI X3.4, 1986.

   [Welch]    Welch, T., "A Technique for High-Performance Data
              Compression", IEEE Computer 17(6), June 1984.

14.2.  Informative References

   [BCP115]   Hansen, T., Hardie, T., and L. Masinter, "Guidelines and
              Registration Procedures for New URI Schemes", BCP 115,
              RFC 4395, February 2006,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp115>.

   [BCP13]    Freed, N., Klensin, J., and T. Hansen, "Media Type
              Specifications and Registration Procedures", BCP 13,
              RFC 6838, January 2013,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp13>.

   [BCP178]   Saint-Andre, P., Crocker, D., and M. Nottingham,
              "Deprecating the "X-" Prefix and Similar Constructs in
              Application Protocols", BCP 178, RFC 6648, June 2012,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp178>.

   [BCP90]    Klyne, G., Nottingham, M., and J. Mogul, "Registration
              Procedures for Message Header Fields", BCP 90, RFC 3864,
              September 2004, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/bcp90>.

   [Georgiev]
              Georgiev, M., Iyengar, S., Jana, S., Anubhai, R., Boneh,
              D., and V. Shmatikov, "The Most Dangerous Code in the
              World: Validating SSL Certificates in Non-browser
              Software", In Proceedings of the 2012 ACM Conference on
              Computer and Communications Security (CCS '12), pp. 38-49,
              October 2012,
              <http://doi.acm.org/10.1145/2382196.2382204>.

   [ISO-8859-1]
              International Organization for Standardization,
              "Information technology -- 8-bit single-byte coded graphic
              character sets -- Part 1: Latin alphabet No. 1", ISO/
              IEC 8859-1:1998, 1998.

   [Kri2001]  Kristol, D., "HTTP Cookies: Standards, Privacy, and
              Politics", ACM Transactions on Internet Technology 1(2),
              November 2001, <http://arxiv.org/abs/cs.SE/0105018>.

   [OWASP]    van der Stock, A., Ed., "A Guide to Building Secure Web
              Applications and Web Services", The Open Web Application
              Security Project (OWASP) 2.0.1, July 2005,
              <https://www.owasp.org/>.

   [REST]     Fielding, R., "Architectural Styles and the Design of
              Network-based Software Architectures",
              Doctoral Dissertation, University of California, Irvine,
              September 2000,
              <http://roy.gbiv.com/pubs/dissertation/top.htm>.
              <https://roy.gbiv.com/pubs/dissertation/top.htm>.

   [RFC1919]  Chatel, M., "Classical versus Transparent IP Proxies",
              RFC 1919, DOI 10.17487/RFC1919, March 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1919>.

   [RFC1945]  Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R., and H. Nielsen, "Hypertext
              Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0", RFC 1945,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC1945, May 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc1945>.

   [RFC2049]  Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose

   [RFC2047]  Moore, K., "MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail
              Extensions (MIME) Extensions)
              Part Five: Conformance Criteria and
              Examples", Three: Message Header Extensions for Non-ASCII Text",
              RFC 2049, 2047, DOI 10.17487/RFC2049, 10.17487/RFC2047, November 1996,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2049>.
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2047>.

   [RFC2068]  Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Nielsen, H., and T.
              Berners-Lee, "Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1",
              RFC 2068, DOI 10.17487/RFC2068, January 1997,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2068>.

   [RFC2145]  Mogul, J., Fielding, R., Gettys, J., and H. Nielsen, "Use
              and Interpretation of HTTP Version Numbers", RFC 2145,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC2145, May 1997,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2145>.

   [RFC2295]  Holtman, K. and A. Mutz, "Transparent Content Negotiation
              in HTTP", RFC 2295, DOI 10.17487/RFC2295, March 1998,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2295>.

   [RFC2388]  Masinter, L., "Returning Values from Forms: multipart/
              form-data", RFC 2388, DOI 10.17487/RFC2388, August 1998,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2388>.

   [RFC2557]  Palme, F., Hopmann, A., Shelness, N., and E. Stefferud,
              "MIME Encapsulation of Aggregate Documents, such as HTML
              (MHTML)", RFC 2557, DOI 10.17487/RFC2557, March 1999,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2557>.

   [RFC2616]  Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Frystyk, H.,
              Masinter, L., Leach, P., and T. Berners-Lee, "Hypertext
              Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1", T. Berners-Lee, "Hypertext
              Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1", RFC 2616,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC2616, June 1999,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2616>.

   [RFC2617]  Franks, J., Hallam-Baker, P., Hostetler, J., Lawrence, S.,
              Leach, P., Luotonen, A., and L. Stewart, "HTTP
              Authentication: Basic and Digest Access Authentication",
              RFC 2616, 2617, DOI 10.17487/RFC2616, 10.17487/RFC2617, June 1999,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2616>.
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2617>.

   [RFC2774]  Frystyk, H., Leach, P., and S. Lawrence, "An HTTP
              Extension Framework", RFC 2774, DOI 10.17487/RFC2774,
              February 2000, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2774>.

   [RFC2817]  Khare, R. and S. Lawrence, "Upgrading to TLS Within
              HTTP/1.1",

   [RFC2818]  Rescorla, E., "HTTP Over TLS", RFC 2817, 2818,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC2817, 10.17487/RFC2818, May 2000,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2817>.
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2818>.

   [RFC2978]  Freed, N. and J. Postel, "IANA Charset Registration
              Procedures", BCP 19, RFC 2978, DOI 10.17487/RFC2978,
              October 2000, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc2978>.

   [RFC5226]  Narten, T. and H. Alvestrand, "Guidelines for Writing an
              IANA Considerations Section in RFCs", BCP 26, RFC 5226,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5226, May 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5226>.

   [RFC5246]  Dierks, T.

   [RFC3040]  Cooper, I., Melve, I., and E. Rescorla, "The Transport Layer Security
              (TLS) Protocol Version 1.2", RFC 5246,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5246, August 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5246>.

   [RFC5322]  Resnick, P., G. Tomlinson, "Internet Message Format", RFC 5322,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5322, October 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5322>.

   [RFC5789]  Dusseault, L. and J. Snell, "PATCH Method for HTTP",
              RFC 5789, DOI 10.17487/RFC5789, March 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5789>.

   [RFC5905]  Mills, D., Martin, J., Ed., Burbank, J., and W. Kasch,
              "Network Time Protocol Version 4: Protocol and Algorithms
              Specification", RFC 5905, DOI 10.17487/RFC5905, June 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5905>.

   [RFC5987]  Reschke, J., "Character Set Web
              Replication and Language Encoding for
              Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Header Field
              Parameters", RFC 5987, DOI 10.17487/RFC5987, August 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5987>.

   [RFC5988]  Nottingham, M., "Web Linking", RFC 5988,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5988, October 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5988>.

   [RFC6265]  Barth, A., "HTTP State Management Mechanism", Caching Taxonomy", RFC 6265, 3040,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC6265, April 2011,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6265>.

   [RFC7231]  Fielding, 10.17487/RFC3040, January 2001,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc3040>.

   [RFC4033]  Arends, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
              Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Semantics and Content", RFC 7231,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC7231, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7231>.

   [RFC7238]  Reschke, J., "The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP)
              Status Code 308 (Permanent Redirect)", draft-reschke-http-
              status-308-07 (work in progress), March 2012.

Appendix A.  Differences between HTTP and MIME

   HTTP/1.1 uses many of the constructs defined for the Internet Message
   Format [RFC5322] and the Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions (MIME)
   [RFC2045] to allow a message body to be transmitted in an open
   variety of representations and with extensible header fields.
   However, RFC 2045 is focused only on email; applications of HTTP have
   many characteristics that differ from email; hence, HTTP has features
   that differ from MIME.  These differences were carefully chosen to
   optimize performance over binary connections, to allow greater
   freedom in the use of new media types, to make date comparisons
   easier, and to acknowledge the practice of some early HTTP servers
   and clients.

   This appendix describes specific areas where HTTP differs from MIME.
   Proxies and gateways to and from strict MIME environments need to be
   aware of these differences and provide the appropriate conversions
   where necessary.

A.1.  MIME-Version

   HTTP is not a MIME-compliant protocol.  However, messages can include
   a single MIME-Version header field to indicate what version of the
   MIME protocol was used to construct the message.  Use of the MIME-
   Version header field indicates that the message is in full
   conformance with the MIME protocol (as defined in [RFC2045]).
   Senders are responsible for ensuring full conformance (where
   possible) when exporting HTTP messages to strict MIME environments.

A.2.  Conversion to Canonical Form

   MIME requires that an Internet mail body part be converted to
   canonical form prior to being transferred, as described in Section 4
   of [RFC2049].  Section 3.1.1.3 of this document describes the forms
   allowed for subtypes of the "text" media type when transmitted over
   HTTP.  [RFC2046] requires that content with a type of "text"
   represent line breaks as CRLF and forbids the use of CR or LF outside
   of line break sequences.  HTTP allows CRLF, bare CR, and bare LF to
   indicate a line break within text content.

   A proxy or gateway from HTTP to a strict MIME environment ought to
   translate all line breaks within the text media types described in
   Section 3.1.1.3 of this document to the Austein, R., Larson, M., Massey, D., and S.
              Rose, "DNS Security Introduction and Requirements",
              RFC 2049 canonical form of
   CRLF.  Note, however, this might be complicated by the presence of a
   Content-Encoding 4033, DOI 10.17487/RFC4033, March 2005,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4033>.

   [RFC4559]  Jaganathan, K., Zhu, L., and by the fact that J. Brezak, "SPNEGO-based
              Kerberos and NTLM HTTP allows the use of some
   charsets that do not use octets 13 Authentication in Microsoft
              Windows", RFC 4559, DOI 10.17487/RFC4559, June 2006,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4559>.

   [RFC4918]  Dusseault, L., Ed., "HTTP Extensions for Web Distributed
              Authoring and 10 to represent CR Versioning (WebDAV)", RFC 4918,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC4918, June 2007,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc4918>.

   [RFC5226]  Narten, T. and LF,
   respectively.

   Conversion will break any cryptographic checksums applied to the
   original content unless the original content is already in canonical
   form.  Therefore, the canonical form is recommended H. Alvestrand, "Guidelines for any content
   that uses such checksums Writing an
              IANA Considerations Section in HTTP.

A.3.  Conversion of Date Formats

   HTTP/1.1 uses a restricted set of date formats (Section 7.1.1.1) to
   simplify the process of date comparison.  Proxies RFCs", BCP 26, RFC 5226,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5226, May 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5226>.

   [RFC5246]  Dierks, T. and gateways from
   other protocols ought to ensure that any Date header field present in
   a message conforms to one of the HTTP/1.1 formats E. Rescorla, "The Transport Layer Security
              (TLS) Protocol Version 1.2", RFC 5246,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5246, August 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5246>.

   [RFC5322]  Resnick, P., "Internet Message Format", RFC 5322,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5322, October 2008,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5322>.

   [RFC5789]  Dusseault, L. and rewrite the
   date if necessary.

A.4.  Conversion of Content-Encoding

   MIME does not include any concept equivalent to HTTP/1.1's Content-
   Encoding header field.  Since this acts as a modifier on the media
   type, proxies J. Snell, "PATCH Method for HTTP",
              RFC 5789, DOI 10.17487/RFC5789, March 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5789>.

   [RFC5905]  Mills, D., Martin, J., Ed., Burbank, J., and gateways from HTTP to MIME-compliant protocols
   ought to either change the value of the Content-Type header field or
   decode the representation before forwarding the message.  (Some
   experimental applications of Content-Type W. Kasch,
              "Network Time Protocol Version 4: Protocol and Algorithms
              Specification", RFC 5905, DOI 10.17487/RFC5905, June 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5905>.

   [RFC5987]  Reschke, J., "Character Set and Language Encoding for Internet mail have used
   a media-type parameter of ";conversions=<content-coding>" to perform
   a function equivalent to Content-Encoding.  However, this parameter
   is not part of the MIME standards).

A.5.  Conversion of Content-Transfer-Encoding

   HTTP does not use the Content-Transfer-Encoding field of MIME.
   Proxies
              Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Header Field
              Parameters", RFC 5987, DOI 10.17487/RFC5987, August 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5987>.

   [RFC5988]  Nottingham, M., "Web Linking", RFC 5988,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC5988, October 2010,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc5988>.

   [RFC6265]  Barth, A., "HTTP State Management Mechanism", RFC 6265,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC6265, April 2011,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6265>.

   [RFC6585]  Nottingham, M. and gateways from MIME-compliant protocols to HTTP need to
   remove any Content-Transfer-Encoding prior to delivering the response
   message to an R. Fielding, "Additional HTTP client.

   Proxies Status
              Codes", RFC 6585, DOI 10.17487/RFC6585, April 2012,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc6585>.

   [RFC7230]  Fielding, R., Ed. and gateways from HTTP to MIME-compliant protocols are
   responsible for ensuring that the message is in the correct format J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
              Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Message Syntax and encoding for safe transport on that protocol, where "safe
   transport" is defined by the limitations of the protocol being used.
   Such a proxy or gateway ought to transform Routing",
              RFC 7230, DOI 10.17487/RFC7230, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7230>.

   [RFC7231]  Fielding, R., Ed. and label the data with an
   appropriate Content-Transfer-Encoding if doing so will improve the
   likelihood of safe transport over the destination protocol.

A.6.  MHTML J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
              Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Semantics and Content", RFC 7231,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC7231, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7231>.

   [RFC7232]  Fielding, R., Ed. and J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
              Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Conditional Requests", RFC 7232,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC7232, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7232>.

   [RFC7233]  Fielding, R., Ed., Lafon, Y., Ed., and J. Reschke, Ed.,
              "Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP): Range Requests",
              RFC 7233, DOI 10.17487/RFC7233, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7233>.

   [RFC7235]  Fielding, R., Ed. and Line Length Limitations

   HTTP implementations that share code with MHTML [RFC2557]
   implementations need to be aware of MIME line length limitations.
   Since HTTP does not have this limitation, HTTP does not fold long
   lines.  MHTML messages being transported by HTTP follow all
   conventions of MHTML, including line length limitations J. Reschke, Ed., "Hypertext Transfer
              Protocol (HTTP/1.1): Authentication", RFC 7235,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC7235, June 2014,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7235>.

   [RFC7238]  Reschke, J., "The Hypertext Transfer Protocol Status Code
              308 (Permanent Redirect)", RFC 7238, DOI 10.17487/RFC7238,
              June 2014, <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7238>.

   [RFC7616]  Shekh-Yusef, R., Ed., Ahrens, D., and folding,
   canonicalization, etc., since S. Bremer, "HTTP
              Digest Access Authentication", RFC 7616,
              DOI 10.17487/RFC7616, September 2015,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7616>.

   [RFC7617]  Reschke, J., "The 'Basic' HTTP transfers message-bodies as
   payload and, aside from the "multipart/byteranges" type (Appendix A
   of [RANGERQ]), does not interpret the content or any MIME header
   lines that might be contained therein.

Appendix B.  Changes from Authentication Scheme",
              RFC 7231

   None yet.

Appendix C.  Imported ABNF

   The following core rules are included by reference, as defined in
   Appendix B.1 of [RFC5234]: ALPHA (letters), CR (carriage return),
   CRLF (CR LF), CTL (controls), DIGIT (decimal 0-9), DQUOTE (double
   quote), HEXDIG (hexadecimal 0-9/A-F/a-f), HTAB (horizontal tab), LF
   (line feed), OCTET (any 8-bit sequence of data), SP (space), and
   VCHAR (any visible US-ASCII character).

   The rules below are defined in [MESSGNG]:

     BWS           = <BWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3>
     OWS           = <OWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3>
     RWS           = <RWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3>
     URI-reference = <URI-reference, see [MESSGNG], Section 2.7>
     absolute-URI  = <absolute-URI, see [MESSGNG], Section 2.7>
     comment       = <comment, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.6>
     field-name    = <comment, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2>
     partial-URI   = <partial-URI, see [MESSGNG], Section 2.7>
     quoted-string = <quoted-string, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.6>
     token         = <token, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.6> 7617, DOI 10.17487/RFC7617, September 2015,
              <https://www.rfc-editor.org/info/rfc7617>.

Appendix D. A.  Collected ABNF

   In the collected ABNF below, list rules are expanded as per
   Section 1.2 of [MESSGNG]. 11.

   Accept = [ ( "," / ( media-range [ accept-params ] ) ) *( OWS "," [
    OWS ( media-range [ accept-params ] ) ] ) ]
   Accept-Charset = *( "," OWS ) ( ( charset / "*" ) [ weight ] ) *( OWS
    "," [ OWS ( ( charset / "*" ) [ weight ] ) ] )
   Accept-Encoding = [ ( "," / ( codings [ weight ] ) ) *( OWS "," [ OWS
    ( codings [ weight ] ) ] ) ]
   Accept-Language = *( "," OWS ) ( language-range [ weight ] ) *( OWS
    "," [ OWS ( language-range [ weight ] ) ] )
   Accept-Ranges = acceptable-ranges
   Allow = [ ( "," / method ) *( OWS "," [ OWS method ] ) ]
   Authorization = credentials

   BWS = <BWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3> OWS

   Content-Encoding = *( "," OWS ) content-coding *( OWS "," [ OWS
    content-coding ] )
   Content-Language = *( "," OWS ) language-tag *( OWS "," [ OWS
    language-tag ] )
   Content-Length = 1*DIGIT
   Content-Location = absolute-URI / partial-URI
   Content-Range = byte-content-range / other-content-range
   Content-Type = media-type

   Date = HTTP-date

   ETag = entity-tag
   Expect = "100-continue"

   From = mailbox

   GMT = %x47.4D.54 ; GMT

   HTTP-date = IMF-fixdate / obs-date
   Host = uri-host [ ":" port ]

   IMF-fixdate = day-name "," SP date1 SP time-of-day SP GMT
   If-Match = "*" / ( *( "," OWS ) entity-tag *( OWS "," [ OWS
    entity-tag ] ) )
   If-Modified-Since = HTTP-date
   If-None-Match = "*" / ( *( "," OWS ) entity-tag *( OWS "," [ OWS
    entity-tag ] ) )
   If-Range = entity-tag / HTTP-date
   If-Unmodified-Since = HTTP-date
   Last-Modified = HTTP-date
   Location = URI-reference

   Max-Forwards = 1*DIGIT

   OWS = <OWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3> *( SP / HTAB )

   Proxy-Authenticate = *( "," OWS ) challenge *( OWS "," [ OWS
    challenge ] )
   Proxy-Authorization = credentials

   RWS = <RWS, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.3> 1*( SP / HTAB )
   Range = byte-ranges-specifier / other-ranges-specifier
   Referer = absolute-URI / partial-URI
   Retry-After = HTTP-date / delay-seconds

   Server = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) )

   Trailer = *( "," OWS ) field-name *( OWS "," [ OWS field-name ] )

   URI-reference = <URI-reference, see [MESSGNG], [RFC3986], Section 2.7> 4.1>
   User-Agent = product *( RWS ( product / comment ) comment ) )

   Vary = "*" / ( *( "," OWS ) field-name *( OWS "," [ OWS field-name ]
    ) )
   Via = *( "," OWS ) ( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS comment
    ] ) *( OWS "," [ OWS ( received-protocol RWS received-by [ RWS
    comment ] ) ] )

   WWW-Authenticate = *( "," OWS ) challenge *( OWS "," [ OWS challenge
    ] )

   absolute-URI = <absolute-URI, see [RFC3986], Section 4.3>
   absolute-path = 1*( "/" segment )
   accept-ext = OWS ";" OWS token [ "=" ( token / quoted-string ) ]
   accept-params = weight *accept-ext
   acceptable-ranges = ( *( "," OWS ) range-unit *( OWS "," [ OWS
    range-unit ] ) ) / "none"
   asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
   auth-param = token BWS "=" BWS ( token / quoted-string )
   auth-scheme = token
   authority = <authority, see [RFC3986], Section 3.2>

   byte-content-range = bytes-unit SP ( byte-range-resp /
    unsatisfied-range )
   byte-range = first-byte-pos "-" last-byte-pos
   byte-range-resp = byte-range "/" ( complete-length / "*" )

   Vary
   byte-range-set = "*" / ( *( "," OWS ) field-name ( byte-range-spec /
    suffix-byte-range-spec ) *( OWS "," [ OWS field-name ] ( byte-range-spec /
    suffix-byte-range-spec ) ] )

   absolute-URI = <absolute-URI, see [MESSGNG], Section 2.7>
   accept-ext
   byte-range-spec = OWS ";" OWS token first-byte-pos "-" [ last-byte-pos ]
   byte-ranges-specifier = bytes-unit "=" byte-range-set
   bytes-unit = "bytes"

   challenge = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token token68 / quoted-string [ ( "," / auth-param ) *(
    OWS "," [ OWS auth-param ] ) ] ) ]
   accept-params = weight *accept-ext
   asctime-date = day-name SP date3 SP time-of-day SP year
   charset = token
   codings = content-coding / "identity" / "*"
   comment = <comment, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.6> "(" *( ctext / quoted-pair / comment ) ")"
   complete-length = 1*DIGIT
   content-coding = token
   credentials = auth-scheme [ 1*SP ( token68 / [ ( "," / auth-param )
    *( OWS "," [ OWS auth-param ] ) ] ) ]
   ctext = HTAB / SP / %x21-27 ; '!'-'''
    / %x2A-5B ; '*'-'['
    / %x5D-7E ; ']'-'~'
    / obs-text

   date1 = day SP month SP year
   date2 = day "-" month "-" 2DIGIT
   date3 = month SP ( 2DIGIT / ( SP DIGIT ) )
   day = 2DIGIT
   day-name = %x4D.6F.6E ; Mon
    / %x54.75.65 ; Tue
    / %x57.65.64 ; Wed
    / %x54.68.75 ; Thu
    / %x46.72.69 ; Fri
    / %x53.61.74 ; Sat
    / %x53.75.6E ; Sun
   day-name-l = %x4D.6F.6E.64.61.79 ; Monday
    / %x54.75.65.73.64.61.79 ; Tuesday
    / %x57.65.64.6E.65.73.64.61.79 ; Wednesday
    / %x54.68.75.72.73.64.61.79 ; Thursday
    / %x46.72.69.64.61.79 ; Friday
    / %x53.61.74.75.72.64.61.79 ; Saturday
    / %x53.75.6E.64.61.79 ; Sunday
   delay-seconds = 1*DIGIT

   entity-tag = [ weak ] opaque-tag
   etagc = "!" / %x23-7E ; '#'-'~'
    / obs-text

   field-content = field-vchar [ 1*( SP / HTAB ) field-vchar ]
   field-name = <comment, token
   field-value = *( field-content / obs-fold )
   field-vchar = VCHAR / obs-text
   first-byte-pos = 1*DIGIT
   fragment = <fragment, see [MESSGNG], [RFC3986], Section 3.2> 3.5>

   hour = 2DIGIT
   http-URI = "http://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ] [ "#"
    fragment ]
   https-URI = "https://" authority path-abempty [ "?" query ] [ "#"
    fragment ]

   language-range = <language-range, see [RFC4647], Section 2.1>
   language-tag = <Language-Tag, see [RFC5646], Section 2.1>
   last-byte-pos = 1*DIGIT

   mailbox = <mailbox, see [RFC5322], Section 3.4>
   media-range = ( "*/*" / ( type "/*" ) / ( type "/" subtype ) ) *( OWS
    ";" OWS parameter )
   media-type = type "/" subtype *( OWS ";" OWS parameter )
   method = token
   minute = 2DIGIT
   month = %x4A.61.6E ; Jan
    / %x46.65.62 ; Feb
    / %x4D.61.72 ; Mar
    / %x41.70.72 ; Apr
    / %x4D.61.79 ; May
    / %x4A.75.6E ; Jun
    / %x4A.75.6C ; Jul
    / %x41.75.67 ; Aug
    / %x53.65.70 ; Sep
    / %x4F.63.74 ; Oct
    / %x4E.6F.76 ; Nov
    / %x44.65.63 ; Dec

   obs-date = rfc850-date / asctime-date
   obs-fold = <obs-fold, see [Messaging], Section 5.2>
   obs-text = %x80-FF
   opaque-tag = DQUOTE *etagc DQUOTE
   other-content-range = other-range-unit SP other-range-resp
   other-range-resp = *CHAR
   other-range-set = 1*VCHAR
   other-range-unit = token
   other-ranges-specifier = other-range-unit "=" other-range-set

   parameter = token "=" ( token / quoted-string )
   partial-URI = <partial-URI, relative-part [ "?" query ]
   path-abempty = <path-abempty, see [RFC3986], Section 3.3>
   port = <port, see [MESSGNG], [RFC3986], Section 2.7> 3.2.3>
   product = token [ "/" product-version ]
   product-version = token

   quoted-string
   protocol-name = <protocol-name, see [Messaging], Section 9.7>
   protocol-version = <protocol-version, see [Messaging], Section 9.7>
   pseudonym = token

   qdtext = HTAB / SP / "!" / %x23-5B ; '#'-'['
    / %x5D-7E ; ']'-'~'
    / obs-text
   query = <quoted-string, <query, see [MESSGNG], [RFC3986], Section 3.2.6> 3.4>
   quoted-pair = "\" ( HTAB / SP / VCHAR / obs-text )
   quoted-string = DQUOTE *( qdtext / quoted-pair ) DQUOTE
   qvalue = ( "0" [ "." *3DIGIT ] ) / ( "1" [ "." *3"0" ] )

   range-unit = bytes-unit / other-range-unit
   received-by = ( uri-host [ ":" port ] ) / pseudonym
   received-protocol = [ protocol-name "/" ] protocol-version
   relative-part = <relative-part, see [RFC3986], Section 4.2>
   request-target = <request-target, see [Messaging], Section 3.2>
   rfc850-date = day-name-l "," SP date2 SP time-of-day SP GMT

   second = 2DIGIT
   segment = <segment, see [RFC3986], Section 3.3>
   subtype = token
   suffix-byte-range-spec = "-" suffix-length
   suffix-length = 1*DIGIT

   tchar = "!" / "#" / "$" / "%" / "&" / "'" / "*" / "+" / "-" / "." /
    "^" / "_" / "`" / "|" / "~" / DIGIT / ALPHA
   time-of-day = hour ":" minute ":" second
   token = <token, see [MESSGNG], Section 3.2.6> 1*tchar
   token68 = 1*( ALPHA / DIGIT / "-" / "." / "_" / "~" / "+" / "/" )
    *"="
   type = token

   unsatisfied-range = "*/" complete-length
   uri-host = <host, see [RFC3986], Section 3.2.2>

   weak = %x57.2F ; W/
   weight = OWS ";" OWS "q=" qvalue

   year = 4DIGIT

Appendix B.  Changes from RFC 7230

   Most of the sections introducing HTTP's design goals, history,
   architecture, conformance criteria, protocol versioning, URIs,
   message routing, and header field values have been moved here
   (without substantive change).

Appendix C.  Changes from RFC 7231

   None yet.

Appendix D.  Changes from RFC 7232

   None yet.

Appendix E.  Changes from RFC 7233

   None yet.

Appendix F.  Changes from RFC 7235

   None yet.

Appendix G.  Change Log

   This section is to be removed before publishing as an RFC.

E.1.  Since RFC 7231

G.1.  Between RFC723x and draft 00

   The changes in this draft are were purely editorial:

   o  Change boilerplate and abstract to indicate the "draft" status,
      and update references to ancestor specifications.

   o  Remove version "1.1" from document title, indicating that this
      specification applies to all HTTP versions.

   o  Adjust historical notes.

   o  Update links to sibling specifications.

   o  Replace sections listing changes from RFC 2616 by new empty
      sections referring to RFC 723x.

   o  Remove acknowledgements specific to RFC 723x.

   o  Move "Acknowledgements" to the very end and make them unnumbered.

G.2.  Since draft-ietf-httpbis-semantics-00

   The changes in this draft are editorial, with respect to HTTP as a
   whole, to merge core HTTP semantics into this document:

   o  Merged introduction, architecture, conformance, and ABNF
      extensions from RFC 7230 (Messaging).

   o  Rearranged architecture to extract conformance, http(s) schemes,
      and protocol versioning into a separate major section.

   o  Moved discussion of MIME differences to [Messaging] since that is
      primarily concerned with transforming 1.1 messages.

   o  Merged entire content of RFC 7232 (Conditional Requests).

   o  Merged entire content of RFC 7233 (Range Requests).

   o  Merged entire content of RFC 7235 (Auth Framework).

   o  Moved all extensibility tips, registration procedures, and
      registry tables from the IANA considerations to normative
      sections, reducing the IANA considerations to just instructions
      that will be removed prior to publication as an RFC.

Index

   1
      100 Continue (status code)  50  106
      100-continue (expect value)  34  73
      101 Switching Protocols (status code)  50  106
      1xx Informational (status code class)  50  106

   2
      200 OK (status code)  51  107
      201 Created (status code)  52  108
      202 Accepted (status code)  52  108
      203 Non-Authoritative Information (status code)  52  108
      204 No Content (status code)  53  109
      205 Reset Content (status code)  53  109
      206 Partial Content (status code)  110
      2xx Successful (status code class)  51  107

   3
      300 Multiple Choices (status code)  55  114
      301 Moved Permanently (status code)  56  115
      302 Found (status code)  57  116
      303 See Other (status code)  57  116
      304 Not Modified (status code)  117
      305 Use Proxy (status code)  58  117
      306 (Unused) (status code)  58  118
      307 Temporary Redirect (status code)  58  118
      3xx Redirection (status code class)  54  113

   4
      400 Bad Request (status code)  59  118
      401 Unauthorized (status code)  118
      402 Payment Required (status code)  59  119
      403 Forbidden (status code)  59  119
      404 Not Found (status code)  59  119
      405 Method Not Allowed (status code)  59  120
      406 Not Acceptable (status code)  60  120
      407 Proxy Authentication Required (status code)  120
      408 Request Timeout (status code)  60  120
      409 Conflict (status code)  60  121
      410 Gone (status code)  61  121
      411 Length Required (status code)  61  121
      412 Precondition Failed (status code)  122
      413 Payload Too Large (status code)  61  122
      414 URI Too Long (status code)  62  122
      415 Unsupported Media Type (status code)  62  122
      416 Range Not Satisfiable (status code)  123
      417 Expectation Failed (status code)  62  123
      426 Upgrade Required (status code)  62  123
      4xx Client Error (status code class)  58  118

   5
      500 Internal Server Error (status code)  63  124
      501 Not Implemented (status code)  63  124
      502 Bad Gateway (status code)  63  124
      503 Service Unavailable (status code)  64  125
      504 Gateway Timeout (status code)  64  125
      505 HTTP Version Not Supported (status code)  64  125
      5xx Server Error (status code class)  63  124

   A
      Accept header field  38  88
      Accept-Charset header field  40  90
      Accept-Encoding header field  41  91
      Accept-Language header field  43  93
      Accept-Ranges header field  145
      Allow header field  72  145
      Authorization header field  97
      accelerator  12
      authoritative response  148

   B
      browser  10

   C
      CONNECT method  30  69
      Canonical Root URI  96
      Content-Encoding header field  11  46
      Content-Language header field  13  47
      Content-Length header field  48
      Content-Location header field  15
      Content-Transfer-Encoding  49
      Content-Range header field  91  53
      Content-Type header field  10  45
      cache  13
      cacheable  24  14, 62
      captive portal  13
      client  10
      compress (Coding Format)  40
      compress (content coding)  11  40
      conditional request  37  76
      connection  10
      content coding  11  40
      content negotiation  6  8

   D
      DELETE method  29  68
      Date header field  67  130
      Delimiters  27
      deflate (Coding Format)  40
      deflate (content coding)  11  40
      downstream  12

   E
      ETag header field  139
      Expect header field  34  73
      effective request URI  31

   F
      From header field  44  100

   G
      GET method  24  63
      Grammar
         absolute-path  15
         absolute-URI  15
         Accept  38  88
         Accept-Charset  41  91
         Accept-Encoding  41  91
         accept-ext  38  88
         Accept-Language  43  93
         accept-params  38  88
         Accept-Ranges  145
         acceptable-ranges  145
         Allow  73  145
         ALPHA  9
         asctime-date  67  130
         auth-param  95
         auth-scheme  95
         authority  15
         Authorization  97
         BWS  29
         byte-content-range  53
         byte-range  53
         byte-range-resp  53
         byte-range-set  43
         byte-range-spec  43
         byte-ranges-specifier  43
         bytes-unit  42-43
         challenge  95
         charset  9  38
         codings  41  91
         comment  28
         complete-length  53
         content-coding  11  40
         Content-Encoding  12  46
         Content-Language  13  47
         Content-Length  48
         Content-Location  15  49
         Content-Range  53
         Content-Type  10  45
         CR  9
         credentials  96
         CRLF  9
         ctext  28
         CTL  9
         Date  67  130
         date1  66  129
         day  66  129
         day-name  66  129
         day-name-l  66  129
         delay-seconds  70  133
         DIGIT  9
         DQUOTE  9
         entity-tag  139
         ETag  139
         etagc  139
         Expect  34  73
         field-content  26
         field-name  22, 30
         field-value  26
         field-vchar  26
         first-byte-pos  43
         fragment  15
         From  45  100
         GMT  66  129
         HEXDIG  9
         Host  32
         hour  66  129
         HTAB  9
         HTTP-date  65  127
         http-URI  16
         https-URI  17
         If-Match  80
         If-Modified-Since  82
         If-None-Match  81
         If-Range  85
         If-Unmodified-Since  83
         IMF-fixdate  66  129
         language-range  43  93
         language-tag  13  42
         last-byte-pos  43
         Last-Modified  137
         LF  9
         Location  68  131
         Max-Forwards  36  76
         media-range  38  88
         media-type  8  38
         method  21  59
         minute  66  129
         month  66  129
         obs-date  66  129
         obs-text  28
         OCTET  9
         opaque-tag  139
         other-content-range  53
         other-range-resp  53
         other-range-unit  42, 44
         OWS  29
         parameter  8  38
         partial-URI  15
         port  15
         product  47  102
         product-version  47  102
         protocol-name  34
         protocol-version  34
         Proxy-Authenticate  144
         Proxy-Authorization  97
         pseudonym  34
         qdtext  28
         query  15
         quoted-pair  28
         quoted-string  28
         qvalue  38  88
         Range  86
         range-unit  42
         ranges-specifier  43
         received-by  34
         received-protocol  34
         Referer  45  101
         Retry-After  70  133
         rfc850-date  67  130
         RWS  29
         second  66  129
         segment  15
         Server  73  146
         SP  9
         subtype  8  38
         suffix-byte-range-spec  43
         suffix-length  43
         tchar  27
         time-of-day  66  129
         token  27
         token68  95
         Trailer  30
         type  8  38
         unsatisfied-range  53
         uri-host  15
         URI-reference  15
         User-Agent  46  102
         Vary  70  133
         VCHAR  9
         Via  34
         weak  139
         weight  38  88
         WWW-Authenticate  143
         year  66  129
      gateway  12
      gzip (Coding Format)  41
      gzip (content coding)  11  40

   H
      HEAD method  25  63
      Host header field  32
      http URI scheme  16
      https URI scheme  17

   I
      If-Match header field  80
      If-Modified-Since header field  82
      If-None-Match header field  81
      If-Range header field  84
      If-Unmodified-Since header field  83
      idempotent  23  62
      inbound  12
      interception proxy  13
      intermediary  11

   L
      Location
      Last-Modified header field  68

   M
      MIME-Version  137
      Location header field  90  131

   M
      Max-Forwards header field  36  76
      Media Type
         multipart/byteranges  55
         multipart/x-byteranges  55
      message  10
      metadata  134
      multipart/byteranges Media Type  55
      multipart/x-byteranges Media Type  55

   N
      non-transforming proxy  35

   O
      OPTIONS method  31  70
      origin server  10
      outbound  12

   P
      POST method  25  64
      PUT method  26  65
      Protection Space  96
      Proxy-Authenticate header field  144
      Proxy-Authorization header field  97
      payload  17  51
      phishing  148
      proxy  12

   R
      Range header field  86
      Realm  96
      Referer header field  45  101
      Retry-After header field  69  132
      recipient  10
      representation  7  37
      request  10
      resource  14
      response  10
      reverse proxy  12

   S
      Server header field  73  146
      Status Codes Classes
         1xx Informational  50  106
         2xx Successful  51  107
         3xx Redirection  54  113
         4xx Client Error  58  118
         5xx Server Error  63  124
      safe  22  61
      selected representation  7, 71  37, 77, 134
      sender  10
      server  10
      spider  10

   T
      TRACE method  32  71
      Trailer header field  30
      target URI  30
      target resource  30
      transforming proxy  35
      transparent proxy  13
      tunnel  13

   U
      URI scheme
         http  16
         https  17
      User-Agent header field  46  102
      upstream  12
      user agent  10

   V
      Vary header field  70  133
      Via header field  34
      validator  134
         strong  135
         weak  135

   W
      WWW-Authenticate header field  143

   X
      x-compress (content coding)  11  40
      x-gzip (content coding)  11  40

Acknowledgments

   This edition of the HTTP specification builds on the many
   contributions that went into RFC 1945, RFC 2068, RFC 2145, and RFC
   2616, including substantial contributions made by the previous
   authors, editors, and Working Group Chairs: Tim Berners-Lee, Ari
   Luotonen, Roy T.  Fielding, Henrik Frystyk Nielsen, Jim Gettys,
   Jeffrey C.  Mogul, Larry Masinter, Paul J.  Leach, and Yves Lafon.

   See Appendix "Acknowledgments" Section 10 of [RFC7230] for further acknowledgements from prior
   revisions.

   In addition, this document has reincorporated the HTTP Authentication
   Framework, previously defined in RFC 7235 and RFC 2617.  We thank
   John Franks, Phillip M.  Hallam-Baker, Jeffery L.  Hostetler, Scott
   D.  Lawrence, Paul J.  Leach, Ari Luotonen, and Lawrence C.  Stewart
   for their work on that specification.  See Section 6 of [MESSGNG]. [RFC2617] for
   further acknowledgements.

   [[newacks: New acks to be added here.]]

Authors' Addresses

   Roy T. Fielding (editor)
   Adobe
   345 Park Ave
   San Jose, CA  95110
   USA

   EMail: fielding@gbiv.com
   URI:   http://roy.gbiv.com/   https://roy.gbiv.com/

   Mark Nottingham (editor)
   Fastly

   EMail: mnot@mnot.net
   URI:   https://www.mnot.net/

   Julian F. Reschke (editor)
   greenbytes GmbH
   Hafenweg 16
   Muenster, NW  48155
   Germany

   EMail: julian.reschke@greenbytes.de
   URI:   http://greenbytes.de/tech/webdav/   https://greenbytes.de/tech/webdav/